MC68HC908QL3CP [NXP]
IC,MICROCONTROLLER,8-BIT,68HC08 CPU,CMOS,DIP,16PIN,PLASTIC;型号: | MC68HC908QL3CP |
厂家: | NXP |
描述: | IC,MICROCONTROLLER,8-BIT,68HC08 CPU,CMOS,DIP,16PIN,PLASTIC 微控制器 光电二极管 |
文件: | 总246页 (文件大小:3002K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
MC68HC908QL4
MC68HC908QL3
MC68HC908QL2
Data Sheet
M68HC08
Microcontrollers
MC68HC908QL4/D
Rev. 2
3/2004
MOTOROLA.COM/SEMICONDUCTORS
MC68HC908QL4
MC68HC908QL3
MC68HC908QL2
Data Sheet
To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our documents on the
World Wide Web will be the most current. Your printed copy may be an earlier
revision. To verify you have the latest information available, refer to:
http://motorola.com/semiconductors/
The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in this
document. For your convenience, the page number designators have been linked
to the appropriate location.
Motorola and the Stylized M Logo are registered trademarks of Motorola, Inc.
DigitalDNA is a trademark of Motorola, Inc.
This product incorporates SuperFlash® technology licensed from SST.
© Motorola, Inc., 2004
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
3
Revision History
Revision History
Revision
Level
Page
Number(s)
Date
Description
September,
2003
N/A
Initial release
N/A
226
228
17.3 Functional Operating Range — Corrected operating voltage
range
17.6 Control Timing — Corrected values for internal operating
frequency and internal clock period
November,
2003
1.0
17.14 5.0-Volt ADC Characteristics — Replaced ADC characteristic
table found in initial release
236
237
17.15 3.3-Volt ADC Characteristics — Added
Figure 2-2 . Control, Status, and Data Registers
Corrected reset state for the FLASH Block Protect Register.
Corrected reset value for the Internal Oscillator Time Value
33
34
Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary — Added WAIT instruction
83
11.8.1 Oscillator Status Register — Revised description of ECGON
bit for clarity
111
Table 13-3. Interrupt Sources — Corrected address locations for
SLIC, KBI, and ADC
132
14.3.5 SLIC Wait (Core Specific) — Revised description for clarity
14.3.7 SLIC Stop (Core Specific) — Revised description for clarity
144
144
14.6.6.2 Byte Transfer Mode Operation — Revised definition of
Receiver Buffer Overrun Error
156
161
174
196
196
206
March,
2004
2.0
14.7.1 LIN Message Frame Header — Revised third paragraph of
description
14.14 Sleep and Wakeup Operation — Revised second paragraph of
description
15.8 Input/Output Signals — Corrected reference from PTA0/TCH) to
PTB0/TCH0
15.8.2 TIM Channel I/O Pins (PTB0/TCH0 and PTA1/TCH1) —
Corrected reference to from PTA0/TCH) to PTB0/TCH0
Figure 16-1 . Block Diagram Highlighting BRK and MON Blocks —
Added
17.5 5-V DC Electrical Characteristics — Updated table notes
17.8 5-V Oscillator Characteristics — Updated table notes
17.9 3.3-V DC Electrical Characteristics — Updated table notes
227
230
231
Data Sheet
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
4
Revision History
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
List of Sections
Section 1. General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Section 2. Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
Section 3. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Section 4. Auto Wakeup Module (AWU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2) . . . . . .63
Section 6. Computer Operating Properly (COP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Section 7. Central Processor Unit (CPU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Section 8. External Interrupt (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Section 9. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Section 10. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Section 11. Oscillator Module (OSC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Section 12. Input/Output Ports (PORTS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Section 13. System Integration Module (SIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
Section 14. Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
Section 15. Timer Interface Module (TIM). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Section 16. Development Support. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Section 17. Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Section 18. Ordering Information and Mechanical
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
5
List of Sections
List of Sections
Data Sheet
6
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
List of Sections
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Table of Contents
Section 1. General Description
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
MCU Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Pin Function Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Section 2. Memory
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Unimplemented Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Reserved Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Input/Output (I/O) Section. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Random-Access Memory (RAM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
2.6
FLASH Memory (FLASH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
FLASH Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
FLASH Page Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
FLASH Mass Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
FLASH Program Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
FLASH Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
FLASH Block Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
2.6.1
2.6.2
2.6.3
2.6.4
2.6.5
2.6.6
2.6.7
2.6.8
Section 3. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
3.1
3.2
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
3.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
ADC Port I/O Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Voltage Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Conversion Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Accuracy and Precision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Result Justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
3.3.1
3.3.2
3.3.3
3.3.4
3.3.5
3.3.6
3.4
3.5
Monotonicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
Table of Contents
7
Table of Contents
3.6
3.6.1
3.6.2
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
3.7
I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDAD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
ADC Analog Ground Pin (VSSAD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
ADC Voltage Reference High Pin (VREFH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
ADC Voltage In (VADIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
3.7.1
3.7.2
3.7.3
3.7.4
3.7.5
3.8
3.8.1
3.8.2
3.8.2.1
3.8.2.2
3.8.2.3
3.8.2.4
3.8.3
I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
ADC Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
ADC Data Register High and Data Register Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Left Justified Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Right Justified Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Left Justified Signed Data Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Eight Bit Truncation Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
ADC Clock Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Section 4. Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
4.6
Input/Output Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Port A I/O Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Keyboard Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
4.6.1
4.6.2
4.6.3
Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
5.1
5.2
Section 6. Computer Operating Properly (COP)
6.1
6.2
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
6.3
I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
BUSCLKX4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
COPCTL Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Internal Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Reset Vector Fetch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
COPD (COP Disable) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
COPRS (COP Rate Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
6.3.1
6.3.2
6.3.3
6.3.4
6.3.5
6.3.6
6.3.7
Data Sheet
8
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
6.4
6.5
6.6
COP Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
6.7
6.7.1
6.7.2
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
6.8
COP Module During Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Section 7. Central Processor Unit (CPU)
7.1
7.2
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
7.3
CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Index Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Stack Pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Program Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Condition Code Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
7.3.1
7.3.2
7.3.3
7.3.4
7.3.5
7.4
Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
7.5
7.5.1
7.5.2
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
7.6
7.7
7.8
CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Opcode Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Section 8. External Interrupt (IRQ)
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
8.5
8.6
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
IRQ Pin. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
IRQ Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
IRQ Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Section 9. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
9.1
9.2
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
9.3
9.3.1
9.3.2
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Keyboard Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Keyboard Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
9.4
9.5
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
Table of Contents
9
Table of Contents
9.6
Keyboard Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
9.7
9.7.1
9.7.2
Input/Output Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Keyboard Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Section 10. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
10.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
10.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
10.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
10.3.1
10.3.2
10.3.3
10.3.4
Polled LVI Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Forced Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Voltage Hysteresis Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
LVI Trip Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
10.4 LVI Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
10.5 LVI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
10.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
10.6.1
10.6.2
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Section 11. Oscillator Module (OSC)
11.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
11.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
11.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
11.3.1
Internal Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Internal Oscillator Trimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Internal to External Clock Switching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
External Oscillator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
XTAL Oscillator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
RC Oscillator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
11.3.1.1
11.3.1.2
11.3.2
11.3.3
11.3.4
11.4 Oscillator Module Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
11.4.1
11.4.2
11.4.3
11.4.4
11.4.5
11.4.6
11.4.7
11.4.8
Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2/PTA4/BUSCLKX4). . . . . . . . . 108
Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
XTAL Oscillator Clock (XTALCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
RC Oscillator Clock (RCCLK). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Internal Oscillator Clock (INTCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Oscillator Out 2 (BUSCLKX4). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Oscillator Out (BUSCLKX2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
11.5 Low Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
11.5.1
11.5.2
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
11.6 Oscillator During Break Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
11.7 CONFIG2 Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Data Sheet
10
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
11.8 Input/Output (I/O) Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
11.8.1
11.8.2
Oscillator Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Oscillator Trim Register (OSCTRIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Section 12. Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
12.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
12.2 Port A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
12.2.1
12.2.2
12.2.3
Port A Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Data Direction Register A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Port A Input Pullup Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
12.3 Port B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
12.3.1
12.3.2
12.3.3
Port B Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Data Direction Register B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Port B Input Pullup Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Section 13. System Integration Module (SIM)
13.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
13.2 RST and IRQ Pins Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
13.3 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
13.3.1
13.3.2
13.3.3
Bus Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Clock Start-Up from POR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Clocks in Stop Mode and Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
13.4 Reset and System Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
13.4.1
13.4.2
External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Active Resets from Internal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Illegal Opcode Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Illegal Address Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
13.4.2.1
13.4.2.2
13.4.2.3
13.4.2.4
13.4.2.5
13.5 SIM Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
13.5.1
13.5.2
13.5.3
SIM Counter During Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
SIM Counter During Stop Mode Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
SIM Counter and Reset States. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
13.6 Exception Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
13.6.1
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Hardware Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
SWI Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Interrupt Status Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Interrupt Status Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Interrupt Status Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Interrupt Status Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Status Flag Protection in Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
13.6.1.1
13.6.1.2
13.6.2
13.6.2.1
13.6.2.2
13.6.2.3
13.6.3
13.6.4
13.6.5
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
Table of Contents
11
Table of Contents
13.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
13.7.1
13.7.2
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
13.8 SIM Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
13.8.1
13.8.2
13.8.3
SIM Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Break Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Section 14. Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
14.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
14.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
14.3.1
14.3.2
14.3.3
14.3.4
14.3.5
14.3.6
14.3.7
14.3.8
14.3.9
14.3.10
Power Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
SLIC Disabled. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
SLIC Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
SLIC Wait (Core Specific). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Wakeup from SLIC Wait with CPU in WAIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
SLIC Stop (Core Specific). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Normal and Emulation Mode Operation (Core Specific). . . . . . . . . 145
Special Mode Operation (Core Specific) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Low-Power Options (Core Specific) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
14.4 External Signal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
14.4.1
14.4.2
SLCTX — SLIC Transmit Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
SLCRX — SLIC Receive Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
14.5 Memory Map/Register Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
14.6 SLIC Registers and Control Bits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
14.6.1
14.6.2
14.6.3
14.6.4
14.6.5
14.6.6
14.6.6.1
14.6.6.2
14.6.7
14.6.8
SLIC Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
SLIC Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
SLIC Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
SLIC Prescaler Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
SLIC Bit Time Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
SLIC State Vector Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
LIN Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Byte Transfer Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
SLIC Data Length Code Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
SLIC Identifier and Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
14.7 Initialization/Application Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
14.7.1
14.7.2
14.7.3
14.7.4
LIN Message Frame Header . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
LIN Data Field. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
LIN Checksum Field . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
SLIC Module Constraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
14.8 SLCSV Interrupt Handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Data Sheet
12
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
14.9 SLIC Module Initialization Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
14.9.1
14.9.2
LIN Mode Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Byte Transfer Mode Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
14.10 Handling LIN Message Headers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
14.10.1
14.10.2
LIN Message Headers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Possible Errors on Message Headers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
14.11 Handling Command Message Frames. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
14.11.1
14.11.2
14.11.3
Standard Command Message Frames. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Extended Command Message Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Possible Errors on Command Message Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
14.12 Handling Request LIN Message Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
14.12.1
14.12.2
14.12.3
14.12.4
Standard Request Message Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Extended Request Message Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Transmit Abort . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Possible Errors on Request Message Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
14.13 Handling IMSG to Minimize Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
14.14 Sleep and Wakeup Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
14.15 Polling Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
14.16 LIN Data Integrity Checking Methods. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
14.17 High-Speed LIN Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
14.18 Byte Transfer Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
14.19 Oscillator Trimming with SLIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
14.20 Digital Receive Filter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
14.20.1
14.20.2
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Section 15. Timer Interface Module (TIM)
15.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
15.2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
15.3 Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
15.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
15.4.1
15.4.2
15.4.3
15.4.3.1
15.4.3.2
15.4.4
15.4.4.1
15.4.4.2
15.4.4.3
TIM Counter Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Unbuffered Output Compare. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Buffered Output Compare. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Buffered PWM Signal Generation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
15.5 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
15.6 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
13
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
15.7 TIM During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
15.8 Input/Output Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
15.8.1
15.8.2
TIM Clock Pin (PTA2/TCLK). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
TIM Channel I/O Pins (PTB0/TCH0 and PTA1/TCH1) . . . . . . . . . . 196
15.9 Input/Output Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
15.9.1
15.9.2
15.9.3
15.9.4
15.9.5
TIM Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
TIM Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
TIM Counter Modulo Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
TIM Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
TIM Channel Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Section 16. Development Support
16.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
16.2 Break Module (BRK). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
16.2.1
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Flag Protection During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
TIM During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
COP During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Break Module Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Break Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Break Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Break Auxiliary Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Break Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
16.2.1.1
16.2.1.2
16.2.1.3
16.2.2
16.2.2.1
16.2.2.2
16.2.2.3
16.2.2.4
16.2.2.5
16.2.3
16.3 Monitor Module (MON). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
16.3.1
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Normal Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Forced Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Monitor Vectors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Break Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
16.3.1.1
16.3.1.2
16.3.1.3
16.3.1.4
16.3.1.5
16.3.1.6
16.3.1.7
16.3.2
Section 17. Electrical Specifications
17.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
17.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
17.3 Functional Operating Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
17.4 Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
17.5 5-V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
17.6 Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
17.7 Typical 5-V Output Drive Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Data Sheet
14
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
17.8 5-V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
17.9 3.3-V DC Electrical Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
17.10 Typical 3.3-V Output Drive Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
17.11 3.3-V Control Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
17.12 3.3-V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
17.13 Supply Current Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
17.14 5.0-Volt ADC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
17.15 3.3-Volt ADC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
17.16 Timer Interface Module Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
17.17 Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Section 18. Ordering Information
and Mechanical Specifications
18.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
18.2 MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
18.3 16-Pin Plastic Dual In-Line Package (Case #648D). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
18.4 16-Pin Small Outline Integrated Circuit Package
(Case #751G) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
18.5 16-Pin Thin Shrink Small Outline Package (Case #948F) . . . . . . . . . . 243
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
15
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Data Sheet
16
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 1. General Description
1.1 Introduction
The MC68HC908QL4 is a member of the low-cost, high-performance M68HC08
Family of 8-bit microcontroller units (MCUs). All MCUs in the family use the
enhanced M68HC08 central processor unit (CPU08) and are available with a
variety of modules, memory sizes and types, and package types.
0.4
Table 1-1. Summary of Device Variations
Analog-to-Digital
Converter
Pin
Count
Device
Memory Size
MC68HC908QL4
MC68HC908QL3
MC68HC908QL2
4096 bytes FLASH
4096 bytes FLASH
2048 bytes FLASH
6 ch, 10 bit
—
16 pins
16 pins
16 pins
6 ch, 10 bit
1.2 Features
Features include:
•
•
•
•
•
High-performance M68HC08 CPU core
Fully upward-compatible object code with M68HC05 Family
5-V and 3.3-V operating voltages (VDD
)
8-MHz internal bus operation at 5 V, 4-MHz at 3.3 V
Trimmable internal oscillator
–
–
–
Selectable 3.2 or 6.4 MHz internal bus operation
8-bit trim capability allows 0.4% accuracy(1)
± 25% untrimmed
1. ±5% guaranteed accuracy over entire temperature and voltage range after trimming. LIN
communication easily maintained under all conditions using SLIC module.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
17
General Description
General Description
•
Slave LIN interface Controller (SLIC) module
–
–
Full LIN messaging buffering of Identifier and 8 data bytes
Automatic baud rate and LIN message frame synchronization:
No prior programming of bit rate required, 1–20 kbps LIN bus speed
operation
All LIN messages will be received (no message loss due to
synchronization process)
Input clock tolerance as high as ±50%, allowing internal oscillator to
remain untrimmed
Incoming break symbols allowed to be 10 to 20 bit times without
message loss
Supports automatic software trimming of internal oscillator using LIN
synchronization data
–
Automatic processing and verification of LIN SYNCH BREAK and
SYNCH BYTE
–
–
–
–
–
Automatic checksum calculation and verification with error reporting
Maximum of 2 interrupts per LIN message frame
Full LIN error checking and reporting
High-speed LIN capability up to 83.33 kbps to 120.00 kbps
Configurable digital receive filter
•
•
•
•
Auto wakeup from STOP capability
In-system FLASH programming
FLASH security(1)
On-chip in-application programmable FLASH memory (with internal
program/erase voltage generation)
–
–
MC68HC908QL4, MC68HC908QL3 — 4096 bytes
MC68HC908QL2 — 2048 bytes
•
Read-only memory (ROM)
–
–
MC68HC908QL4, MC68HC908QL3 — 4096 bytes
MC68HC908QL2 — 2048 bytes
•
•
128 bytes of on-chip random-access memory (RAM)
2-channel, 16-bit timer interface module (TIM) with external clock source
input
•
•
6-channel, 10-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC) on MC68HC908QL4
and MC68HC908QL2
13 bidirectional input/output (I/O) lines and one input only:
–
–
–
–
Six shared with keyboard interrupt function
Six shared with ADC
Two shared with TIM
Two shared with SLC
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading or
copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users.
Data Sheet
18
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
General Description
MOTOROLA
General Description
MCU Block Diagram
–
–
–
–
–
One shared with reset
One input only shared with external interrupt (IRQ)
High current sink/source capability
Selectable pullups on all ports, selectable on an individual bit basis
Three-state ability on all port pins
•
•
6-bit keyboard interrupt with wakeup feature (KBI)
Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module features:
–
Software selectable trip point in CONFIG register
•
System protection features:
–
–
–
–
Computer operating properly (COP) watchdog
Low-voltage detection with reset
Illegal opcode detection with reset
Illegal address detection with reset
•
•
External asynchronous interrupt pin with internal pullup (IRQ) shared with
general-purpose input pin
Master asynchronous reset pin (RST) shared with general-purpose
input/output (I/O) pin
•
•
•
•
•
Power-on reset
Internal pullups on IRQ and RST to reduce external components
Memory mapped I/O registers
Power saving stop and wait modes
Available packages:
–
–
–
16-pin plastic dual in-line package (PDIP)
16-pin small outline integrated circuit (SOIC) package
16-pin thin shrink small outline package (TSSOP)
Features of the CPU08 include the following:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Enhanced HC05 programming model
Extensive loop control functions
16 addressing modes (eight more than the HC05)
16-bit index register and stack pointer
Memory-to-memory data transfers
Fast 8 × 8 multiply instruction
Fast 16/8 divide instruction
Binary-coded decimal (BCD) instructions
Optimization for controller applications
Efficient C language support
1.3 MCU Block Diagram
Figure 1-1 shows the structure of the MC68HC908QL4.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
19
General Description
General Description
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
CLOCK
GENERATOR
(OSCILLATOR)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
SINGLE INTERRUPT
MODULE
M68HC08 CPU
PTB0/TCH0
PTB1
BREAK
MODULE
PTB2/AD4
PTB3/AD5
PTB4/SLCRX
PTB5/SLCTX
PTB6
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
KEYBOARD INTERRUPT
MODULE
PTB7
2-CH 16-BIT TIMER
MODULE
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL3: 4096 BYTES
MC68HC908QL2: 2048 BYTES
USER FLASH
SLAVE LIN INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
COP
MODULE
6-CHANNEL 10-BIT
ADC
MONITOR ROM
128 BYTES RAM
VDD
POWER SUPPLY
VSS
RST, IRQ: Pins have internal (about 30 kΩ) pull up
PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5: High current sink and source capability
PTA0–PTA5: Pins have programmable keyboard interrupt and pull up
ADC pins only available on MC68HC908QL4 and MC68HC908QL2
Figure 1-1. Block Diagram
Data Sheet
20
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
General Description
General Description
Pin Functions
VDD
VDD
VSS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
VSS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
PTA1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTB4/SLCRx
PTA0/KBI0
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
PTB0/TCH0
PTA5/OSC1/KBI5
PTA4/OSC2/KBI4
PTB4/SLCRx
PTB0/TCH0
PTB3/AD5
PTB2/AD4
PTB5/SLCTx
PTB6
PTB3
PTB2
PTB5/SLCTx
PTB6
PTB1
PTB7
PTB7
PTB1
16-PIN ASSIGNMENT
MC68HC908QL3 PDIP/SOIC
16-PIN ASSIGNMENT
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL2 PDIP/SOIC
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
PTB4/SLCRx
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
PTB4/SLCRx
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
PTA4/OSC2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/KBI5
PTB5/SLCTx
PTB6
PTB5/SLCTx
PTB6
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
VSS
PTA0/KBI0
VSS
PTB7
PTB7
VDD
PTB1
VDD
PTB1
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
PTB2/AD4
PTA1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
PTB2
PTB3/AD5
PTB3
PTB0/TCH0
PTB0/TCH0
16-PIN ASSIGNMENT
MC68HC908QL3 TSSOP
16-PIN ASSIGNMENT
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL2 TSSOP
Figure 1-2. MCU Pin Assignments
1.4 Pin Functions
Table 1-2 provides a description of the pin functions.
Table 1-2. Pin Functions
Pin
Name
Description
Input/Output
VDD
VSS
Power supply
Power
Power supply ground
Power
Input/Output
Input
PTA0 — General purpose I/O port
AD0 — A/D channel 0 input
KBI0 — Keyboard interrupt input 0
PTA0
Input
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
21
General Description
General Description
Table 1-2. Pin Functions (Continued)
Pin
Name
Description
Input/Output
PTA1 — General purpose I/O port
Input/Output
Input
AD1 — A/D channel 1 input
PTA1
TCH1 — Timer Channel 1 I/O
Input/Output
Input
KBI1— Keyboard interrupt input 1
PTA2 — General purpose input-only port
IRQ — External interrupt with programmable pullup and Schmitt trigger input
KBI2 — Keyboard interrupt input 2
Input
Input
PTA2
PTA3
Input
TCLK — External clock source input for the TIM module
PTA3 — General purpose I/O port
Input
Input/Output
Input
RST — Reset input, active low with internal pullup and Schmitt trigger input
KBI3 — Keyboard interrupt input 3
Input
PTA4 — General purpose I/O port
Input/Output
OSC2 — XTAL oscillator output (XTAL option only)
RC or internal oscillator output (OSC2EN = 1 in PTAPUE register)
Output
Output
PTA4
PTA5
AD2 — A/D channel 2 input
Input
Input
KBI4 — Keyboard interrupt input 4
PTA5 — General purpose I/O port
OSC1 — XTAL, RC, or external oscillator input
AD3 — A/D channel 3 input
Input/Output
Input
Input
KBI5 — Keyboard interrupt input 5
PTB0 — General purpose I/O port
TCH0 — Timer Channel 0 I/O
PTB1 — General purpose I/O port
PTB2 — General purpose I/O port
AD4 — A/D channel 4 input
Input
Input/Output
Input/Output
Input/Output
Input/Output
Input
PTB0
PTB1
PTB2
PTB3 — General purpose I/O port
AD5 — A/D channel 5 input
Input/Output
Input
PTB3
PTB4
PTB5
PTB4 — General purpose I/O port
SLCRx — SLC receive input
Input/Output
Input
PTB5 — General purpose I/O port
SLCTx — SLC transmit output
Input/Output
Output
PTB6, PTB7 General-purpose I/O port
Input/Output
Data Sheet
22
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
General Description
General Description
Pin Function Priority
1.5 Pin Function Priority
Table 1-3 is meant to resolve the priority if multiple functions are enabled on a
single pin.
NOTE:
Upon reset all pins come up as input ports regardless of the priority table.
Table 1-3. Function Priority in Shared Pins
Pin Name
PTA0
PTA1
PTA2
PTA3
PTA4
PTA5
PTB0
PTB1
PTB2
PTB3
PTB4
PTB5
Highest-to-Lowest Priority Sequence
AD0 → TCH1 → KBI0 → PTA0
AD1 → KBI1 → PTA1
IRQ → KBI2 → TCLK → PTA2
RST → KBI3 → PTA3
OSC2 → AD2 → KBI4 → PTA4
OSC1 → AD3 → KBI5 → PTA5
TCH0 → PTB0
PTB1
AD4 → PTB2
AD5 → PTB3
SLCRx → PTB4
SLCTx → PTB5
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
23
General Description
General Description
Data Sheet
24
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
General Description
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 2. Memory
2.1 Introduction
The central processor unit (CPU08) can address 64 Kbytes of memory space. The
memory map, shown in Figure 2-1, includes:
•
•
•
•
•
•
4096 bytes of user FLASH for MC68HC908QL4 and MC68HC908QL3
2048 bytes of user FLASH for MC68HC908QL2
128 bytes of random access memory (RAM)
48 bytes of user-defined vectors, located in FLASH
350 bytes of monitor read-only memory (ROM)
674 bytes of FLASH program and erase routines, located in auxiliary ROM
2.2 Unimplemented Memory Locations
Accessing a reserved location can have unpredictable effects on MCU operation.
In Figure 2-1 and in register figures in this document, unimplemented locations are
shaded.
2.3 Reserved Memory Locations
Accessing a reserved location can have unpredictable effects on MCU operation.
In Figure 2-1 and in register figures in this document, reserved locations are
marked with the word Reserved or with the letter R.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
25
Memory
Memory
$0000
↓
$0051
I/O REGISTERS
81 BYTES
$0052
↓
$007F
UNIMPLEMENTED
47 BYTES
$0080
↓
$00FF
RAM
128 BYTES
$0100
↓
$2B7D
$0100
↓
$2B7D
UNIMPLEMENTED
10,878 BYTES
UNIMPLEMENTED
10,878 BYTES
$2B7E
↓
$2E1F
$2B7E
↓
$2E1F
AUXILIARY ROM
674 BYTES
AUXILIARY ROM
674 BYTES
$2E20
↓
$EDFF
$2E20
↓
UNIMPLEMENTED
49120 BYTES
UNIMPLEMENTED
51168 BYTES
$F5FF
$EE00
↓
FLASH MEMORY
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL3
4096 BYTES
$F600
↓
$FDFF
FLASH MEMORY
2048 BYTES
$FDFF
$FE00
↓
$FE0F
MISC REGISTERS
16 BYTES
MC68HC908QL2
MEMORY MAP
$FE00
↓
$FE0F
UNIMPLEMENTED
16 BYTES
$FE10
↓
$FF7D
MONITOR ROM
350 BYTES
$FF7E
↓
$FFBD
UNIMPLEMENTED
64 BYTES
$FFBE
↓
$FFC1
MISC REGISTERS
4 BYTES
$FFC2
↓
$FFCF
UNIMPLEMENTED
14 BYTES
$FFD0
↓
$FFFF
USER VECTORS
48 BYTES
Figure 2-1. Memory Map
Data Sheet
26
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Memory
Memory
Input/Output (I/O) Section
2.4 Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addresses $0000–$0051, shown in Figure 2-2, contain most of the control, status,
and data registers. Additional miscellaneous registers have these addresses:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
$FE00 — Break status register, BSR
$FE01 — Reset status register, SRSR
$FE02 — Break auxiliary register, BRKAR
$FE03 — Break flag control register, BFCR
$FE04 — Interrupt status register 1, INT1
$FE05 — Interrupt status register 2, INT2
$FE06 — Interrupt status register 3, INT3
$FE07 — Reserved
$FE08 — FLASH control register, FLCR
$FE09 — Break address register high, BRKH
$FE0A — Break address register low, BRKL
$FE0B — Break status and control register, BRKSCR
$FE0C — LVI status register, LVISR
$FE0D–$FE0F — Reserved
$FFBE — FLASH block protect register, FLBPR
$FFBF — Reserved
$FFC0 — Internal OSC trim value — Optional
$FFC1 — Reserved
$FFFF — COP control register, COPCTL
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
27
Memory
Memory
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTA0
U
Read:
0
AWUL
PTA2
Port A Data Register
PTA5
U
PTA4
U
PTA3
U
PTA1
U
$0000
(PTA) Write:
See page 114.
Reset:
Read:
U
0
U
Port B Data Register
PTB7
PTB6
PTB5
PTB4
PTB3
PTB2
PTB1
PTB0
$0001
$0002
$0003
(PTB) Write:
See page 117.
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Read:
0
0
0
Data Direction Register A
(DDRA) Write:
DDRA5
DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA1
DDRA0
$0004
$0005
See page 115.
Reset:
Read:
0
DDRB7
0
0
DDRB6
0
0
DDRB5
0
0
DDRB4
0
0
DDRB3
0
0
DDRB2
0
0
DDRB1
0
0
DDRB0
0
Data Direction Register B
(DDRB) Write:
See page 117.
Reset:
$0006
↓
$000A
Unimplemented
Read:
0
0
Port A Input Pullup Enable
OSC2EN
0
PTAPUE5 PTAPUE4 PTAPUE3 PTAPUE2 PTAPUE1 PTAPUE0
$000B
$000C
Register (PTAPUE) Write:
See page 116.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Port B Input Pullup Enable
PTBPUE7 PTBPUE6 PTBPUE5 PTBPUE4 PTBPUE3 PTBPUE2 PTBPUE1 PTBPUE0
Register (PTBPUE) Write:
See page 119.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
$000D
↓
$0019
Unimplemented
Read:
0
0
0
0
KEYF
0
ACKK
0
Keyboard Status and
Control Register (KBSCR) Write:
IMASKK
MODEK
$001A
See page 96.
Reset:
0
0
0
AWUIE
0
0
KBIE5
0
0
KBIE4
0
0
KBIE3
0
0
KBIE1
0
0
KBIE0
0
Read:
Keyboard Interrupt
Enable Register (KBIER) Write:
KBIE2
0
$001B
$001C
See page 97.
Reset:
0
Unimplemented
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
U = Unaffected
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 1 of 7)
Data Sheet
28
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Memory
Memory
Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
0
1
IMASK
0
Bit 0
MODE
0
Read:
0
0
0
0
IRQF
IRQ Status and Control
Register (INTSCR) Write:
$001D
ACK
0
See page 89.
Reset:
0
R
0
0
R
0
0
R
0
0
0
Read:
Configuration Register 2
OSCOPT1 OSCOPT0 IRQPUD
IRQEN
0
RSTEN
0(2)
$001E
(CONFIG2)(1) Write:
See page 64.
Reset:
0
0
0
1. One-time writable register after each reset.
2. RSTEN reset to 0 by a power-on reset (POR) only.
Read:
Configuration Register 1
COPRS
0
LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD LVI5OR3
0(2)
SSREC
0
STOP
0
COPD
0
$001F
(CONFIG1)(1) Write:
See page 64.
Reset:
0
0
0
1. One-time writable register after each reset.
2. LVI5OR3 reset to 0 by a power-on reset (POR) only.
Read:
TOF
0
0
0
TIM Status and Control
TOIE
TSTOP
PS2
PS1
PS0
$0020
$0021
$0022
$0023
$0024
$0025
$0026
Register (TSC) Write:
See page 197.
Reset:
TRST
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
Read:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
TIM Counter Register High
(TCNTH) Write:
See page 199.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TIM Counter Register
Low (TCNTL) Write:
See page 199.
Reset:
0
Bit 15
1
0
Bit 14
1
0
Bit 13
1
0
Bit 12
1
0
Bit 11
1
0
Bit 10
1
0
Bit 9
1
0
Bit 8
1
Read:
TIM Counter Modulo
Register High (TMODH) Write:
See page 199.
Reset:
Read:
TIM Counter Modulo
Register Low (TMODL) Write:
Bit 7
Bit 6
1
Bit 5
1
Bit 4
1
Bit 3
1
Bit 2
1
Bit 1
1
Bit 0
1
See page 199.
Reset:
1
CH0F
0
Read:
TIM Channel 0 Status and
Control Register (TSC0) Write:
CH0IE
0
MS0B
0
MS0A
0
ELS0B
0
ELS0A
0
TOV0
0
CH0MAX
0
See page 200.
Reset:
0
Read:
TIM Channel 0
Register High (TCH0H) Write:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
See page 203.
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
R
U = Unaffected
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 2 of 7)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
29
Memory
Memory
Addr.
Register Name
TIM Channel 0
Register Low (TCH0L) Write:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
$0027
See page 203.
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Read:
CH1F
0
TIM Channel 1 Status and
Control Register (TSC1) Write:
CH1IE
0
MS1A
0
ELS1B
0
ELS1A
0
TOV1
0
CH1MAX
$0028
$0029
$002A
0
0
See page 200.
Reset:
0
0
Read:
TIM Channel 1
Register High (TCH1H) Write:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
See page 203.
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 4 Bit 3
Indeterminate after reset
Read:
TIM Channel 1
Register Low (TCH1L) Write:
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
See page 203.
Reset:
$002B
↓
$0035
Unimplemented
Read:
ECGST
0
Oscillator Status and Control
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
BFS
0
ECGON
0
$0036
$0037
Register (OSCSTAT) Write:
See page 111.
Reset:
Unimplemented
Oscillator Trim Register Read:
(OSCTRIM)
TRIM7
1
TRIM6
0
TRIM5
0
TRIM4
0
TRIM3
0
TRIM2
0
TRIM1
0
TRIM0
0
Write:
$0038
See page 112.
Reset:
$0039
↓
$003B
Unimplemented
Read:
ADC Status and Control
Register (ADSCR) Write:
COCO
AIEN
ADCO
ADCH4
ADCH3
ADCH2
ADCH1
ADCH0
$003C
$003D
$003E
See page 52.
Reset:
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
ADC Data High Register
(ADRH) Write:
See page 53.
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Read:
AD1
AD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ADC Data Low Register
(ADRL) Write:
See page 53.
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
R
U = Unaffected
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 3 of 7)
Data Sheet
30
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Memory
Memory
Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
ADIV0
0
4
3
MODE1
0
2
MODE0
1
1
R
Bit 0
Read:
0
ADC Clock Register
ADIV2
ADIV1
ADICLK
$003F
(ADCLK) Write:
See page 55.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SLCIE
0
SLIC Control Register 1
INITREQ
WAKETX TXABRT
IMSG
$0040
$0041
$0042
$0043
$0044
$0045
$0046
$0047
$0048
$0049
$004A
(SLCC1) Write:
See page 147.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SLIC Control Register 2
SLCWCM
BTM
SLCE
0
(SLCC2) Write:
See page 148.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: SLCACT
INITACK
SLIC Status Register
(SLCS) Write:
SLCF
See page 149.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SLIC Prescale Register
RXFP1
RXFP0
(SLCP) Write:
See page 150.
Reset:
Read:
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
BT12
0
0
BT11
0
0
BT10
0
0
0
SLIC Bit Time Register High
BT9
0
BT8
(SLCBTH) Write:
See page 152.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
SLIC Bit Time Register Low
BT7
BT6
BT5
BT4
BT3
BT2
BT1
(SLCBTL) Write:
See page 152.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
I3
I2
I1
I0
SLIC State Vector Register
(SLCSV) Write:
See page 152.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SLIC Data Length Code
TXGO
CHKMOD
DLC5
DLC4
DLC3
DLC2
DLC1
DLC0
Register (SLCDLC) Write:
See page 157.
Reset:
0
R7
T7
0
0
R6
T6
0
0
R5
T5
0
0
R4
T4
0
0
0
R2
T2
0
0
R1
T1
0
0
R0
T0
0
Read:
R3
SLIC Identifier Register
(SLCID) Write:
See page 158.
Reset:
T3
0
Read:
R7
T7
0
R6
T6
0
R5
T5
0
R4
T4
0
R3
R2
T2
0
R1
T1
0
R0
T0
0
SLIC Data Register 7
(SLCD7) Write:
See page 159.
Reset:
T3
0
Read:
R7
T7
0
R6
T6
0
R5
T5
0
R4
T4
0
R3
R2
T2
0
R1
T1
0
R0
T0
0
SLIC Data Register 6
(SLCD6) Write:
See page 159.
Reset:
T3
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
U = Unaffected
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 4 of 7)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
31
Memory
Memory
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
R7
T7
0
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
SLIC Data Register 5
$004B
(SLCD5) Write:
See page 159.
Reset:
Read:
R7
T7
0
R6
T6
0
R5
T5
0
R4
T4
0
R3
T3
0
R2
T2
0
R1
T1
0
R0
T0
0
SLIC Data Register 4
$004C
$004D
$004E
$004F
$0050
(SLCD4) Write:
See page 159.
Reset:
Read:
R7
T7
0
R6
T6
0
R5
T5
0
R4
T4
0
R3
T3
0
R2
T2
0
R1
T1
0
R0
T0
0
SLIC Data Register 3
(SLCD3) Write:
See page 159.
Reset:
Read:
R7
T7
0
R6
T6
0
R5
T5
0
R4
T4
0
R3
T3
0
R2
T2
0
R1
T1
0
R0
T0
0
SLIC Data Register 2
(SLCD2) Write:
See page 159.
Reset:
Read:
R7
T7
0
R6
T6
0
R5
T5
0
R4
T4
0
R3
T3
0
R2
T2
0
R1
T1
0
R0
T0
0
SLIC Data Register 1
(SLCD1) Write:
See page 160.
Reset:
Read:
R7
T7
0
R6
T6
0
R5
T5
0
R4
T4
0
R3
T3
0
R2
T2
0
R1
T1
0
R0
T0
0
SLIC Data Register 0
(SLCD0) Write:
See page 160.
Reset:
$0051
↓
$005F
Unimplemented
Read:
SBSW
See note 1
0
Break Status Register
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
$FE00
(BSR) Write:
See page 211.
Reset:
1. Writing a 0 clears SBSW.
Read:
POR
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
MODRST
LVI
SIM Reset Status Register
$FE01
$FE02
$FE03
(SRSR) Write:
See page 137.
POR:
Read:
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Break Auxiliary
BDCOP
Register (BRKAR) Write:
See page 210.
Reset:
0
BCFE
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Break Flag Control
Register (BFCR) Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
See page 211.
Reset:
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
U = Unaffected
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 5 of 7)
Data Sheet
32
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Memory
Memory
Input/Output (I/O) Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
0
6
IF5
R
0
5
IF4
R
0
4
IF3
R
3
0
2
IF1
R
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Interrupt Status Register 1
$FE04
(INT1) Write:
R
R
R
0
R
See page 89.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
IF14
R
0
0
IF11
R
IF10
R
IF9
R
0
0
Interrupt Status Register 2
$FE05
(INT2) Write:
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
See page 89.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IF15
R
Interrupt Status Register 3
$FE06
$FE07
(INT3) Write:
R
R
0
R
0
R
R
R
R
0
See page 89.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Read:
0
0
0
0
FLASH Control Register
HVEN
0
MASS
0
ERASE
0
PGM
0
$FE08
$FE09
$FE0A
$FE0B
$FE0C
(FLCR) Write:
See page 37.
Reset:
Read:
0
Bit 15
0
0
Bit 14
0
0
Bit 13
0
0
Bit 12
0
Break Address High
Bit 11
0
Bit 10
0
Bit 9
0
Bit 8
0
Register (BRKH) Write:
See page 210.
Reset:
Read:
Break Address low
Register (BRKL) Write:
Bit 7
0
Bit 6
0
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
See page 210.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Break Status and Control
Register (BRKSCR) Write:
BRKE
BRKA
See page 209.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: LVIOUT
R
LVI Status Register
(LVISR) Write:
See page 101.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
$FE0D
↓
$FE0F
Reserved for FLASH Test
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
$FFB0
↓
$FFBD
Unimplemented
Read:
0
FLASH Block Protect
Register (FLBPR) Write:
BPR7
BPR6
BPR5
BPR4
BPR3
BPR2
BPR1
$FFBE
See page 43.
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
R
U = Unaffected
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 6 of 7)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
33
Memory
Memory
Addr.
Register Name
Unimplemented
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
$FFBF
Read:
Write:
Reset:
TRIM7
R
TRIM6
R
TRIM5
R
TRIM4
TRIM3
TRIM2
R
TRIM1
R
TRIM0
R
Internal Oscillator Trim
Value (Optional)
$FFC0
$FFC1
Unaffected by reset
Reserved
R
R
$FFC2
↓
$FFCF
Unimplemented
Read:
LOW BYTE OF RESET VECTOR
WRITING CLEARS COP COUNTER (ANY VALUE)
Unaffected by reset
COP Control Register
$FFFF
(COPCTL) Write:
See page 69.
Reset:
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
U = Unaffected
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 7 of 7)
Data Sheet
34
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Memory
Memory
Input/Output (I/O) Section
.
Table 2-1. Vector Addresses
Vector Priority
Vector
Address
Vector
$FFDE
$FFDF
$FFE0
$FFE1
ADC conversion complete vector (high)
ADC conversion complete vector (low)
Lowest
IF15
Keyboard vector (high)
Keyboard vector (low)
IF14
IF13
↓
—
Not used
IF10
$FFEA
$FFEB
SLIC vector (high)
SLIC vector (low)
IF9
IF8
↓
—
Not used
IF6
$FFF2
$FFF3
$FFF4
$FFF5
$FFF6
$FFF7
—
TIM overflow vector (high)
TIM overflow vector (low)
TIM channel 1 vector (high)
TIM channel 1 vector (low)
TIM channel 0 vector (high)
TIM channel 0 vector (low)
Not used
IF5
IF4
IF3
IF2
IF1
$FFFA
$FFFB
$FFFC
$FFFD
$FFFE
$FFFF
IRQ vector (high)
IRQ vector (low)
SWI vector (high)
—
—
SWI vector (low)
Reset vector (high)
Highest
Reset vector (low)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
35
Memory
Memory
2.5 Random-Access Memory (RAM)
Addresses $0080–$00FF are RAM locations. The location of the stack RAM is
programmable. The 16-bit stack pointer allows the stack to be anywhere in the
64-Kbyte memory space.
NOTE:
NOTE:
NOTE:
For correct operation, the stack pointer must point only to RAM locations.
Before processing an interrupt, the central processor unit (CPU) uses five bytes of
the stack to save the contents of the CPU registers.
For M6805, M146805, and M68HC05 compatibility, the H register is not stacked.
During a subroutine call, the CPU uses two bytes of the stack to store the return
address. The stack pointer decrements during pushes and increments during pulls.
Be careful when using nested subroutines. The CPU may overwrite data in the
RAM during a subroutine or during the interrupt stacking operation.
2.6 FLASH Memory (FLASH)
The FLASH memory consists of an array of 4096 or 2048 bytes with an additional
48 bytes for user vectors. The minimum size of FLASH memory that can be erased
is 64 bytes; and the maximum size of FLASH memory that can be programmed in
a program cycle is 32 bytes (a row). Program and erase operations are facilitated
through control bits in the FLASH control register (FLCR). Details for these
operations appear later in this section. The address ranges for the user memory
and vectors are:
•
$EE00 – $FDFF; user memory, 4096 bytes: MC68HC908QL4 and
MC68HC908QL3
•
•
$F600 – $FDFF; user memory, 2048 bytes: MC68HC908QL2
$FFD0 – $FFFF; user interrupt vectors, 48 bytes.
NOTE:
An erased bit reads as 1 and a programmed bit reads as 0. A security feature
prevents viewing of the FLASH contents.(1)
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading or
copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users.
Data Sheet
36
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Memory
MOTOROLA
Memory
FLASH Memory (FLASH)
2.6.1 FLASH Control Register
The FLASH control register (FLCR) controls FLASH program and erase
operations.
Address:
$FE08
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
HVEN
0
2
MASS
0
1
ERASE
0
Bit 0
PGM
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-3. FLASH Control Register (FLCR)
HVEN — High Voltage Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables high voltage from the charge pump to the memory
for either program or erase operation. It can only be set if either PGM =1 or
ERASE =1 and the proper sequence for program or erase is followed.
1 = High voltage enabled to array and charge pump on
0 = High voltage disabled to array and charge pump off
MASS — Mass Erase Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for mass erase operation.
1 = Mass Erase operation selected
0 = Mass Erase operation unselected
ERASE — Erase Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for erase operation. ERASE is
interlocked with the PGM bit such that both bits cannot be equal to 1 or set to 1
at the same time.
1 = Erase operation selected
0 = Erase operation unselected
PGM — Program Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for program operation. PGM is
interlocked with the ERASE bit such that both bits cannot be equal to 1 or set
to 1 at the same time.
1 = Program operation selected
0 = Program operation unselected
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
37
Memory
Memory
2.6.2 FLASH Page Erase Operation
Use the following procedure to erase a page of FLASH memory. A page consists
of 64 consecutive bytes starting from addresses $XX00, $XX40, $XX80, or $XXC0.
The 48-byte user interrupt vectors area also forms a page. Any FLASH memory
page can be erased alone.
1. Set the ERASE bit and clear the MASS bit in the FLASH control register.
2. Read the FLASH block protect register.
3. Write any data to any FLASH location within the address range of the block
to be erased.
4. Wait for a time, tNVS (minimum 10 µs).
5. Set the HVEN bit.
6. Wait for a time, tErase (minimum 1 ms or 4 ms).
7. Clear the ERASE bit.
8. Wait for a time, tNVH (minimum 5 µs).
9. Clear the HVEN bit.
10. After time, tRCV (typical 1 µs), the memory can be accessed in read mode
again.
NOTE:
Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by code being
executed from the FLASH memory. While these operations must be performed in
the order as shown, but other unrelated operations may occur between the steps.
CAUTION:
A page erase of the vector page will erase the internal oscillator trim value at
$FFC0.
In applications that require more than 1000 program/erase cycles, use the 4 ms
page erase specification to get improved long-term reliability. Any application can
use this 4 ms page erase specification. However, in applications where a FLASH
location will be erased and reprogrammed less than 1000 times, and speed is
important, use the 1 ms page erase specification to get a shorter cycle time.
Data Sheet
38
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Memory
MOTOROLA
Memory
FLASH Memory (FLASH)
2.6.3 FLASH Mass Erase Operation
Use the following procedure to erase the entire FLASH memory to read as 1:
1. Set both the ERASE bit and the MASS bit in the FLASH control register.
2. Read from the FLASH block protect register.
3. Write any data to any FLASH address(1) within the FLASH memory address
range.
4. Wait for a time, tNVS (minimum 10 µs).
5. Set the HVEN bit.
6. Wait for a time, tErase (minimum 4 ms).
7. Clear the ERASE and MASS bits.
NOTE:
Mass erase is disabled whenever any block is protected (FLBPR does not equal
$FF).
8. Wait for a time, tNVH (minimum 100 µs).
9. Clear the HVEN bit.
10. After time, tRCV (typical 1 µs), the memory can be accessed in read mode
again.
NOTE:
Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by code being
executed from the FLASH memory. While these operations must be performed in
the order as shown, but other unrelated operations may occur between the steps.
CAUTION:
A mass erase will erase the internal oscillator trim value at $FFC0.
1. When in monitor mode, with security sequence failed (see 16.3.2 Security), write to the FLASH
block protect register instead of any FLASH address.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
39
Memory
Memory
2.6.4 FLASH Program Operation
Programming of the FLASH memory is done on a row basis. A row consists of 32
consecutive bytes starting from addresses $XX00, $XX20, $XX40, $XX60, $XX80,
$XXA0, $XXC0, or $XXE0. Use the following step-by-step procedure to program a
row of FLASH memory
Figure 2-4 shows a flowchart of the programming algorithm.
NOTE:
Only bytes which are currently $FF may be programmed.
1. Set the PGM bit. This configures the memory for program operation and
enables the latching of address and data for programming.
2. Read from the FLASH block protect register.
3. Write any data to any FLASH location within the address range desired.
4. Wait for a time, tNVS (minimum 10 µs).
5. Set the HVEN bit.
6. Wait for a time, tPGS (minimum 5 µs).
7. Write data to the FLASH address being programmed(1).
8. Wait for time, tPROG (minimum 30 µs).
9. Repeat step 7 and 8 until all desired bytes within the row are programmed.
10. Clear the PGM bit(1).
11. Wait for time, tNVH (minimum 5 µs).
12. Clear the HVEN bit.
13. After time, tRCV (typical 1 µs), the memory can be accessed in read mode
again.
NOTE:
NOTE:
The COP register at location $FFFF should not be written between steps 5–12,
when the HVEN bit is set. Since this register is located at a valid FLASH address,
unpredictable behavior may occur if this location is written while HVEN is set.
This program sequence is repeated throughout the memory until all data is
programmed.
Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by code being
executed from the FLASH memory. While these operations must be performed in
the order shown, other unrelated operations may occur between the steps. Do not
exceed tPROG maximum, see 17.17 Memory Characteristics.
1. The time between each FLASH address change, or the time between the last FLASH address
programmed to clearing PGM bit, must not exceed the maximum programming time, tPROG
maximum.
Data Sheet
40
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Memory
MOTOROLA
Memory
FLASH Memory (FLASH)
2.6.5 FLASH Protection
Due to the ability of the on-board charge pump to erase and program the FLASH
memory in the target application, provision is made to protect blocks of memory
from unintentional erase or program operations due to system malfunction. This
protection is done by use of a FLASH block protect register (FLBPR). The FLBPR
determines the range of the FLASH memory which is to be protected. The range
of the protected area starts from a location defined by FLBPR and ends to the
bottom of the FLASH memory ($FFFF). When the memory is protected, the HVEN
bit cannot be set in either ERASE or PROGRAM operations.
NOTE:
In performing a program or erase operation, the FLASH block protect register must
be read after setting the PGM or ERASE bit and before asserting the HVEN bit.
When the FLBPR is programmed with all 0s, the entire memory is protected from
being programmed and erased. When all the bits are erased (all 1s), the entire
memory is accessible for program and erase.
When bits within the FLBPR are programmed, they lock a block of memory. The
address ranges are shown in 2.6.6 FLASH Block Protect Register. Once the
FLBPR is programmed with a value other than $FF, any erase or program of the
FLBPR or the protected block of FLASH memory is prohibited. Mass erase is
disabled whenever any block is protected (FLBPR does not equal $FF). The
FLBPR itself can be erased or programmed only with an external voltage, VTST
,
present on the IRQ pin. This voltage also allows entry from reset into the monitor
mode.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
41
Memory
Memory
Algorithm for Programming
a Row (32 Bytes) of FLASH Memory
1
2
3
SET PGM BIT
READ THE FLASH BLOCK PROTECT REGISTER
WRITE ANY DATA TO ANY FLASH ADDRESS
WITHIN THE ROW ADDRESS RANGE DESIRED
4
5
6
WAIT FOR A TIME, tNVS
SET HVEN BIT
WAIT FOR A TIME, tPGS
7
8
WRITE DATA TO THE FLASH ADDRESS
TO BE PROGRAMMED
WAIT FOR A TIME, tPROG
COMPLETED
Y
PROGRAMMING
THIS ROW?
9
N
10
CLEAR PGM BIT
WAIT FOR A TIME, tNVH
CLEAR HVEN BIT
11
12
13
NOTES:
The time between each FLASH address change (step 7to step 7),
or the time between the last FLASH address programmed
to clearing PGM bit (step 6 to step 10)
must not exceed the maximum programming
time, tPROG max.
WAIT FOR A TIME, tRCV
END OF PROGRAMMING
This row program algorithm assumes the row/s
to be programmed are initially erased.
Figure 2-4. FLASH Programming Flowchart
Data Sheet
42
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Memory
Memory
FLASH Memory (FLASH)
2.6.6 FLASH Block Protect Register
The FLASH block protect register is implemented as a byte within the FLASH
memory, and therefore can only be written during a programming sequence of the
FLASH memory. The value in this register determines the starting address of the
protected range within the FLASH memory.
Address: $FFBE
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
BPR7
BPR6
BPR5
BPR4
BPR3
BPR2
BPR1
BPR0
Unaffected by reset. Initial value from factory is 1.
Write to this register is by a programming sequence to the FLASH memory.
Figure 2-5. FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR)
BPR[7:0] — FLASH Protection Register Bits [7:0]
These eight bits in FLBPR represent bits [13:6] of a 16-bit memory address. Bits
[15:14] are 1s and bits [5:0] are 0s.
The resultant 16-bit address is used for specifying the start address of the
FLASH memory for block protection. The FLASH is protected from this start
address to the end of FLASH memory, at $FFFF. With this mechanism, the
protect start address can be XX00, XX40, XX80, or XXC0 within the FLASH
memory. See Figure 2-6 and Table 2-2.
16-BIT MEMORY ADDRESS
FLBPR VALUE
START ADDRESS OF
FLASH BLOCK PROTECT
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 2-6. FLASH Block Protect Start Address
Table 2-2. Examples of Protect Start Address
BPR[7:0]
Start of Address of Protect Range
The entire FLASH memory is protected.
$EE40 (1110 1110 0100 0000)
$EE80 (1110 1110 1000 0000)
$EEC0 (1110 1110 1100 0000)
$EF00 (1110 1111 0000 0000)
and so on...
$00–$B8
$B9 (1011 1001)
$BA (1011 1010)
$BB (1011 1011)
$BC (1011 1100)
$DE (1101 1110)
$DF (1101 1111)
$F780 (1111 0111 1000 0000)
$F7C0 (1111 0111 1100 0000)
$FF80 (1111 1111 1000 0000)
$FE (1111 1110)
FLBPR, OSCTRIM, and vectors are protected
$FF
The entire FLASH memory is not protected.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
43
Memory
Memory
2.6.7 Wait Mode
Putting the MCU into wait mode while the FLASH is in read mode does not affect
the operation of the FLASH memory directly, but there will not be any memory
activity since the CPU is inactive.
The WAIT instruction should not be executed while performing a program or erase
operation on the FLASH, or the operation will discontinue and the FLASH will be
on standby mode.
2.6.8 Stop Mode
Putting the MCU into stop mode while the FLASH is in read mode does not affect
the operation of the FLASH memory directly, but there will not be any memory
activity since the CPU is inactive.
The STOP instruction should not be executed while performing a program or erase
operation on the FLASH, or the operation will discontinue and the FLASH will be
on standby mode
NOTE:
Standby mode is the power-saving mode of the FLASH module in which all internal
control signals to the FLASH are inactive and the current consumption of the
FLASH is at a minimum.
Data Sheet
44
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Memory
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 3. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Features
This section describes the 10-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC).
Features of the ADC module include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Six channels with multiplexed input
Linear successive approximation with monotonicity
10-bit resolution
Single or continuous conversion
Conversion complete flag or conversion complete interrupt
Selectable ADC clock
Left or right justified result
Left justified sign data mode
3.3 Functional Description
The ADC provides six pins for sampling external sources. An analog multiplexer
allows the single ADC converter to select one of the ADC channels as ADC
voltage in (VADIN). VADIN is converted by the successive approximation
register-based analog-to-digital converter. When the conversion is completed,
ADC places the result in the ADC data register and sets a flag or generates an
interrupt. See Figure 3-2.
3.3.1 ADC Port I/O Pins
PTA0, PTA1, PTA4, PTA5, PTB2, and PTB3 are general-purpose I/O
(input/output) pins that share with the ADC channels. The channel select bits
define which ADC channel/port pin will be used as the input signal. The ADC
overrides the port I/O logic by forcing that pin as input to the ADC. The remaining
ADC channels/port pins are controlled by the port I/O logic and can be used as
general-purpose I/O. Writes to the port register or data direction register (DDR) will
not have any affect on the port pin that is selected by the ADC. A read of a port pin
in use by the ADC will return a 0.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
45
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
CLOCK
GENERATOR
(OSCILLATOR)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
SINGLE INTERRUPT
MODULE
M68HC08 CPU
PTB0/TCH0
PTB1
BREAK
MODULE
PTB2/AD4
PTB3/AD5
PTB4/SLCRX
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
PTB5/SLCTX
PTB6
KEYBOARD INTERRUPT
MODULE
PTB7
2-CH 16-BIT TIMER
MODULE
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL3: 4096 BYTES
MC68HC908QL2: 2048 BYTES
USER FLASH
SLAVE LIN INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
COP
MODULE
6-CHANNEL 10-BIT
ADC
MONITOR ROM
128 BYTES RAM
VDD
VSS
POWER SUPPLY
RST, IRQ: Pins have internal (about 30 kΩ) pull up
PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5: High current sink and source capability
PTA0–PTA5: Pins have programmable keyboard interrupt and pull up
ADC pins only available on MC68HC908QL4 and MC68HC908QL2
Figure 3-1. Block Diagram Highlighting ADC Block and Pins
Data Sheet
46
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Functional Description
INTERNAL
DATA BUS
READ DDRx
WRITE DDRx
DISABLE
DDRx
PTx
RESET
WRITE PTx
READ PTx
PTx
ADC CHANNEL x
DISABLE
ADC DATA REGISTER
ADC
VOLTAGE IN
(VADIN
CONVERSION
COMPLETE
ADCH4–ADCH0
)
CHANNEL
SELECT
INTERRUPT
ADC
LOGIC
ADC CLOCK
AIEN COCO
CGMXCLK
CLOCK
GENERATOR
BUS CLOCK
ADIV2–ADIV0 ADICLK
Figure 3-2. ADC Block Diagram
3.3.2 Voltage Conversion
When the input voltage to the ADC equals VREFH, the ADC converts the signal to
$3FF (full scale). If the input voltage equals VREFL, the ADC converts it to $000.
Input voltages between VREFH and VREFL are a straight-line linear conversion.
NOTE:
The ADC input voltage must always be greater than VSSA and less than VDDA
REFH must always be greater than or equal to VREFL
.
V
.
Connect the VDDA pin to the same voltage potential as the VDD pin, and connect
the VSSA pin to the same voltage potential as the VSS pin.
The VDDA pin should be routed carefully for maximum noise immunity.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
47
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
3.3.3 Conversion Time
Conversion starts after a write to the ADC status and control register (ADSCR).
One conversion will take between 16 and 17 ADC clock cycles. The ADIVx and
ADICLK bits should be set to provide a 1-MHz ADC clock frequency.
16 to 17 ADC cycles
Conversion time =
ADC frequency
Number of bus cycles = conversion time × bus frequency
3.3.4 Conversion
In continuous conversion mode, the ADC data register will be filled with new data
after each conversion. Data from the previous conversion will be overwritten
whether that data has been read or not. Conversions will continue until the ADCO
bit is cleared. The COCO bit is set after each conversion and will stay set until the
next write of the ADC status and control register or the next read of the ADC data
register.
In single conversion mode, conversion begins with a write to the ADSCR. Only one
conversion occurs between writes to the ADSCR.
3.3.5 Accuracy and Precision
The conversion process is monotonic and has no missing codes.
3.3.6 Result Justification
The conversion result may be formatted in four different ways:
1. Left justified
2. Right justified
3. Left Justified sign data mode
4. 8-bit truncation mode
All four of these modes are controlled using MODE0 and MODE1 bits located in
the ADC clock register (ADCLK).
Left justification will place the eight most significant bits (MSB) in the corresponding
ADC data register high, ADRH. This may be useful if the result is to be treated as
an 8-bit result where the two least significant bits (LSB), located in the ADC data
register low, ADRL, can be ignored. However, ADRL must be read after ADRH or
else the interlocking will prevent all new conversions from being stored.
Right justification will place only the two MSBs in the corresponding ADC data
register high, ADRH, and the eight LSBs in ADC data register low, ADRL. This
mode of operation typically is used when a 10-bit unsigned result is desired.
Data Sheet
48
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Functional Description
Left justified sign data mode is similar to left justified mode with one exception. The
MSB of the 10-bit result, AD9 located in ADRH, is complemented. This mode of
operation is useful when a result, represented as a signed magnitude from
mid-scale, is needed. Finally, 8-bit truncation mode will place the eight MSBs in the
ADC data register low, ADRL. The two LSBs are dropped. This mode of operation
is used when compatibility with 8-bit ADC designs are required. No interlocking
between ADRH and ADRL is present.
NOTE:
Quantization error is affected when only the most significant eight bits are used as
a result. See Figure 3-3.
8-BIT 10-BIT
RESULT RESULT
IDEAL 8-BIT CHARACTERISTIC
WITH QUANTIZATION = 1/2
10-BIT TRUNCATED
TO 8-BIT RESULT
003
00B
00A
009
IDEAL 10-BIT CHARACTERISTIC
WITH QUANTIZATION = 1/2
002
001
000
008
007
006
005
004
003
002
001
000
WHEN TRUNCATION IS USED,
ERROR FROM IDEAL 8-BIT = 3/8 LSB
DUE TO NON-IDEAL QUANTIZATION.
INPUT VOLTAGE
REPRESENTED AS 10-BIT
1/2
2 1/2
4 1/2
6 1/2
8 1/2
1 1/2
3 1/2
5 1/2
7 1/2
9 1/2
2 1/2
INPUT VOLTAGE
REPRESENTED AS 8-BIT
1/2
1 1/2
Figure 3-3. Bit Truncation Mode Error
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
49
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
3.4 Monotonicity
The conversion process is monotonic and has no missing codes.
3.5 Interrupts
When the AIEN bit is set, the ADC module is capable of generating CPU interrupts
after each ADC conversion. A CPU interrupt is generated if the COCO bit is at 0.
The COCO bit is not used as a conversion complete flag when interrupts are
enabled.
3.6 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instruction can put the MCU in low power-consumption
standby modes.
3.6.1 Wait Mode
The ADC continues normal operation during wait mode. Any enabled CPU interrupt
request from the ADC can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If the ADC is not
required to bring the MCU out of wait mode, power down the ADC by setting
ADCH4–ADCH0 bits in the ADC status and control register before executing the
WAIT instruction.
3.6.2 Stop Mode
3.7 I/O Signals
The ADC module is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. Any pending
conversion is aborted. ADC conversions resume when the MCU exits stop mode
after an external interrupt. Allow one conversion cycle to stabilize the analog
circuitry.
The ADC module has six pins shared with I/O pins on port A and port B.
3.7.1 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDAD
)
The ADC analog portion uses VDDAD as its power pin and is internally connected
to the VDD pad. External filtering may be necessary to ensure clean VDD for good
results.
NOTE:
For maximum noise immunity, route VDD carefully and place bypass capacitors as
close as possible to the package.
VDD and VDDA use the same pad on the MC68HC908QL4.
Data Sheet
50
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
3.7.2 ADC Analog Ground Pin (VSSAD
)
The ADC analog portion uses VSSAD as its ground pin and is internally connected
to the VSSAD pad.
NOTE:
Route VSS cleanly to avoid any offset errors.
VDD and VDDA use the same pad on the MC68HC908QL4.
3.7.3 ADC Voltage Reference High Pin (VREFH
)
The ADC analog portion uses VREFH as its upper voltage reference pin. By default,
connect the VREFH pin to the same voltage potential as VDD. External filtering is
often necessary to ensure a clean VREFH for good results. Any noise present on
this pin will be reflected and possibly magnified in A/D conversion values.
NOTE:
For maximum noise immunity, route VREFH carefully and place bypass capacitors
as close as possible to the package. Routing VREFH close and parallel to VREFL
may improve common mode noise rejection.
VDD and VREFH are connected on the MC68HC908QL4.
3.7.4 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL
)
The ADC analog portion uses VREFL as its lower voltage reference pin. By default,
connect the VREFL pin to the same voltage potential as VSS. External filtering is
often necessary to ensure a clean VREFL for good results. Any noise present on this
pin will be reflected and possibly magnified in A/D conversion values.
NOTE:
For maximum noise immunity, route VREFL carefully and, if not connected to VSS,
place bypass capacitors as close as possible to the package. Routing VREFH close
and parallel to VREFL may improve common mode noise rejection.
VSS and VREFL are connected on the MC68HC908QL4.
3.7.5 ADC Voltage In (VADIN
)
VADIN is the input voltage signal from one of the ADC channels to the ADC module.
3.8 I/O Registers
These I/O registers control and monitor ADC operation:
•
•
•
ADC status and control register (ADSCR)
ADC data register (ADRH and ADRL)
ADC clock register (ADCLK)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
51
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
3.8.1 ADC Status and Control Register
Function of the ADC status and control register (ADSCR) is described here.
Address:
$003C
Bit 7
6
AIEN
0
5
ADCO
0
4
ADCH4
1
3
ADCH3
1
2
ADCH2
1
1
ADCH1
1
Bit 0
ADCH0
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
COCO
0
Figure 3-4. ADC Status and Control Register (ADSCR)
COCO — Conversions Complete Bit
When the AIEN bit is 0, the COCO is a read-only bit which is set each time a
conversion is completed except in the continuous conversion mode where it is
set after the first conversion. This bit is cleared whenever the ADSCR is written
or whenever the ADR is read.
If the AIEN bit is 1, the COCO becomes a read/write bit, which should be cleared
to 0 for CPU to service the ADC interrupt request. Reset clears this bit.
1 = Conversion completed (AIEN = 0)
0 = Conversion not completed (AIEN = 0)/CPU interrupt (AIEN = 1)
AIEN — ADC Interrupt Enable Bit
When this bit is set, an interrupt is generated at the end of an ADC conversion.
The interrupt signal is cleared when the data register is read or the status/control
register is written. Reset clears the AIEN bit.
1 = ADC interrupt enabled
0 = ADC interrupt disabled
ADCO — ADC Continuous Conversion Bit
When set, the ADC will convert samples continuously and update the ADR
register at the end of each conversion. Only one conversion is completed
between writes to the ADSCR when this bit is cleared. Reset clears the
ADCO bit.
1 = Continuous ADC conversion
0 = One ADC conversion
ADCH4–ADCH0 — ADC Channel Select Bits
ADCH4–ADCH0 form a 5-bit field which is used to select one of 16 ADC
channels. Only eight channels, AD7–AD0, are available on this MCU. The
channels are detailed in Table 3-1. Care should be taken when using a port pin
as both an analog and digital input simultaneously to prevent switching noise
from corrupting the analog signal.
The ADC subsystem is turned off when the channel select bits are all set to 1.
This feature allows for reduced power consumption for the MCU when the ADC
is not being used.
NOTE:
Recovery from the disabled state requires one conversion cycle to stabilize.
Data Sheet
52
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
The voltage levels supplied from internal reference nodes, as specified in
Table 3-1, are used to verify the operation of the ADC converter both in production
test and for user applications.
Table 3-1. Mux Channel Select(1)
ADCH4
ADCH3
ADCH2
ADCH1
ADCH0
Input Select
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA1/AD1/KBI1
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI2
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
PTB2/AD4
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
PTB3/AD5
0
↓
1
0
↓
1
1
↓
1
1
↓
0
0
↓
0
Unused
VDDA
VSSA
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
ADC power off
1. If any unused channels are selected, the resulting ADC conversion will be unknown or
reserved.
3.8.2 ADC Data Register High and Data Register Low
3.8.2.1 Left Justified Mode
In left justified mode, the ADRH register holds the eight MSBs of the 10-bit result.
The only difference from left justified mode is that the AD9 is complemented. The
ADRL register holds the two LSBs of the 10-bit result. All other bits read as 0.
ADRH and ADRL are updated each time an ADC single channel conversion
completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL until ADRL is read. All
subsequent results will be lost until the ADRH and ADRL reads are completed.
Address:
$003D
Bit 7
ADRH
Bit 0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Read:
Write:
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
Reset:
Address:
Read:
Unaffected by reset
$003E
AD1
ADRL
0
AD0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
= Unimplemented
Figure 3-5. ADC Data Register High (ADRH) and Low (ADRL)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
53
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
3.8.2.2 Right Justified Mode
In right justified mode, the ADRH register holds the two MSBs of the 10-bit result.
All other bits read as 0. The ADRL register holds the eight LSBs of the 10-bit result.
ADRH and ADRL are updated each time an ADC single channel conversion
completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL until ADRL is read. All
subsequent results will be lost until the ADRH and ADRL reads are completed.
Address:
$003D
Bit 7
0
ADRH
Bit 0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
Read:
Write:
AD9
AD8
Reset:
Address:
Read:
Unaffected by reset
$003E
AD7
ADRL
AD0
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
= Unimplemented
Figure 3-6. ADC Data Register High (ADRH) and Low (ADRL)
3.8.2.3 Left Justified Signed Data Mode
In left justified signed data mode, the ADRH register holds the eight MSBs of the
10-bit result. The only difference from left justified mode is that the AD9 is
complemented. The ADRL register holds the two LSBs of the 10-bit result. All other
bits read as 0. ADRH and ADRL are updated each time an ADC single channel
conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL until ADRL is
read. All subsequent results will be lost until the ADRH and ADRL reads are
completed.
Address:
$003D
Bit 7
ADRH
Bit 0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Read:
Write:
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
Reset:
Address:
Read:
Unaffected by reset
$003E
AD1
ADRL
0
AD0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
= Unimplemented
Figure 3-7. ADC Data Register High (ADRH) and Low (ADRL)
Data Sheet
54
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
3.8.2.4 Eight Bit Truncation Mode
In 8-bit truncation mode, the ADRL register holds the eight MSBs of the 10-bit
result. The ADRH register is unused and reads as 0. The ADRL register is updated
each time an ADC single channel conversion completes. In 8-bit mode, the ADRL
register contains no interlocking with ADRH.
Address:
$003D
Bit 7
0
ADRH
Bit 0
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Address:
Read:
Unaffected by reset
$003E
AD9
ADRL
AD2
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
= Unimplemented
Figure 3-8. ADC Data Register High (ADRH) and Low (ADRL)
3.8.3 ADC Clock Register
The ADC clock register (ADCLK) selects the clock frequency for the ADC.
Address:
$003F
Bit 7
6
ADIV1
0
5
ADIV0
0
4
3
2
MODE0
1
1
R
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
ADIV2
0
ADICLK
MODE1
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 3-9. ADC Clock Register (ADCLK)
ADIV2–ADIV0 — ADC Clock Prescaler Bits
ADIV2–ADIV0 form a 3-bit field which selects the divide ratio used by the ADC
to generate the internal ADC clock. Table 3-2 shows the available clock
configurations. The ADC clock should be set to approximately 1 MHz.
Table 3-2. ADC Clock Divide Ratio
ADIV2
ADIV1
ADIV0
ADC Clock Rate
ADC input clock ÷ 1
ADC input clock ÷ 2
ADC input clock ÷ 4
ADC input clock ÷ 8
ADC input clock ÷ 16
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
X(1)
X(1)
1. X = Don’t care
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
55
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
ADICLK — ADC Input Clock Select Bit
ADICLK selects either the bus clock or the oscillator output clock (CGMXCLK)
as the input clock source to generate the internal ADC clock. Reset selects
CGMXCLK as the ADC clock source.
1 = Internal bus clock
0 = Oscillator output clock (CGMXCLK)
The ADC requires a clock rate of approximately 1 MHz for correct operation.
If the selected clock source is not fast enough, the ADC will generate incorrect
conversions. See 17.14 5.0-Volt ADC Characteristics.
f
CGMXCLK or bus frequency
ADIV[2:0]
fADIC
=
≅ 1 MHz
MODE1 and MODE0 — Modes of Result Justification Bits
MODE1 and MODE0 select among four modes of operation. The manner in
which the ADC conversion results will be placed in the ADC data registers is
controlled by these modes of operation. Reset returns right-justified mode.
00 = 8-bit truncation mode
01 = Right justified mode
10 = Left justified mode
11 = Left justified signed data mode
Data Sheet
56
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 4. Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
4.1 Introduction
This section describes the auto wakeup module (AWU). The AWU generates a
periodic interrupt during stop mode to wake the part up without requiring an
external signal. Figure 4-2 is a block diagram of the AWU.
4.2 Features
Features of the auto wakeup module include:
•
One internal interrupt with separate interrupt enable bit, sharing the same
keyboard interrupt vector and keyboard interrupt
mask bit.
•
•
•
Exit from low-power stop mode without external signals.
Selectable timeout periods of 16 milliseconds or 512 milliseconds.
Dedicated low power internal oscillator separate from the main system clock
sources.
Figure 4-1 provides a summary of the input/output (I/O) registers used in
conjuction with the AWU.
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
AWUL
PTA2
Port A Data Register
(PTA) Write:
See page 60.
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA1
PTA0
$0000
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Keyboard Status Read:
and Control Register
0
0
0
0
0
0
KEYF
0
IMASKK
0
MODEK
0
Write:
ACKK
$001A
$001B
(KBSCR)
See page 60.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
Keyboard Interrupt Enable
AWUIE
0
KBIE5
0
KBIE4
0
KBIE3
0
KBIE2
0
KBIE1
0
KBIE0
0
Register (KBIER) Write:
See page 61.
Reset:
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 4-1. AWU Register Summary
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
57
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
4.3 Functional Description
The function of the auto wakeup logic is to generate periodic wakeup requests to
bring the microcontroller unit (MCU) out of stop mode. The wakeup requests are
treated as regular keyboard interrupt requests, with the difference that instead of a
pin, the interrupt signal is generated by an internal logic.
Writing the AWUIE bit in the keyboard interrupt enable register enables or disables
the auto wakeup interrupt input (see Figure 4-2). A logic 1 applied to the
AWUIREQ input with auto wakeup interrupt request enabled, latches an auto
wakeup interrupt request.
Auto wakeup latch, AWUL, can be read directly from the bit 6 position of port A data
register (PTA). This is a read-only bit which is occupying an empty bit position on
PTA. No PTA associated registers, such as PTA6 data direction or PTA6 pullup
exist for this bit.
Entering stop mode will enable the auto wakeup generation logic. An internal RC
oscillator (exclusive for the auto wakeup feature) drives the wakeup request
generator. Once the overflow count is reached in the generator counter, a wakeup
request, AWUIREQ, is latched and sent to the KBI logic. See Figure 4-1.
COPRS (FROM CONFIG1)
VDD
AUTOWUGEN
TO PTA READ, BIT 6
1 = DIV 29
D
E
AWUL
Q
SHORT
0 = DIV 214
INT RC OSC
EN 32 kHz
OVERFLOW
AWUIREQ
R
CLK
RST
TO KBI INTERRUPT LOGIC
(SEE Figure 9-3. Keyboard
Interrupt Block Diagram)
CLRLOGIC
CLEAR
RESET
ACKK
(CGMXCLK)
BUSCLKX4
CLK
RST
RESET
ISTOP
RESET
AWUIE
Figure 4-2. Auto Wakeup Interrupt Request Generation Logic
Data Sheet
58
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
Wait Mode
Entering stop mode will enable the auto wakeup generation logic. An internal RC
oscillator (exclusive for the auto wakeup feature) drives the wakeup request
generator. Once the overflow count is reached in the generator counter, a wakeup
request, AWUIREQ, is latched and sent to the KBI logic. See Figure 4-1.
Wakeup interrupt requests will only be serviced if the associated interrupt enable
bit, AWUIE, in KBIER is set. The AWU shares the keyboard interrupt vector.
The overflow count can be selected from two options defined by the COPRS bit in
CONFIG1. This bit was “borrowed” from the computer operating properly (COP)
using the fact that the COP feature is idle (no MCU clock available) in stop mode.
The typical values of the periodic wakeup request are (at room temperature):
•
•
COPRS = 0: 650 ms @ 5 V, 950 ms @ 3 V
COPRS = 1: 16 ms @ 5 V, 23 ms @ 3 V
The auto wakeup RC oscillator is highly dependent on operating voltage and
temperature. This feature is not recommended for use as a time-keeping function.
The wakeup request is latched to allow the interrupt source identification. The
latched value, AWUL, can be read directly from the bit 6 position of PTA data
register. This is a read-only bit which is occupying an empty bit position on PTA.
No PTA associated registers, such as PTA6 data, PTA6 direction, and PTA6 pullup
exist for this bit. The latch can be cleared by writing to the ACKK bit in the KBSCR
register. Reset also clears the latch. AWUIE bit in KBI interrupt enable register (see
Figure 4-2) has no effect on AWUL reading.
The AWU oscillator and counters are inactive in normal operating mode and
become active only upon entering stop mode.
4.4 Wait Mode
4.5 Stop Mode
The AWU module remains inactive in wait mode.
When the AWU module is enabled (AWUIE = 1 in the keyboard interrupt enable
register) it is activated automatically upon entering stop mode. Clearing the
IMASKK bit in the keyboard status and control register enables keyboard interrupt
requests to bring the MCU out of stop mode. The AWU counters start from ‘0’ each
time stop mode is entered.
4.6 Input/Output Registers
The AWU shares registers with the keyboard interrupt (KBI) module and the port A
I/O module. The following I/O registers control and monitor operation of the AWU:
•
•
•
Port A data register (PTA)
Keyboard interrupt status and control register (KBSCR)
Keyboard interrupt enable register (KBIER)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
59
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
4.6.1 Port A I/O Register
The port A data register (PTA) contains a data latch for the state of the AWU
interrupt request, in addition to the data latches for port A.
Address: $0000
Bit 7
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
AWUL
PTA2
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA1
PTA0
0
0
Unaffected by reset
= Unimplemented
Figure 4-3. Port A Data Register (PTA)
AWUL — Auto Wakeup Latch
This is a read-only bit which has the value of the auto wakeup interrupt request
latch. The wakeup request signal is generated internally. There is no PTA6 port
or any of the associated bits such as PTA6 data direction or pullup bits.
1 = Auto wakeup interrupt request is pending
0 = Auto wakeup interrupt request is not pending
NOTE:
PTA5–PTA0 bits are not used in conjuction with the auto wakeup feature. To see
a description of these bits, see 12.2.1 Port A Data Register.
4.6.2 Keyboard Status and Control Register
The keyboard status and control register (KBSCR):
•
•
•
Flags keyboard/auto wakeup interrupt requests
Acknowledges keyboard/auto wakeup interrupt requests
Masks keyboard/auto wakeup interrupt requests
Address: $001A
Bit 7
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
2
1
IMASKK
0
Bit 0
MODEK
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
KEYF
0
ACKK
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 4-4. Keyboard Status and Control Register (KBSCR)
Bits 7–4 — Not used
These read-only bits always read as 0s.
KEYF — Keyboard Flag Bit
This read-only bit is set when a keyboard interrupt is pending on port A or auto
wakeup. Reset clears the KEYF bit.
1 = Keyboard/auto wakeup interrupt pending
0 = No keyboard/auto wakeup interrupt pending
Data Sheet
60
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
MOTOROLA
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
Input/Output Registers
ACKK — Keyboard Acknowledge Bit
Writing a 1 to this write-only bit clears the keyboard/auto wakeup interrupt
request on port A and auto wakeup logic. ACKK always reads as 0. Reset clears
ACKK.
IMASKK— Keyboard Interrupt Mask Bit
Writing a 1 to this read/write bit prevents the output of the keyboard interrupt
mask from generating interrupt requests on port A or auto wakeup. Reset clears
the IMASKK bit.
1 = Keyboard/auto wakeup interrupt requests masked
0 = Keyboard/auto wakeup interrupt requests not masked
NOTE:
MODEK is not used in conjuction with the auto wakeup feature. To see a
description of this bit, see 9.7.1 Keyboard Status and Control Register.
4.6.3 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register
The keyboard interrupt enable register (KBIER) enables or disables the auto
wakeup to operate as a keyboard/auto wakeup interrupt input.
Address: $001B
Bit 7
0
6
AWUIE
0
5
KBIE5
0
4
KBIE4
0
3
KBIE3
0
2
KBIE2
0
1
KBIE1
0
Bit 0
KBIE0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 4-5. Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register (KBIER)
AWUIE — Auto Wakeup Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the auto wakeup interrupt input to latch interrupt
requests. Reset clears AWUIE.
1 = Auto wakeup enabled as interrupt input
0 = Auto wakeup not enabled as interrupt input
NOTE:
KBIE5–KBIE0 bits are not used in conjuction with the auto wakeup feature. To see
a description of these bits, see 9.7.2 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
61
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
Data Sheet
62
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)
5.1 Introduction
This section describes the configuration registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2). The
configuration registers enable or disable the following options:
•
Stop mode recovery time (32 × BUSCLKX4 cycles or
4096 × BUSCLKX4 cycles)
•
•
•
STOP instruction
Computer operating properly module (COP)
COP reset period (COPRS): (213–24) × BUSCLKX4 or
(218–24) × BUSCLKX4
•
•
•
•
•
Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) enable and trip voltage selection
OSC option selection
IRQ pin
RST pin
Auto wakeup timeout period
5.2 Functional Description
The configuration registers are used in the initialization of various options. The
configuration registers can be written once after each reset. Most of the
configuration register bits are cleared during reset. Since the various options affect
the operation of the microcontroller unit (MCU) it is recommended that this register
be written immediately after reset. The configuration register is located at $001E
and $001F, and may be read at anytime.
NOTE:
The CONFIG registers are one-time writable by the user after each reset. Upon a
reset, the CONFIG registers default to predetermined settings as shown in
Figure 5-1 and Figure 5-2.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
63
Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)
Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)
$001E
Address:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
R
R
R
OSCOPT1 OSCOPT0 IRQPUD
IRQEN
RSTEN
Reset:
POR:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
0
= Reserved
U = Unaffected
R
Figure 5-1 Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2)
OSCOPT1 and OSCOPT0 — Selection Bits for Oscillator Option
(0, 0) Internal oscillator
(0, 1) External oscillator
(1, 0) External RC oscillator
(1, 1) External XTAL oscillator
IRQPUD — IRQ Pin Pullup Control Bit
1 = Internal pullup is disconnected
0 = Internal pullup is connected between IRQ pin and VDD
IRQEN — IRQ Pin Function Selection Bit
1 = Interrupt request function active in pin
0 = Interrupt request function inactive in pin
RSTEN — RST Pin Function Selection
1 = Reset function active in pin
0 = Reset function inactive in pin
NOTE:
The RSTEN bit is cleared by a power-on reset (POR) only. Other resets will leave
this bit unaffected.
$001F
Address:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
COPRS
LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD LVI5OR3
SSREC
STOP
COPD
Reset:
POR:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
U = Unaffected
Figure 5-2 Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1)
COPRS (Out of STOP Mode) — COP Reset Period Selection Bit
1 = COP reset short cycle = (213 – 24) × BUSCLKX4
0 = COP reset long cycle = (218 – 24) × BUSCLKX4
COPRS (In STOP Mode) — Auto Wakeup Period Selection Bit
1 = Auto wakeup short cycle = (29) × INTRCOSC
0 = Auto wakeup long cycle = (214) × INTRCOSC
Data Sheet
64
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)
Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)
Functional Description
LVISTOP — LVI Enable in Stop Mode Bit
When the LVIPWRD bit is clear, setting the LVISTOP bit enables the LVI to
operate during stop mode. Reset clears LVISTOP.
1 = LVI enabled during stop mode
0 = LVI disabled during stop mode
LVIRSTD — LVI Reset Disable Bit
LVIRSTD disables the reset signal from the LVI module.
1 = LVI module resets disabled
0 = LVI module resets enabled
LVIPWRD — LVI Power Disable Bit
LVIPWRD disables the LVI module.
1 = LVI module power disabled
0 = LVI module power enabled
LVI5OR3 — LVI 5-V or 3.3-V Operating Mode Bit
LVI5OR3 selects the voltage operating mode of the LVI module. The voltage
mode selected for the LVI should match the operating VDD for the LVI’s voltage
trip points for each of the modes.
1 = LVI operates in 5-V mode
0 = LVI operates in 3.3-V mode
NOTE:
NOTE:
The LVI5OR3 bit is cleared by a power-on reset (POR) only. Other resets will leave
this bit unaffected.
SSREC — Short Stop Recovery Bit
SSREC enables the CPU to exit stop mode with a delay of 32 BUSCLKX4
cycles instead of a 4096 BUSCLKX4 cycle delay.
1 = Stop mode recovery after 32 BUSCLKX4 cycles
0 = Stop mode recovery after 4096 BUSCLKX4 cycles
Exiting stop mode by an LVI reset will result in the long stop recovery.
When using the LVI during normal operation but disabling during stop mode, the
LVI will have an enable time of tEN. The system stabilization time for power-on
reset and long stop recovery (both 4096 BUSCLKX4 cycles) gives a delay
longer than the LVI enable time for these startup scenarios. There is no period
where the MCU is not protected from a low-power condition. However, when
using the short stop recovery configuration option, the 32 BUSCLKX4 delay
must be greater than the LVI’s turn on time to avoid a period in startup where
the LVI is not protecting the MCU.
STOP — STOP Instruction Enable Bit
STOP enables the STOP instruction.
1 = STOP instruction enabled
0 = STOP instruction treated as illegal opcode
COPD — COP Disable Bit
COPD disables the COP module.
1 = COP module disabled
0 = COP module enabled
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
65
Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)
Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)
Data Sheet
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
66
Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 6. Computer Operating Properly (COP)
6.1 Introduction
The computer operating properly (COP) module contains a free-running counter
that generates a reset if allowed to overflow. The COP module helps software
recover from runaway code. Prevent a COP reset by clearing the COP counter
periodically. The COP module can be disabled through the COPD bit in the
configuration 1 (CONFIG1) register.
6.2 Functional Description
SIM MODULE
SIM RESET CIRCUIT
12-BIT SIM COUNTER
BUSCLKX4
RESET STATUS REGISTER
INTERNAL RESET SOURCES(1)
RESET VECTOR FETCH
COPCTL WRITE
COP CLOCK
COP MODULE
6-BIT COP COUNTER
COPEN (FROM SIM)
COPD (FROM CONFIG1)
CLEAR
COP COUNTER
RESET
COPCTL WRITE
COP RATE SELECT
(COPRS FROM CONFIG1)
1. See Section 13. System Integration Module (SIM) for more details.
Figure 6-1. COP Block Diagram
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Data Sheet
67
MOTOROLA
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
The COP counter is a free-running 6-bit counter preceded by the 12-bit system
integration module (SIM) counter. If not cleared by software, the COP counter
overflows and generates an asynchronous reset after 218 – 24 or 213 – 24
BUSCLKX4 cycles; depending on the state of the COP rate select bit, COPRS, in
configuration register 1. With a 218 – 24 BUSCLKX4 cycle overflow option, a 8-MHz
crystal gives a COP timeout period of 32.766 ms. Writing any value to location
$FFFF before an overflow occurs prevents a COP reset by clearing the COP
counter and stages 12–5 of the SIM counter.
NOTE:
NOTE:
Service the COP immediately after reset and before entering or after exiting stop
mode to guarantee the maximum time before the first COP counter overflow.
A COP reset pulls the RST pin low (if the RSTEN bit is set in the CONFIG1 register)
for 32 × BUSCLKX4 cycles and sets the COP bit in the reset status register (RSR).
See 13.8.1 SIM Reset Status Register.
Place COP clearing instructions in the main program and not in an interrupt
subroutine. Such an interrupt subroutine could keep the COP from generating a
reset even while the main program is not working properly.
6.3 I/O Signals
6.3.1 BUSCLKX4
The following paragraphs describe the signals shown in Figure 6-1.
BUSCLKX4 is the oscillator output signal. BUSCLKX4 frequency is equal to the
crystal frequency or the RC-oscillator frequency.
6.3.2 COPCTL Write
Writing any value to the COP control register (COPCTL) (see 6.4 COP Control
Register) clears the COP counter and clears bits 12–5 of the SIM counter.
Reading the COP control register returns the low byte of the reset vector.
6.3.3 Power-On Reset
The power-on reset (POR) circuit in the SIM clears the SIM counter
4096 × BUSCLKX4 cycles after power up.
6.3.4 Internal Reset
An internal reset clears the SIM counter and the COP counter.
6.3.5 Reset Vector Fetch
A reset vector fetch occurs when the vector address appears on the data bus.
A reset vector fetch clears the SIM counter.
Data Sheet
68
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
COP Control Register
6.3.6 COPD (COP Disable)
The COPD signal reflects the state of the COP disable bit (COPD) in the
configuration register (CONFIG). See Section 5. Configuration Registers
(CONFIG1 and CONFIG2).
6.3.7 COPRS (COP Rate Select)
The COPRS signal reflects the state of the COP rate select bit (COPRS) in the
configuration register 1 (CONFIG1). See Section 5. Configuration Registers
(CONFIG1 and CONFIG2).
6.4 COP Control Register
The COP control register (COPCTL) is located at address $FFFF and overlaps the
reset vector. Writing any value to $FFFF clears the COP counter and starts a new
timeout period. Reading location $FFFF returns the low byte of the reset vector.
Address: $FFFF
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
LOW BYTE OF RESET VECTOR
CLEAR COP COUNTER
Unaffected by reset
Figure 6-2. COP Control Register (COPCTL)
6.5 Interrupts
The COP does not generate CPU interrupt requests.
6.6 Monitor Mode
The COP is disabled in monitor mode when VTST is present on the IRQ pin.
6.7 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby
modes.
6.7.1 Wait Mode
The COP remains active during wait mode. If COP is enabled, a reset will occur at
COP timeout.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
69
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
6.7.2 Stop Mode
Stop mode turns off the BUSCLKX4 input to the COP and clears the SIM counter.
Service the COP immediately before entering or after exiting stop mode to ensure
a full COP timeout period after entering or exiting stop mode.
6.8 COP Module During Break Mode
The COP is disabled during a break interrupt with monitor mode when BDCOP bit
is set in break auxiliary register (BRKAR).
Data Sheet
70
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 7. Central Processor Unit (CPU)
7.1 Introduction
The M68HC08 CPU (central processor unit) is an enhanced and fully
object-code-compatible version of the M68HC05 CPU. The CPU08 Reference
Manual (Motorola document order number CPU08RM/AD) contains a description
of the CPU instruction set, addressing modes, and architecture.
7.2 Features
Features of the CPU include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Object code fully upward-compatible with M68HC05 Family
16-bit stack pointer with stack manipulation instructions
16-bit index register with x-register manipulation instructions
8-MHz CPU internal bus frequency
64-Kbyte program/data memory space
16 addressing modes
Memory-to-memory data moves without using accumulator
Fast 8-bit by 8-bit multiply and 16-bit by 8-bit divide instructions
Enhanced binary-coded decimal (BCD) data handling
Modular architecture with expandable internal bus definition for extension of
addressing range beyond 64 Kbytes
•
Low-power stop and wait modes
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
71
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
7.3 CPU Registers
Figure 7-1 shows the five CPU registers. CPU registers are not part of the memory
map.
7
0
0
0
0
ACCUMULATOR (A)
15
15
15
H
X
INDEX REGISTER (H:X)
STACK POINTER (SP)
PROGRAM COUNTER (PC)
CONDITION CODE REGISTER (CCR)
7
0
V
1
1
H
I
N
Z
C
CARRY/BORROW FLAG
ZERO FLAG
NEGATIVE FLAG
INTERRUPT MASK
HALF-CARRY FLAG
TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW FLAG
Figure 7-1. CPU Registers
7.3.1 Accumulator
The accumulator is a general-purpose 8-bit register. The CPU uses the
accumulator to hold operands and the results of arithmetic/logic operations.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Figure 7-2. Accumulator (A)
Data Sheet
72
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
CPU Registers
7.3.2 Index Register
The 16-bit index register allows indexed addressing of a 64-Kbyte memory space.
H is the upper byte of the index register, and X is the lower byte. H:X is the
concatenated 16-bit index register.
In the indexed addressing modes, the CPU uses the contents of the index register
to determine the conditional address of the operand.
The index register can serve also as a temporary data storage location.
Bit
15 14 13 12 11 10
Bit
0
9
0
8
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X = Indeterminate
Figure 7-3. Index Register (H:X)
7.3.3 Stack Pointer
The stack pointer is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next location
on the stack. During a reset, the stack pointer is preset to $00FF. The reset stack
pointer (RSP) instruction sets the least significant byte to $FF and does not affect
the most significant byte. The stack pointer decrements as data is pushed onto the
stack and increments as data is pulled from the stack.
In the stack pointer 8-bit offset and 16-bit offset addressing modes, the stack
pointer can function as an index register to access data on the stack. The CPU
uses the contents of the stack pointer to determine the conditional address of the
operand.
Bit
15 14 13 12 11 10
Bit
0
9
0
8
0
7
1
6
1
5
1
4
1
3
1
2
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
Figure 7-4. Stack Pointer (SP)
The location of the stack is arbitrary and may be relocated anywhere in
NOTE:
random-access memory (RAM). Moving the SP out of page 0 ($0000 to $00FF)
frees direct address (page 0) space. For correct operation, the stack pointer must
point only to RAM locations.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
73
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
7.3.4 Program Counter
The program counter is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next
instruction or operand to be fetched.
Normally, the program counter automatically increments to the next sequential
memory location every time an instruction or operand is fetched. Jump, branch,
and interrupt operations load the program counter with an address other than that
of the next sequential location.
During reset, the program counter is loaded with the reset vector address located
at $FFFE and $FFFF. The vector address is the address of the first instruction to
be executed after exiting the reset state.
Bit
15 14 13 12 11 10
Bit
0
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Loaded with vector from $FFFE and $FFFF
Figure 7-5. Program Counter (PC)
7.3.5 Condition Code Register
The 8-bit condition code register contains the interrupt mask and five flags that
indicate the results of the instruction just executed. Bits 6 and 5 are set
permanently to 1. The following paragraphs describe the functions of the condition
code register.
Bit 7
V
6
1
1
5
1
1
4
H
X
3
I
2
N
X
1
Z
X
Bit 0
C
Read:
Write:
Reset:
X
1
X
X = Indeterminate
Figure 7-6. Condition Code Register (CCR)
V — Overflow Flag
The CPU sets the overflow flag when a two's complement overflow occurs. The
signed branch instructions BGT, BGE, BLE, and BLT use the overflow flag.
1 = Overflow
0 = No overflow
Data Sheet
74
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
CPU Registers
H — Half-Carry Flag
The CPU sets the half-carry flag when a carry occurs between accumulator bits
3 and 4 during an add-without-carry (ADD) or add-with-carry (ADC) operation.
The half-carry flag is required for binary-coded decimal (BCD) arithmetic
operations. The DAA instruction uses the states of the H and C flags to
determine the appropriate correction factor.
1 = Carry between bits 3 and 4
0 = No carry between bits 3 and 4
I — Interrupt Mask
When the interrupt mask is set, all maskable CPU interrupts are disabled. CPU
interrupts are enabled when the interrupt mask is cleared. When a CPU
interrupt occurs, the interrupt mask is set
automatically after the CPU registers are saved on the stack, but before the
interrupt vector is fetched.
1 = Interrupts disabled
0 = Interrupts enabled
NOTE:
To maintain M6805 Family compatibility, the upper byte of the index register (H) is
not stacked automatically. If the interrupt service routine modifies H, then the user
must stack and unstack H using the PSHH and PULH instructions.
After the I bit is cleared, the highest-priority interrupt request is serviced first.
A return-from-interrupt (RTI) instruction pulls the CPU registers from the stack
and restores the interrupt mask from the stack. After any reset, the interrupt
mask is set and can be cleared only by the clear interrupt mask software
instruction (CLI).
N — Negative flag
The CPU sets the negative flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation,
or data manipulation produces a negative result, setting bit 7 of the result.
1 = Negative result
0 = Non-negative result
Z — Zero flag
The CPU sets the zero flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or
data manipulation produces a result of $00.
1 = Zero result
0 = Non-zero result
C — Carry/Borrow Flag
The CPU sets the carry/borrow flag when an addition operation produces a
carry out of bit 7 of the accumulator or when a subtraction operation requires a
borrow. Some instructions — such as bit test and branch, shift, and rotate —
also clear or set the carry/borrow flag.
1 = Carry out of bit 7
0 = No carry out of bit 7
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
75
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
7.4 Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU)
The ALU performs the arithmetic and logic operations defined by the instruction
set.
Refer to the CPU08 Reference Manual (Motorola document order number
CPU08RM/AD) for a description of the instructions and addressing modes and
more detail about the architecture of the CPU.
7.5 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby
modes.
7.5.1 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction:
•
Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register, enabling
interrupts. After exit from wait mode by interrupt, the I bit remains clear. After
exit by reset, the I bit is set.
•
Disables the CPU clock
7.5.2 Stop Mode
The STOP instruction:
•
Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register, enabling
external interrupts. After exit from stop mode by external interrupt, the I bit
remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set.
•
Disables the CPU clock
After exiting stop mode, the CPU clock begins running after the oscillator
stabilization delay.
7.6 CPU During Break Interrupts
If a break module is present on the MCU, the CPU starts a break interrupt by:
•
•
Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction
Loading the program counter with $FFFC:$FFFD or with $FEFC:$FEFD in
monitor mode
The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in progress. If
the break address register match occurs on the last cycle of a CPU instruction, the
break interrupt begins immediately.
A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break routine ends the break
interrupt and returns the MCU to normal operation if the break interrupt has been
deasserted.
Data Sheet
76
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Instruction Set Summary
7.7 Instruction Set Summary
Table 7-1 provides a summary of the M68HC08 instruction set.
Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 1 of 7)
Effect
Source
Form
on CCR
Operation
Description
V H I N Z C
ADC #opr
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
A9 ii
B9 dd
C9 hh ll
D9 ee ff
E9 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
ADC opr
ADC opr
ADC opr,X
ADC opr,X
ADC ,X
Add with Carry
A ← (A) + (M) + (C)
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
F9
ADC opr,SP
ADC opr,SP
9EE9 ff
9ED9 ee ff
ADD #opr
ADD opr
ADD opr
ADD opr,X
ADD opr,X
ADD ,X
ADD opr,SP
ADD opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
AB ii
BB dd
CB hh ll
DB ee ff
EB ff
FB
9EEB ff
9EDB ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
Add without Carry
A ← (A) + (M)
AIS #opr
AIX #opr
Add Immediate Value (Signed) to SP
Add Immediate Value (Signed) to H:X
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– IMM
– IMM
A7 ii
AF ii
2
2
SP ← (SP) + (16 « M)
H:X ← (H:X) + (16 « M)
AND #opr
AND opr
IMM
DIR
EXT
A4 ii
B4 dd
C4 hh ll
D4 ee ff
E4 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
AND opr
AND opr,X
AND opr,X
AND ,X
AND opr,SP
AND opr,SP
IX2
Logical AND
A ← (A) & (M)
0
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
F4
9EE4 ff
9ED4 ee ff
ASL opr
ASLA
ASLX
ASL opr,X
ASL ,X
ASL opr,SP
DIR
INH
38 dd
48
4
1
1
4
3
5
Arithmetic Shift Left
(Same as LSL)
INH
58
C
0
ꢀ
ꢀ
IX1
68 ff
78
b7
b7
b0
b0
IX
SP1
9E68 ff
ASR opr
ASRA
ASRX
ASR opr,X
ASR opr,X
ASR opr,SP
DIR
INH
37 dd
47
4
1
1
4
3
5
INH
57
C
Arithmetic Shift Right
ꢀ
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
IX1
67 ff
77
IX
SP1
9E67 ff
BCC rel
Branch if Carry Bit Clear
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0
–
–
–
– REL
24 rr
3
DIR (b0) 11 dd
DIR (b1) 13 dd
DIR (b2) 15 dd
DIR (b3) 17 dd
DIR (b4) 19 dd
DIR (b5) 1B dd
DIR (b6) 1D dd
DIR (b7) 1F dd
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
BCLR n, opr
Clear Bit n in M
Mn ← 0
–
–
–
–
–
–
BCS rel
BEQ rel
Branch if Carry Bit Set (Same as BLO)
Branch if Equal
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 1
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
25 rr
27 rr
3
3
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
77
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 2 of 7)
Effect
Source
Form
on CCR
Operation
Description
V H I N Z C
Branch if Greater Than or Equal To
(Signed Operands)
BGE opr
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
90 rr
92 rr
3
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) = 0
Branch if Greater Than (Signed
Operands)
BGT opr
3
3
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 0
BHCC rel
BHCS rel
BHI rel
Branch if Half Carry Bit Clear
Branch if Half Carry Bit Set
Branch if Higher
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
– REL
28 rr
29 rr
22 rr
3
3
3
Branch if Higher or Same
(Same as BCC)
BHS rel
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
24 rr
BIH rel
BIL rel
Branch if IRQ Pin High
Branch if IRQ Pin Low
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
2F rr
2E rr
3
3
BIT #opr
BIT opr
IMM
DIR
EXT
A5 ii
B5 dd
C5 hh ll
D5 ee ff
E5 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
BIT opr
BIT opr,X
BIT opr,X
BIT ,X
BIT opr,SP
BIT opr,SP
IX2
Bit Test
(A) & (M)
0
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
F5
9EE5 ff
9ED5 ee ff
Branch if Less Than or Equal To
(Signed Operands)
BLE opr
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
93 rr
3
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 1
BLO rel
BLS rel
BLT opr
BMC rel
BMI rel
BMS rel
BNE rel
BPL rel
BRA rel
Branch if Lower (Same as BCS)
Branch if Lower or Same
Branch if Less Than (Signed Operands)
Branch if Interrupt Mask Clear
Branch if Minus
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
– REL
25 rr
23 rr
91 rr
2C rr
2B rr
2D rr
26 rr
2A rr
20 rr
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) =1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 1
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel
Branch if Interrupt Mask Set
Branch if Not Equal
Branch if Plus
Branch Always
DIR (b0) 01 dd rr
DIR (b1) 03 dd rr
DIR (b2) 05 dd rr
DIR (b3) 07 dd rr
DIR (b4) 09 dd rr
DIR (b5) 0B dd rr
DIR (b6) 0D dd rr
DIR (b7) 0F dd rr
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
BRCLR n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Clear
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
BRN rel
Branch Never
– REL
21 rr
3
Data Sheet
78
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Instruction Set Summary
Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 3 of 7)
Effect
Source
Form
on CCR
Operation
Description
V H I N Z C
DIR (b0) 00 dd rr
DIR (b1) 02 dd rr
DIR (b2) 04 dd rr
DIR (b3) 06 dd rr
DIR (b4) 08 dd rr
DIR (b5) 0A dd rr
DIR (b6) 0C dd rr
DIR (b7) 0E dd rr
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
BRSET n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Set
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 1
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
DIR (b0) 10 dd
DIR (b1) 12 dd
DIR (b2) 14 dd
DIR (b3) 16 dd
DIR (b4) 18 dd
DIR (b5) 1A dd
DIR (b6) 1C dd
DIR (b7) 1E dd
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
BSET n,opr
BSR rel
Set Bit n in M
Mn ← 1
–
PC ← (PC) + 2; push (PCL)
SP ← (SP) – 1; push (PCH)
SP ← (SP) – 1
Branch to Subroutine
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– REL
AD rr
4
PC ← (PC) + rel
CBEQ opr,rel
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (X) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00
DIR
31 dd rr
41 ii rr
51 ii rr
61 ff rr
71 rr
5
4
4
5
4
6
CBEQA #opr,rel
CBEQX #opr,rel
CBEQ opr,X+,rel
CBEQ X+,rel
IMM
IMM
Compare and Branch if Equal
–
IX1+
IX+
CBEQ opr,SP,rel
SP1
9E61 ff rr
CLC
CLI
Clear Carry Bit
C ← 0
I ← 0
–
–
–
–
–
0
–
–
–
–
0 INH
– INH
98
9A
1
2
Clear Interrupt Mask
CLR opr
CLRA
M ← $00
A ← $00
X ← $00
H ← $00
M ← $00
M ← $00
M ← $00
DIR
INH
3F dd
4F
3
1
1
1
3
2
4
CLRX
INH
5F
CLRH
Clear
0
–
–
–
–
0
1
– INH
IX1
IX
SP1
8C
CLR opr,X
CLR ,X
6F ff
7F
CLR opr,SP
9E6F ff
CMP #opr
CMP opr
CMP opr
CMP opr,X
CMP opr,X
CMP ,X
CMP opr,SP
CMP opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
A1 ii
B1 dd
C1 hh ll
D1 ee ff
E1 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
IX2
Compare A with M
(A) – (M)
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
IX1
IX
F1
SP1
SP2
9EE1 ff
9ED1 ee ff
COM opr
COMA
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
A ← (A) = $FF – (M)
X ← (X) = $FF – (M)
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
M ← (M) = $FF – (M)
DIR
INH
33 dd
43
4
1
1
4
3
5
COMX
INH
53
Complement (One’s Complement)
Compare H:X with M
0
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
1
COM opr,X
COM ,X
COM opr,SP
IX1
63 ff
73
9E63 ff
IX
SP1
CPHX #opr
CPHX opr
IMM
ꢀ
65 ii ii+1
75 dd
3
4
(H:X) – (M:M + 1)
ꢀ
DIR
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
79
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 4 of 7)
Effect
Source
Form
on CCR
Operation
Description
V H I N Z C
CPX #opr
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
A3 ii
B3 dd
C3 hh ll
D3 ee ff
E3 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
CPX opr
CPX opr
CPX ,X
CPX opr,X
CPX opr,X
CPX opr,SP
CPX opr,SP
Compare X with M
(X) – (M)
(A)10
ꢀ
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
F3
9EE3 ff
9ED3 ee ff
DAA
Decimal Adjust A
U –
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ INH
72
2
A ← (A) – 1 or M ← (M) – 1 or X ← (X) – 1
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
5
3
3
5
4
6
DBNZ opr,rel
DBNZA rel
DBNZX rel
DBNZ opr,X,rel
DBNZ X,rel
DBNZ opr,SP,rel
DIR
INH
3B dd rr
4B rr
Decrement and Branch if Not Zero
–
–
–
–
– INH
IX1
5B rr
6B ff rr
7B rr
IX
SP1
9E6B ff rr
DEC opr
DECA
M ← (M) – 1
A ← (A) – 1
X ← (X) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
DIR
INH
3A dd
4A
4
1
1
4
3
5
DECX
INH
5A
Decrement
Divide
ꢀ
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
DEC opr,X
DEC ,X
DEC opr,SP
IX1
6A ff
7A
9E6A ff
IX
SP1
A ← (H:A)/(X)
H ← Remainder
DIV
–
–
ꢀ INH
52
7
EOR #opr
EOR opr
IMM
DIR
EXT
A8 ii
B8 dd
C8 hh ll
D8 ee ff
E8 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
EOR opr
EOR opr,X
EOR opr,X
EOR ,X
EOR opr,SP
EOR opr,SP
IX2
Exclusive OR M with A
0
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
A ← (A ⊕ M)
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
F8
9EE8 ff
9ED8 ee ff
INC opr
INCA
INCX
INC opr,X
INC ,X
INC opr,SP
M ← (M) + 1
A ← (A) + 1
X ← (X) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
DIR
INH
3C dd
4C
4
1
1
4
3
5
INH
5C
Increment
ꢀ
–
IX1
6C ff
7C
IX
SP1
9E6C ff
JMP opr
JMP opr
JMP opr,X
JMP opr,X
JMP ,X
DIR
EXT
– IX2
IX1
BC dd
CC hh ll
DC ee ff
EC ff
2
3
4
3
2
Jump
PC ← Jump Address
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
IX
FC
JSR opr
JSR opr
JSR opr,X
JSR opr,X
JSR ,X
DIR
EXT
– IX2
IX1
BD dd
CD hh ll
DD ee ff
ED ff
4
5
6
5
4
PC ← (PC) + n (n = 1, 2, or 3)
Push (PCL); SP ← (SP) – 1
Push (PCH); SP ← (SP) – 1
PC ← Unconditional Address
Jump to Subroutine
IX
FD
LDA #opr
LDA opr
IMM
DIR
EXT
A6 ii
B6 dd
C6 hh ll
D6 ee ff
E6 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
LDA opr
LDA opr,X
LDA opr,X
LDA ,X
LDA opr,SP
LDA opr,SP
IX2
Load A from M
A ← (M)
0
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
F6
9EE6 ff
9ED6 ee ff
Data Sheet
80
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Instruction Set Summary
Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 5 of 7)
Effect
Source
Form
on CCR
Operation
Description
V H I N Z C
LDHX #opr
LDHX opr
IMM
DIR
45 ii jj
55 dd
3
4
Load H:X from M
H:X ← (M:M + 1)
0
–
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
LDX #opr
LDX opr
LDX opr
LDX opr,X
LDX opr,X
LDX ,X
LDX opr,SP
LDX opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
AE ii
BE dd
CE hh ll
DE ee ff
EE ff
FE
9EEE ff
9EDE ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
Load X from M
X ← (M)
0
–
ꢀ
–
LSL opr
LSLA
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
38 dd
48
4
1
1
4
3
5
LSLX
Logical Shift Left
(Same as ASL)
58
C
0
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
LSL opr,X
LSL ,X
LSL opr,SP
68 ff
78
9E68 ff
b7
b7
b0
b0
SP1
LSR opr
LSRA
LSRX
LSR opr,X
LSR ,X
LSR opr,SP
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
34 dd
44
4
1
1
4
3
5
54
0
C
Logical Shift Right
0
ꢀ
64 ff
74
SP1
9E64 ff
MOV opr,opr
MOV opr,X+
MOV #opr,opr
MOV X+,opr
DD
4E dd dd
5E dd
5
4
4
4
(M)Destination ← (M)Source
DIX+
IMD
IX+D
Move
0
–
–
0
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
6E ii dd
7E dd
H:X ← (H:X) + 1 (IX+D, DIX+)
MUL
Unsigned multiply
X:A ← (X) × (A)
–
–
0 INH
42
5
NEG opr
NEGA
DIR
INH
30 dd
40
4
1
1
4
3
5
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
A ← –(A) = $00 – (A)
X ← –(X) = $00 – (X)
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
NEGX
INH
50
Negate (Two’s Complement)
ꢀ
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
NEG opr,X
NEG ,X
NEG opr,SP
IX1
60 ff
70
9E60 ff
IX
SP1
NOP
NSA
No Operation
Nibble Swap A
None
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
– INH
9D
62
1
3
A ← (A[3:0]:A[7:4])
ORA #opr
ORA opr
IMM
DIR
EXT
AA ii
BA dd
CA hh ll
DA ee ff
EA ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
ORA opr
ORA opr,X
ORA opr,X
ORA ,X
ORA opr,SP
ORA opr,SP
IX2
Inclusive OR A and M
A ← (A) | (M)
0
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
FA
9EEA ff
9EDA ee ff
PSHA
PSHH
PSHX
PULA
PULH
PULX
Push A onto Stack
Push H onto Stack
Push X onto Stack
Pull A from Stack
Pull H from Stack
Pull X from Stack
Push (A); SP ← (SP) – 1
Push (H); SP ← (SP) – 1
Push (X); SP ← (SP) – 1
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (A)
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (H)
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (X)
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
– INH
– INH
– INH
– INH
– INH
87
8B
89
86
8A
88
2
2
2
2
2
2
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
81
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 6 of 7)
Effect
Source
Form
on CCR
Operation
Description
V H I N Z C
ROL opr
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
39 dd
49
4
1
1
4
3
5
ROLA
ROLX
59
C
Rotate Left through Carry
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ROL opr,X
ROL ,X
69 ff
79
9E69 ff
b7
b0
ROL opr,SP
SP1
ROR opr
RORA
RORX
ROR opr,X
ROR ,X
ROR opr,SP
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
36 dd
46
4
1
1
4
3
5
56
C
Rotate Right through Carry
66 ff
76
b7
b0
SP1
9E66 ff
RSP
Reset Stack Pointer
Return from Interrupt
SP ← $FF
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
9C
1
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (CCR)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (A)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (X)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCH)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCL)
RTI
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ INH
80
7
SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCH)
SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCL)
RTS
Return from Subroutine
Subtract with Carry
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
81
4
SBC #opr
SBC opr
SBC opr
SBC opr,X
SBC opr,X
SBC ,X
SBC opr,SP
SBC opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
A2 ii
B2 dd
C2 hh ll
D2 ee ff
E2 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
IX2
A ← (A) – (M) – (C)
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
IX1
IX
F2
SP1
SP2
9EE2 ff
9ED2 ee ff
SEC
SEI
Set Carry Bit
C ← 1
I ← 1
–
–
–
–
–
1
–
–
–
–
1 INH
– INH
99
9B
1
2
Set Interrupt Mask
STA opr
DIR
EXT
IX2
B7 dd
C7 hh ll
D7 ee ff
E7 ff
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
STA opr
STA opr,X
STA opr,X
STA ,X
STA opr,SP
STA opr,SP
Store A in M
M ← (A)
0
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
– IX1
IX
F7
SP1
SP2
9EE7 ff
9ED7 ee ff
STHX opr
Store H:X in M
(M:M + 1) ← (H:X)
0
–
–
–
–
0
ꢀ
ꢀ
– DIR
– INH
35 dd
8E
4
1
STOP
Enable IRQ Pin; Stop Oscillator
I ← 0; Stop Oscillator
–
–
STX opr
DIR
EXT
IX2
BF dd
CF hh ll
DF ee ff
EF ff
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
STX opr
STX opr,X
STX opr,X
STX ,X
STX opr,SP
STX opr,SP
Store X in M
M ← (X)
0
–
–
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
– IX1
IX
FF
SP1
SP2
9EEF ff
9EDF ee ff
SUB #opr
SUB opr
SUB opr
SUB opr,X
SUB opr,X
SUB ,X
SUB opr,SP
SUB opr,SP
IMM
DIR
EXT
A0 ii
B0 dd
C0 hh ll
D0 ee ff
E0 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
IX2
Subtract
A ← (A) – (M)
ꢀ
ꢀ
IX1
IX
F0
SP1
SP2
9EE0 ff
9ED0 ee ff
Data Sheet
82
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Opcode Map
Table 7-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 7 of 7)
Effect
Source
Form
on CCR
Operation
Description
V H I N Z C
PC ← (PC) + 1; Push (PCL)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (PCH)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (X)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (A)
SWI
Software Interrupt
–
–
1
–
–
– INH
83
9
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (CCR)
SP ← (SP) – 1; I ← 1
PCH ← Interrupt Vector High Byte
PCL ← Interrupt Vector Low Byte
TAP
TAX
TPA
Transfer A to CCR
Transfer A to X
CCR ← (A)
X ← (A)
ꢀ
–
–
ꢀ
–
–
ꢀ
–
–
ꢀ
–
–
ꢀ
–
–
ꢀ INH
– INH
– INH
84
97
85
2
1
1
Transfer CCR to A
A ← (CCR)
TST opr
TSTA
DIR
INH
3D dd
4D
3
1
1
3
2
4
TSTX
INH
5D
Test for Negative or Zero
(A) – $00 or (X) – $00 or (M) – $00
0
–
–
ꢀ
ꢀ
–
TST opr,X
TST ,X
TST opr,SP
IX1
6D ff
7D
9E6D ff
IX
SP1
TSX
TXA
TXS
WAIT
Transfer SP to H:X
H:X ← (SP) + 1
A ← (X)
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
– INH
– INH
– INH
– INH
95
9F
94
8F
2
1
2
1
Transfer X to A
Transfer H:X to SP
(SP) ← (H:X) – 1
I bit ← 0; Halt CPU
Enable Interrupts; Wait for Interrupt
A
C
CCR
dd
dd rr
DD
DIR
DIX+
ee ff
EXT
ff
H
H
hh ll
I
ii
Accumulator
Carry/borrow bit
Condition code register
Direct address of operand
Direct address of operand and relative offset of branch instruction
Direct to direct addressing mode
n
Any bit
opr Operand (one or two bytes)
PC Program counter
PCH Program counter high byte
PCL Program counter low byte
REL Relative addressing mode
Direct addressing mode
rel
rr
Relative program counter offset byte
Relative program counter offset byte
Direct to indexed with post increment addressing mode
High and low bytes of offset in indexed, 16-bit offset addressing
Extended addressing mode
Offset byte in indexed, 8-bit offset addressing
Half-carry bit
Index register high byte
High and low bytes of operand address in extended addressing
Interrupt mask
SP1 Stack pointer, 8-bit offset addressing mode
SP2 Stack pointer 16-bit offset addressing mode
SP Stack pointer
U
V
X
Z
&
|
Undefined
Overflow bit
Index register low byte
Zero bit
Logical AND
Logical OR
Immediate operand byte
Immediate source to direct destination addressing mode
IMD
IMM
INH
IX
Immediate addressing mode
Inherent addressing mode
Indexed, no offset addressing mode
Indexed, no offset, post increment addressing mode
⊕
Logical EXCLUSIVE OR
Contents of
( )
–( ) Negation (two’s complement)
#
IX+
Immediate value
IX+D
IX1
IX1+
IX2
M
Indexed with post increment to direct addressing mode
Indexed, 8-bit offset addressing mode
Indexed, 8-bit offset, post increment addressing mode
Indexed, 16-bit offset addressing mode
Memory location
«
←
?
:
ꢀ
Sign extend
Loaded with
If
Concatenated with
Set or cleared
Not affected
N
Negative bit
—
7.8 Opcode Map
See Table 7-2.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
83
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Table 7-2. Opcode Map
Bit Manipulation Branch
Read-Modify-Write
Control
Register/Memory
DIR
DIR
REL
DIR
3
INH
4
INH
IX1
SP1
9E6
IX
7
INH
INH
IMM
A
DIR
B
EXT
C
IX2
SP2
IX1
E
SP1
9EE
IX
F
MSB
0
1
2
5
6
8
9
D
9ED
LSB
5
4
3
4
1
NEGA
INH
1
NEGX
INH
4
5
3
7
3
2
3
4
4
5
3
4
2
0
BRSET0 BSET0
BRA
NEG
NEG
NEG
NEG
IX
RTI
BGE
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
SUB
IX
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
REL 2 DIR
3
BRN
REL 3 DIR
3
BHI
REL
3
BLS
REL 2 DIR
3
BCC
REL 2 DIR
3
BCS
REL 2 DIR
3
BNE
REL 2 DIR
3
BEQ
1
1
2
IX1 3 SP1
5
1
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
INH
4
RTS
INH
2
2
2
2
1
1
REL 2 IMM 2 DIR
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
EXT 3 IX2
4
CMP
EXT 3 IX2
4
SBC
EXT 3 IX2
4
CPX
EXT 3 IX2
4
AND
EXT 3 IX2
4
BIT
EXT 3 IX2
4
LDA
EXT 3 IX2
4
STA
EXT 3 IX2
4
EOR
EXT 3 IX2
4
ADC
EXT 3 IX2
4
ORA
EXT 3 IX2
4
ADD
EXT 3 IX2
3
JMP
EXT 3 IX2
5
JSR
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
SP2
5
CMP
SP2
5
SBC
SP2
5
CPX
SP2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IX1
3
CMP
IX1
3
SBC
IX1
3
CPX
IX1
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
SP1
4
CMP
SP1
4
SBC
SP1
4
CPX
SP1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
5
4
4
6
4
CBEQ
IX+
2
DAA
INH
3
COM
IX
3
LSR
IX
4
CPHX
DIR
3
ROR
IX
3
ASR
IX
3
LSL
IX
3
ROL
IX
3
DEC
IX
4
DBNZ
IX
3
INC
IX
2
3
4
2
CMP
IX
2
SBC
IX
2
CPX
IX
2
AND
IX
2
BIT
IX
2
LDA
IX
2
STA
IX
2
EOR
IX
2
ADC
IX
2
ORA
IX
2
ADD
IX
2
JMP
IX
4
JSR
IX
2
LDX
IX
2
STX
IX
1
2
BRCLR0 BCLR0
CBEQ CBEQA CBEQX CBEQ
CBEQ
BLT
CMP
CMP
CMP
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
3
IMM 3 IMM 3 IX1+
4
SP1
REL 2 IMM 2 DIR
5
7
3
3
BGT
2
SBC
3
SBC
4
SBC
BRSET1 BSET1
MUL
INH
DIV
INH
NSA
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
1
1
1
2
2
3
2
2
2
2
2
INH
REL 2 IMM 2 DIR
3
4
1
1
4
COM
IX1
4
LSR
IX1
3
CPHX
IMM
4
ROR
IX1
4
ASR
IX1
4
LSL
IX1
4
ROL
IX1
4
DEC
IX1
5
9
2
CPX
3
CPX
4
CPX
3
BRCLR1 BCLR1
COM
COMA
COMX
COM
SWI
BLE
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
1
INH
1
INH
3
3
SP1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
INH
REL 2 IMM 2 DIR
4
LSR
1
LSRA
INH
1
LSRX
INH
5
2
2
2
AND
IMM 2 DIR
2
BIT
IMM 2 DIR
2
LDA
IMM 2 DIR
2
AIS
IMM 2 DIR
2
EOR
IMM 2 DIR
2
ADC
IMM 2 DIR
3
AND
4
AND
5
3
4
4
BRSET2 BSET2
LSR
TAP
TXS
AND
AND
AND
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
1
3
1
SP1
INH
INH
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
SP2
IX1
SP1
4
3
4
1
2
3
BIT
4
BIT
5
BIT
SP2
5
LDA
SP2
5
STA
SP2
5
EOR
3
BIT
IX1
3
LDA
IX1
4
BIT
SP1
4
LDA
SP1
4
STA
SP1
4
EOR
5
BRCLR2 BCLR2
STHX
LDHX
LDHX
TPA
TSX
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
IMM 2 DIR
INH
INH
4
ROR
1
1
5
2
PULA
INH
2
PSHA
INH
2
PULX
INH
2
PSHX
INH
2
PULH
INH
2
PSHH
INH
1
CLRH
INH
3
LDA
4
LDA
6
BRSET3 BSET3
RORA
RORX
ROR
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
1
INH
1
INH
3
3
3
3
3
4
3
3
SP1
5
4
ASR
1
ASRA
INH
1
LSLA
INH
1
ROLA
INH
1
DECA
INH
1
ASRX
INH
1
LSLX
INH
1
ROLX
INH
1
DECX
INH
1
3
STA
4
STA
3
7
BRCLR3 BCLR3
ASR
TAX
STA
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
REL 2 DIR
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
SP1
5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
INH
IX1
4
LSL
1
CLC
INH
1
3
EOR
4
EOR
3
EOR
8
BRSET4 BSET4 BHCC
LSL
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
2
REL 2 DIR
3
SP1
5
SP2
5
ADC
SP2
IX1
3
SP1
4
ADC
SP1
4
ROL
3
ADC
4
ADC
9
BRCLR4 BCLR4 BHCS
ROL
SEC
INH
2
CLI
INH
2
SEI
INH
1
RSP
INH
ADC
IX1
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
REL 2 DIR
3
BPL
REL 2 DIR
3
BMI
REL 3 DIR
3
BMC
REL 2 DIR
3
BMS
REL 2 DIR
3
BIL
SP1
5
4
DEC
2
ORA
IMM 2 DIR
2
ADD
IMM 2 DIR
3
ORA
4
ORA
5
3
4
A
B
C
D
E
F
BRSET5 BSET5
DEC
ORA
ORA
ORA
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
SP1
6
SP2
IX1
SP1
5
3
3
5
3
ADD
4
ADD
5
3
ADD
IX1
3
JMP
IX1
5
JSR
IX1
3
LDX
IX1
4
BRCLR5 BCLR5
DBNZ DBNZA DBNZX DBNZ
DBNZ
ADD
ADD
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
2
1
1
3
1
INH
1
2
1
1
2
1
INH
1
3
2
2
3
2
IX1
4
INC
IX1
3
TST
IX1
4
MOV
IMD
3
CLR
IX1
SP1
5
SP2
SP1
4
INC
2
JMP
DIR
4
JSR
4
JMP
BRSET6 BSET6
INCA
INCX
INC
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
INH
1
TSTA
INH
5
MOV
DD
1
CLRA
INH
INH
1
TSTX
INH
4
MOV
DIX+
1
CLRX
INH
SP1
4
2
3
TST
2
TST
IX
1
4
BSR
REL 2 DIR
2
LDX
IMM 2 DIR
2
AIX
IMM 2 DIR
6
JSR
BRCLR6 BCLR6
TST
SP1
NOP
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
INH
2
2
2
EXT 3 IX2
4
LDX
EXT 3 IX2
4
STX
EXT 3 IX2
4
1
STOP
INH
1
WAIT
INH
3
LDX
4
LDX
5
4
BRSET7 BSET7
MOV
IX+D
LDX
LDX
*
1
TXA
INH
3
DIR
5
2
DIR
4
REL
3
BIH
1
1
4
4
SP2
3
3
SP1
3
CLR
4
2
CLR
IX
3
STX
4
STX
5
STX
SP2
3
4
STX
SP1
BRCLR7 BCLR7
DIR DIR
CLR
SP1
STX
3
2
REL 2 DIR
3
1
IX1
INH Inherent
REL Relative
SP1 Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset
SP2 Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset
IX+ Indexed, No Offset with
Post Increment
IX1+ Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with
Post Increment
MSB
LSB
0
High Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal
Cycles
IMM Immediate
DIR Direct
IX
Indexed, No Offset
IX1 Indexed, 8-Bit Offset
IX2 Indexed, 16-Bit Offset
IMD Immediate-Direct
EXT Extended
DD Direct-Direct
IX+D Indexed-Direct DIX+ Direct-Indexed
*Pre-byte for stack pointer indexed instructions
5
Low Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal
0
BRSET0 Opcode Mnemonic
DIR Number of Bytes / Addressing Mode
3
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 8. External Interrupt (IRQ)
8.1 Introduction
The IRQ pin (external interrupt), shared with PTA2 (general purpose input) and
keyboard interrupt (KBI), provides a maskable interrupt input.
8.2 Features
Features of the IRQ module include the following:
•
•
•
•
•
•
External interrupt pin, IRQ
IRQ interrupt control bits
Hysteresis buffer
Programmable edge-only or edge and level interrupt sensitivity
Automatic interrupt acknowledge
Selectable internal pullup resistor
8.3 Functional Description
IRQ pin functionality is enabled by setting configuration register 2 (CONFIG2)
IRQEN bit accordingly. A zero disables the IRQ function and IRQ will assume the
other shared functionalities. A one enables the IRQ function.
A logic 0 applied to the external interrupt pin can latch a central processor unit
(CPU) interrupt request. Figure 8-2 shows the structure of the IRQ module.
Interrupt signals on the IRQ pin are latched into the IRQ latch. An interrupt latch
remains set until one of the following actions occurs:
•
Vector fetch — A vector fetch automatically generates an interrupt
acknowledge signal that clears the IRQ latch.
•
Software clear — Software can clear the interrupt latch by writing to the
acknowledge bit in the interrupt status and control register (ISCR). Writing
a 1 to the ACK bit clears the IRQ latch.
•
Reset — A reset automatically clears the interrupt latch.
The external interrupt pin is falling-edge-triggered and is software- configurable to
be either falling-edge or falling-edge and low-level triggered. The MODE bit in the
ISCR controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ pin.
When the interrupt pin is edge-triggered only, the CPU interrupt request remains
set until a vector fetch, software clear, or reset occurs.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
85
External Interrupt (IRQ)
External Interrupt (IRQ)
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
CLOCK
GENERATOR
(OSCILLATOR)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
SINGLE INTERRUPT
MODULE
M68HC08 CPU
PTB0/TCH0
PTB1
BREAK
MODULE
PTB2/AD4
PTB3/AD5
PTB4/SLCRX
PTB5/SLCTX
PTB6
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
KEYBOARD INTERRUPT
MODULE
PTB7
2-CH 16-BIT TIMER
MODULE
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL3: 4096 BYTES
MC68HC908QL2: 2048 BYTES
USER FLASH
SLAVE LIN INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
COP
MODULE
6-CHANNEL 10-BIT
ADC
MONITOR ROM
128 BYTES RAM
VDD
VSS
POWER SUPPLY
RST, IRQ: Pins have internal (about 30 kΩ) pull up
PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5: High current sink and source capability
PTA0–PTA5: Pins have programmable keyboard interrupt and pull up
ADC pins only available on MC68HC908QL4 and MC68HC908QL2
Figure 8-1. Block Diagram Highlighting IRQ Block and Pins
Data Sheet
86
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
External Interrupt (IRQ)
Functional Description
ACK
RESET
TO CPU FOR
BIL/BIH
INSTRUCTIONS
VECTOR
FETCH
DECODER
VDD
IRQPUD
INTERNAL
PULLUP
DEVICE
VDD
IRQF
CLR
D
Q
SYNCHRO-
NIZER
IRQ
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
CK
IRQ
IRQ
FF
IMASK
MODE
HIGH
VOLTAGE
DETECT
TO MODE
SELECT
LOGIC
Figure 8-2. IRQ Module Block Diagram
When the interrupt pin is both falling-edge and low-level triggered, the CPU
interrupt request remains set until both of the following occur:
•
•
Vector fetch or software clear
Return of the interrupt pin to logic 1
The vector fetch or software clear may occur before or after the interrupt pin returns
to logic 1. As long as the pin is low, the interrupt request remains pending. A reset
will clear the latch and the MODE control bit, thereby clearing the interrupt even if
the pin stays low.
When set, the IMASK bit in the ISCR mask all external interrupt requests. A latched
interrupt request is not presented to the interrupt priority logic unless the IMASK bit
is clear.
NOTE:
The interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register (CCR) masks all interrupt
requests, including external interrupt requests. See 13.6 Exception Control.
Figure 8-3 provides a summary of the IRQ I/O register.
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
0
1
IMASK
0
Bit 0
MODE
0
Read:
0
0
0
0
IRQF
IRQ Status and Control
Register (INTSCR) Write:
$001D
ACK
0
See page 89.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-3. IRQ I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
87
External Interrupt (IRQ)
External Interrupt (IRQ)
8.4 IRQ Pin
A logic 0 on the IRQ pin can latch an interrupt request into the IRQ latch. A vector
fetch, software clear, or reset clears the IRQ latch.
If the MODE bit is set, the IRQ pin is both falling-edge sensitive and low-level
sensitive. With MODE set, both of the following actions must occur to clear IRQ:
•
Vector fetch or software clear — A vector fetch generates an interrupt
acknowledge signal to clear the latch. Software may generate the interrupt
acknowledge signal by writing a 1 to the ACK bit in the interrupt status and
control register (ISCR). The ACK bit is useful in applications that poll the IRQ
pin and require software to clear the IRQ latch. Writing to the ACK bit prior
to leaving an interrupt service routine can also prevent spurious interrupts
due to noise. Setting ACK does not affect subsequent transitions on the IRQ
pin. A falling edge that occurs after writing to the ACK bit latches another
interrupt request. If the IRQ mask bit, IMASK, is clear, the CPU loads the
program counter with the vector address at locations $FFFA and $FFFB.
•
Return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 — As long as the IRQ pin is at logic 0, IRQ
remains active.
The vector fetch or software clear and the return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 may occur
in any order. The interrupt request remains pending as long as the IRQ pin is at
logic 0. A reset will clear the latch and the MODE control bit, thereby clearing the
interrupt even if the pin stays low.
If the MODE bit is clear, the IRQ pin is falling-edge sensitive only. With MODE
clear, a vector fetch or software clear immediately clears the IRQ latch.
The IRQF bit in the ISCR register can be used to check for pending interrupts. The
IRQF bit is not affected by the IMASK bit, which makes it useful in applications
where polling is preferred.
NOTE:
NOTE:
When the IRQ function is enabled in the CONFIG2 register, the BIH and BIL
instructions can be used to read the logic level on the IRQ pin. If the IRQ function
is disabled, these instructions will behave as if the IRQ pin is a logic 1, regardless
of the actual level on the pin. Conversely, when the IRQ function is enabled, bit 2
of the port A data register will always read a 0.
When using the level-sensitive interrupt trigger, avoid false interrupts by masking
interrupt requests in the interrupt routine. An internal pullup resistor to VDD is
connected to the IRQ pin; this can be disabled by setting the IRQPUD bit in the
CONFIG2 register ($001E).
8.5 IRQ Module During Break Interrupts
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether the IRQ latch can be
cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the break flag control register
(BFCR) enables software to clear the latches during the break state. See
Section 13. System Integration Module (SIM).
Data Sheet
88
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
External Interrupt (IRQ)
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
IRQ Status and Control Register
To allow software to clear the IRQ latch during a break interrupt, write a 1 to the
BCFE bit. If a latch is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the
MCU exits the break state.
To protect the latches during the break state, write a 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE
at 0 (its default state), writing to the ACK bit in the IRQ status and control register
during the break state has no effect on the IRQ latch.
8.6 IRQ Status and Control Register
The IRQ status and control register (ISCR) controls and monitors operation of the
IRQ module, see Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2).
The ISCR has the following functions:
•
•
•
•
Shows the state of the IRQ flag
Clears the IRQ latch
Masks IRQ and interrupt request
Controls triggering sensitivity of the IRQ interrupt pin
Address: $001D
Bit 7
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
2
1
IMASK
0
Bit 0
MODE
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
IRQF
ACK
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 8-4. IRQ Status and Control Register (INTSCR)
IRQF — IRQ Flag
This read-only status bit is high when the IRQ interrupt is pending.
1 = IRQ interrupt pending
0 = IRQ interrupt not pending
ACK — IRQ Interrupt Request Acknowledge Bit
Writing a 1 to this write-only bit clears the IRQ latch. ACK always reads as 0.
Reset clears ACK.
IMASK — IRQ Interrupt Mask Bit
Writing a 1 to this read/write bit disables IRQ interrupt requests. Reset clears
IMASK.
1 = IRQ interrupt requests disabled
0 = IRQ interrupt requests enabled
MODE — IRQ Edge/Level Select Bit
This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ pin. Reset clears
MODE.
1 = IRQ interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels
0 = IRQ interrupt requests on falling edges only
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
89
External Interrupt (IRQ)
External Interrupt (IRQ)
Data Sheet
90
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 9. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
9.1 Introduction
The keyboard interrupt module (KBI) provides six independently maskable external
interrupts, which are accessible via the PTA0–PTA5 pins.
9.2 Features
Features of the keyboard interrupt module include:
•
Six keyboard interrupt pins with separate keyboard interrupt enable bits and
one keyboard interrupt mask
•
•
•
Software configurable pullup device if input pin is configured as input port bit
Programmable edge-only or edge and level interrupt sensitivity
Exit from low-power modes
Figure 9-1 provides a summary of the input/output (I/O) registers
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
IMASKK
0
Bit 0
MODEK
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
KEYF
0
ACKK
0
Keyboard Status
and Control Register
(KBSCR)
$001A
See page 96.
0
0
0
AWUIE
0
0
KBIE5
0
0
KBIE4
0
0
KBIE3
0
Keyboard Interrupt Enable
KBIE2
0
KBIE1
0
KBIE0
0
$001B
Register (KBIER) Write:
See page 97.
Reset:
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-1. KBI I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
91
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
CLOCK
GENERATOR
(OSCILLATOR)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
SINGLE INTERRUPT
MODULE
M68HC08 CPU
PTB0/TCH0
PTB1
BREAK
MODULE
PTB2/AD4
PTB3/AD5
PTB4/SLCRX
PTB5/SLCTX
PTB6
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
KEYBOARD INTERRUPT
MODULE
PTB7
2-CH 16-BIT TIMER
MODULE
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL3: 4096 BYTES
MC68HC908QL2: 2048 BYTES
USER FLASH
SLAVE LIN INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
COP
MODULE
6-CHANNEL 10-BIT
ADC
MONITOR ROM
128 BYTES RAM
VDD
VSS
POWER SUPPLY
RST, IRQ: Pins have internal (about 30 kΩ) pull up
PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5: High current sink and source capability
PTA0–PTA5: Pins have programmable keyboard interrupt and pull up
ADC pins only available on MC68HC908QL4 and MC68HC908QL2
Figure 9-2. Block Diagram Highlighting KBI Block and Pins
Data Sheet
92
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Functional Description
INTERNAL BUS
VECTOR FETCH
DECODER
ACKK
KBI0
VDD
RESET
KEYF
CLR
.
.
.
D
Q
SYNCHRONIZER
KBIE0
CK
TO PULLUP ENABLE
KEYBOARD
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
IMASKK
KBI5
KEYBOARD
INTERRUPT FF
MODEK
KBIE5
TO PULLUP ENABLE
1. For AWUGEN logic refer to Figure 4-2. Auto Wakeup Interrupt
Request Generation Logic.
AWUIREQ(1)
Figure 9-3. Keyboard Interrupt Block Diagram
9.3 Functional Description
The keyboard interrupt module controls the enabling/disabling of interrupt
functions on the six port A pins. These six pins can be enabled/disabled
independently of each other.
9.3.1 Keyboard Operation
Writing to the KBIE0–KBIE5 bits in the keyboard interrupt enable register (KBIER)
independently enables or disables each port A pin as a keyboard interrupt pin.
Enabling a keyboard interrupt pin in port A also enables its internal pullup device
irrespective of PTAPUEx bits in the port A input pullup enable register (see 12.2.3
Port A Input Pullup Enable Register). A logic 0 applied to an enabled keyboard
interrupt pin latches a keyboard interrupt request.
A keyboard interrupt is latched when one or more keyboard interrupt inputs goes
low after all were high. The MODEK bit in the keyboard status and control register
controls the triggering mode of the keyboard interrupt.
•
If the keyboard interrupt is edge-sensitive only, a falling edge on a keyboard
interrupt input does not latch an interrupt request if another keyboard pin is
already low. To prevent losing an interrupt request on one input because
another input is still low, software can disable the latter input while it is low.
•
If the keyboard interrupt is falling edge and low-level sensitive, an interrupt
request is present as long as any keyboard interrupt input is low.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
93
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
If the MODEK bit is set, the keyboard interrupt inputs are both falling edge and
low-level sensitive, and both of the following actions must occur to clear a keyboard
interrupt request:
•
Vector fetch or software clear — A vector fetch generates an interrupt
acknowledge signal to clear the interrupt request. Software may generate
the interrupt acknowledge signal by writing a 1 to the ACKK bit in the
keyboard status and control register (KBSCR). The ACKK bit is useful in
applications that poll the keyboard interrupt inputs and require software to
clear the keyboard interrupt request. Writing to the ACKK bit prior to leaving
an interrupt service routine can also prevent spurious interrupts due to
noise. Setting ACKK does not affect subsequent transitions on the keyboard
interrupt inputs. A falling edge that occurs after writing to the ACKK bit
latches another interrupt request. If the keyboard interrupt mask bit,
IMASKK, is clear, the central processor unit (CPU) loads the program
counter with the vector address at locations $FFE0 and $FFE1.
•
Return of all enabled keyboard interrupt inputs to logic 1 — As long as any
enabled keyboard interrupt pin is at logic 0, the keyboard interrupt remains
set. The auto wakeup interrupt input, AWUIREQ, will be cleared only by
writing to ACKK bit in KBSCR or reset.
The vector fetch or software clear and the return of all enabled keyboard interrupt
pins to logic 1 may occur in any order.
If the MODEK bit is clear, the keyboard interrupt pin is falling-edge sensitive only.
With MODEK clear, a vector fetch or software clear immediately clears the
keyboard interrupt request.
Reset clears the keyboard interrupt request and the MODEK bit, clearing the
interrupt request even if a keyboard interrupt input stays at logic 0.
The keyboard flag bit (KEYF) in the keyboard status and control register can be
used to see if a pending interrupt exists. The KEYF bit is not affected by the
keyboard interrupt mask bit (IMASKK) which makes it useful in applications where
polling is preferred.
To determine the logic level on a keyboard interrupt pin, use the data direction
register to configure the pin as an input and then read the data register.
NOTE:
Setting a keyboard interrupt enable bit (KBIEx) forces the corresponding keyboard
interrupt pin to be an input, overriding the data direction register. However, the data
direction register bit must be a 0 for software to read the pin.
Data Sheet
94
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
MOTOROLA
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Wait Mode
9.3.2 Keyboard Initialization
When a keyboard interrupt pin is enabled, it takes time for the internal pullup to
reach a logic 1. Therefore a false interrupt can occur as soon as the pin is enabled.
To prevent a false interrupt on keyboard initialization:
1. Mask keyboard interrupts by setting the IMASKK bit in the keyboard status
and control register.
2. Enable the KBI pins by setting the appropriate KBIEx bits in the keyboard
interrupt enable register.
3. Write to the ACKK bit in the keyboard status and control register to clear any
false interrupts.
4. Clear the IMASKK bit.
An interrupt signal on an edge-triggered pin can be acknowledged immediately
after enabling the pin. An interrupt signal on an edge- and level-triggered interrupt
pin must be acknowledged after a delay that depends on the external load.
Another way to avoid a false interrupt:
1. Configure the keyboard pins as outputs by setting the appropriate DDRA
bits in the data direction register A.
2. Write 1s to the appropriate port A data register bits.
3. Enable the KBI pins by setting the appropriate KBIEx bits in the keyboard
interrupt enable register.
9.4 Wait Mode
9.5 Stop Mode
The keyboard module remains active in wait mode. Clearing the IMASKK bit in the
keyboard status and control register enables keyboard interrupt requests to bring
the MCU out of wait mode.
The keyboard module remains active in stop mode. Clearing the IMASKK bit in the
keyboard status and control register enables keyboard interrupt requests to bring
the MCU out of stop mode.
9.6 Keyboard Module During Break Interrupts
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether the keyboard interrupt latch
can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the break flag control
register (BFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state.
To allow software to clear the keyboard interrupt latch during a break interrupt,
write a 1 to the BCFE bit. If a latch is cleared during the break state, it remains
cleared when the MCU exits the break state.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
95
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
To protect the latch during the break state, write a 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE
at 0 (its default state), writing to the keyboard acknowledge bit (ACKK) in the
keyboard status and control register during the break state has no effect.
9.7 Input/Output Registers
The following I/O registers control and monitor operation of the keyboard interrupt
module:
•
•
Keyboard interrupt status and control register (KBSCR)
Keyboard interrupt enable register (KBIER)
9.7.1 Keyboard Status and Control Register
The keyboard status and control register (KBSCR):
•
•
•
•
Flags keyboard interrupt requests
Acknowledges keyboard interrupt requests
Masks keyboard interrupt requests
Controls keyboard interrupt triggering sensitivity
Address: $001A
Bit 7
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
2
1
IMASKK
0
Bit 0
MODEK
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
KEYF
0
ACKK
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-4. Keyboard Status and Control Register (KBSCR)
Bits 7–4 — Not used
These read-only bits always read as 0s.
KEYF — Keyboard Flag Bit
This read-only bit is set when a keyboard interrupt is pending on port A or auto
wakeup. Reset clears the KEYF bit.
1 = Keyboard interrupt pending
0 = No keyboard interrupt pending
ACKK — Keyboard Acknowledge Bit
Writing a 1 to this write-only bit clears the keyboard interrupt request on port A
and auto wakeup logic. ACKK always reads as 0. Reset clears ACKK.
IMASKK— Keyboard Interrupt Mask Bit
Writing a 1 to this read/write bit prevents the output of the keyboard interrupt
mask from generating interrupt requests on port A or auto wakeup. Reset clears
the IMASKK bit.
1 = Keyboard interrupt requests masked
0 = Keyboard interrupt requests not masked
Data Sheet
96
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
MOTOROLA
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Input/Output Registers
MODEK — Keyboard Triggering Sensitivity Bit
This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the keyboard interrupt
pins on port A and auto wakeup. Reset clears MODEK.
1 = Keyboard interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels
0 = Keyboard interrupt requests on falling edges only
9.7.2 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register
The port A keyboard interrupt enable register (KBIER) enables or disables each
port A pin or auto wakeup to operate as a keyboard interrupt input.
Address: $001B
Bit 7
0
6
AWUIE
0
5
KBIE5
0
4
KBIE4
0
3
KBIE3
0
2
KBIE2
0
1
KBIE1
0
Bit 0
KBIE0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-5. Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register (KBIER)
KBIE5–KBIE0 — Port A Keyboard Interrupt Enable Bits
Each of these read/write bits enables the corresponding keyboard interrupt pin
on port A to latch interrupt requests. Reset clears the keyboard interrupt enable
register.
1 = KBIx pin enabled as keyboard interrupt pin
0 = KBIx pin not enabled as keyboard interrupt pin
NOTE:
AWUIE bit is not used in conjunction with the keyboard interrupt feature. To see a
description of this bit, see Section 4. Auto Wakeup Module (AWU).
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
97
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Data Sheet
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
98
Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 10. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
10.1 Introduction
This section describes the low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module, which monitors the
voltage on the VDD pin and can force a reset when the VDD voltage falls below the
LVI trip falling voltage, VTRIPF
.
10.2 Features
Features of the LVI module include:
•
•
•
•
Programmable LVI reset
Programmable power consumption
Selectable LVI trip voltage
Programmable stop mode operation
10.3 Functional Description
Figure 10-1 shows the structure of the LVI module. LVISTOP, LVIPWRD,
LVI5OR3, and LVIRSTD are user selectable options found in the configuration
register (CONFIG1). See Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and
CONFIG2).
VDD
STOP INSTRUCTION
LVISTOP
FROM CONFIG1
FROM CONFIG1
LVIRSTD
LVIPWRD
FROM CONFIG1
VDD > LVITRIP = 0
LVI RESET
LOW VDD
DETECTOR
VDD ≤ LVITRIP = 1
LVIOUT
LVI5OR3
FROM CONFIG1
Figure 10-1. LVI Module Block Diagram
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
99
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
The LVI is enabled out of reset. The LVI module contains a bandgap reference
circuit and comparator. Clearing the LVI power disable bit, LVIPWRD, enables the
LVI to monitor VDD voltage. Clearing the LVI reset disable bit, LVIRSTD, enables
the LVI module to generate a reset when VDD falls below a voltage, VTRIPF. Setting
the LVI enable in stop mode bit, LVISTOP, enables the LVI to operate in stop
mode. Setting the LVI 5-V or 3-V trip point bit, LVI5OR3, enables the trip point
voltage, VTRIPF, to be configured for 5-V operation. Clearing the LVI5OR3 bit
enables the trip point voltage, VTRIPF, to be configured for 3-V operation. The
actual trip thresholds are specified in 17.5 5-V DC Electrical Characteristics and
17.9 3.3-V DC Electrical Characteristics.
NOTE:
After a power-on reset, the LVI’s default mode of operation is 3 volts. If a 5-V
system is used, the user must set the LVI5OR3 bit to raise the trip point to 5-V
operation.
If the user requires 5-V mode and sets the LVI5OR3 bit after power-on reset while
the VDD supply is not above the VTRIPR for 5-V mode, the microcontroller unit
(MCU) will immediately go into reset. The next time the LVI releases the reset, the
supply will be above the VTRIPR for 5-V mode.
Once an LVI reset occurs, the MCU remains in reset until VDD rises above a
voltage, VTRIPR, which causes the MCU to exit reset. See Section 13. System
Integration Module (SIM) for the reset recovery sequence.
The output of the comparator controls the state of the LVIOUT flag in the LVI status
register (LVISR) and can be used for polling LVI operation when the LVI reset is
disabled.
10.3.1 Polled LVI Operation
In applications that can operate at VDD levels below the VTRIPF level, software can
monitor VDD by polling the LVIOUT bit. In the configuration register, the LVIPWRD
bit must be at 0 to enable the LVI module, and the LVIRSTD bit must be at 1 to
disable LVI resets.
10.3.2 Forced Reset Operation
In applications that require VDD to remain above the VTRIPF level, enabling LVI
resets allows the LVI module to reset the MCU when VDD falls below the VTRIPF
level. In the configuration register, the LVIPWRD and LVIRSTD bits must be at 0
to enable the LVI module and to enable LVI resets.
10.3.3 Voltage Hysteresis Protection
Once the LVI has triggered (by having VDD fall below VTRIPF), the LVI will maintain
a reset condition until VDD rises above the rising trip point voltage, VTRIPR. This
prevents a condition in which the MCU is continually entering and exiting reset if
VDD is approximately equal to VTRIPF. VTRIPR is greater than VTRIPF by the
hysteresis voltage, VHYS
.
Data Sheet
100
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
LVI Status Register
10.3.4 LVI Trip Selection
The LVI5OR3 bit in the configuration register selects whether the LVI is configured
for 5-V or 3-V protection.
NOTE:
The microcontroller is guaranteed to operate at a minimum supply voltage. The trip
point (VTRIPF [5 V] or VTRIPF [3 V]) may be lower than this. See 17.5 5-V DC
Electrical Characteristics and 17.9 3.3-V DC Electrical Characteristics for the
actual trip point voltages.
10.4 LVI Status Register
The LVI status register (LVISR) indicates if the VDD voltage was detected below
the VTRIPF level while LVI resets have been disabled.
Address: $FE0C
Bit 7
Read: LVIOUT
Write:
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
R
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 10-2. LVI Status Register (LVISR)
LVIOUT — LVI Output Bit
This read-only flag becomes set when the VDD voltage falls below the VTRIPF
trip voltage and is cleared when VDD voltage rises above VTRIPR. The difference
in these threshold levels results in a hysteresis that prevents oscillation into and
out of reset (see Table 10-1). Reset clears the LVIOUT bit.
Table 10-1. LVIOUT Bit Indication
VDD
LVIOUT
VDD > VTRIPR
0
VDD < VTRIPF
1
VTRIPF < VDD < VTRIPR
Previous value
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
101
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
10.5 LVI Interrupts
The LVI module does not generate interrupt requests.
10.6 Low-Power Modes
The STOP and WAIT instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby
modes.
10.6.1 Wait Mode
10.6.2 Stop Mode
If enabled, the LVI module remains active in wait mode. If enabled to generate
resets, the LVI module can generate a reset and bring the MCU out of wait mode.
When the LVIPWRD bit in the configuration register is cleared and the LVISTOP
bit in the configuration register is set, the LVI module remains active in stop mode.
If enabled to generate resets, the LVI module can generate a reset and bring the
MCU out of stop mode.
Data Sheet
102
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 11. Oscillator Module (OSC)
11.1 Introduction
The oscillator module is used to provide a stable clock source for the
microcontroller system and bus. The oscillator module generates two output
clocks, BUSCLKX2 and BUSCLKX4. The BUSCLKX4 clock is used by the system
integration module (SIM) and the computer operating properly module (COP). The
BUSCLKX2 clock is divided by two in the SIM to be used as the bus clock for the
microcontroller. Therefore the bus frequency will be one forth of the BUSCLKX4
frequency.
11.2 Features
The oscillator has these four clock source options available:
1. Internal oscillator: An internally generated, fixed frequency clock, trimmable
to ± 5%. This is the default option out of reset.
2. External oscillator: An external clock that can be driven directly into OSC1.
3. External RC: A built-in oscillator module (RC oscillator) that requires an
external R connection only. The capacitor is internal to the chip.
4. External crystal: A built-in oscillator module (XTAL oscillator) that requires
an external crystal or ceramic-resonator.
11.3 Functional Description
The oscillator contains these major subsystems:
•
•
•
•
•
Internal oscillator circuit
Internal or external clock switch control
External clock circuit
External crystal circuit
External RC clock circuit
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
103
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module (OSC)
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
CLOCK
GENERATOR
(OSCILLATOR)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
SINGLE INTERRUPT
MODULE
M68HC08 CPU
PTB0/TCH0
PTB1
BREAK
MODULE
PTB2/AD4
PTB3/AD5
PTB4/SLCRX
PTB5/SLCTX
PTB6
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
KEYBOARD INTERRUPT
MODULE
PTB7
2-CH 16-BIT TIMER
MODULE
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL3: 4096 BYTES
MC68HC908QL2: 2048 BYTES
USER FLASH
SLAVE LIN INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
COP
MODULE
6-CHANNEL 10-BIT
ADC
MONITOR ROM
128 BYTES RAM
VDD
VSS
POWER SUPPLY
RST, IRQ: Pins have internal (about 30 kΩ) pull up
PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5: High current sink and source capability
PTA0–PTA5: Pins have programmable keyboard interrupt and pull up
ADC pins only available on MC68HC908QL4 and MC68HC908QL2
Figure 11-1. Block Diagram Highlighting OSC Block and Pins
Data Sheet
104
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Functional Description
11.3.1 Internal Oscillator
The internal oscillator circuit is designed for use with no external components to
provide a clock source with tolerance less than ±25% untrimmed. An 8-bit trimming
register allows the adjust to a tolerance of less than ±5%.
The internal oscillator will generate a clock of 25.6 MHz typical (INTCLK) resulting
in a maximum bus speed (internal clock ÷ 4) of 6.4 MHz. The bus clock is software
selectable to be 3.2 MHz, which is the default frequency after reset. The 3.2 MHz
selection is required for applications running at 3.3 V. The maximum frequency at
5 V is 8 MHz, since the internal oscillator will have a ±25% tolerance (pre-trim),
then the +25% case should not allow a frequency higher than 8 MHz:
6.4 MHz + 25% = 8 MHz for 5 V operation
3.2 MHz + 25% = 4 MHz for 3.3 V operation
Figure 11-3 shows how BUSCLKX4 is derived from INTCLK and, like the RC
oscillator, OSC2 can output BUSCLKX4 by setting OSC2EN in PTAPUE register.
See Section 12. Input/Output Ports (PORTS).
11.3.1.1 Internal Oscillator Trimming
The 8-bit trimming register, OSCTRIM, allows a clock period adjust of +127 and
–128 steps. Increasing OSCTRIM value increases the clock period. Trimming
allows the internal clock frequency to be set to 25.6 MHz ± 5%.
There’s an option to order a trimmed version of MC68HC908QL4. The trimming
value will be provided in a known FLASH location, $FFC0. So that the user would
be able to copy this byte from the FLASH to the OSCTRIM register right at the
beginning of assembly code.
Reset loads OSCTRIM with a default value of $80.
11.3.1.2 Internal to External Clock Switching
When external clock source (external OSC, RC, or XTAL) is desired, the user must
perform the following steps:
1. For external crystal circuits only, OSCOPT[1:0] = 1:1: To help precharge an
external crystal oscillator, set PTA4 (OSC2) as an output and drive high for
several cycles. This may help the crystal circuit start more robustly.
2. Set CONFIG2 bits OSCOPT[1:0] according to Table 11-2. The oscillator
module control logic will then set OSC1 as an external clock input and, if the
external crystal option is selected, OSC2 will also be set as the clock output.
3. Create a software delay to wait the stabilization time needed for the selected
clock source (crystal, resonator, RC) as recommended by the component
manufacturer. A good rule of thumb for crystal oscillators is to wait
4096 cycles of the crystal frequency, i.e., for a 4-MHz crystal, wait
approximately 1 ms.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
105
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module (OSC)
4. After the manufacturer’s recommended delay has elapsed, the ECGON bit
in the OSC status register (OSCSTAT) needs to be set by the user software.
5. After ECGON set is detected, the OSC module checks for oscillator activity
by waiting two external clock rising edges.
6. The OSC module then switches to the external clock. Logic provides a glitch
free transition.
7. The OSC module first sets the ECGST bit in the OSCSTAT register and then
stops the internal oscillator.
NOTE:
Once transition to the external clock is done, the internal oscillator will only be
reactivated with reset. No post-switch clock monitor feature is implemented (clock
does not switch back to internal if external clock dies).
11.3.2 External Oscillator
The external clock option is designed for use when a clock signal is available in the
application to provide a clock source to the microcontroller. The OSC1 pin is
enabled as an input by the oscillator module. The clock signal is used directly to
create BUSCLKX4 and also divided by two to create BUSCLKX2.
In this configuration, the OSC2 pin cannot output BUSCLKX4. So the OSC2EN bit
in the port A pullup enable register will be clear to enable PTA4 I/O functions on
the pin.
11.3.3 XTAL Oscillator
The XTAL oscillator circuit is designed for use with an external crystal or ceramic
resonator to provide an accurate clock source. In this configuration, the OSC2 pin
is dedicated to the external crystal circuit. The OSC2EN bit in the port A pullup
enable register has no effect when this clock mode is selected.
In its typical configuration, the XTAL oscillator is connected in a Pierce oscillator
configuration, as shown in Figure 11-2. This figure shows only the logical
representation of the internal components and may not represent actual circuitry.
The oscillator configuration uses five components:
•
•
•
•
•
Crystal, X1
Fixed capacitor, C1
Tuning capacitor, C2 (can also be a fixed capacitor)
Feedback resistor, RB
Series resistor, RS (optional)
NOTE:
The series resistor (RS) is included in the diagram to follow strict Pierce oscillator
guidelines and may not be required for all ranges of operation, especially with high
frequency crystals. Refer to the crystal manufacturer’s data for more information.
Data Sheet
106
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Oscillator Module (OSC)
MOTOROLA
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module Signals
FROM SIM
TO SIM
TO SIM
BUSCLKX2
÷ 2
BUSCLKX4
XTALCLK
SIMOSCEN
MCU
OSC1
OSC2
(1)
RS
RB
X1
Note 1.
RS can be zero (shorted) when used with
higher-frequency crystals. Refer
to manufacturer’s data. See Section 17.
Electrical Specifications for
C1
C2
component value requirements.
Figure 11-2. XTAL Oscillator External Connections
11.3.4 RC Oscillator
The RC oscillator circuit is designed for use with external R to provide a clock
source with tolerance less than 25%.
In its typical configuration, the RC oscillator requires two external components, one
R and one C. In the MC68HC908QL4, the capacitor is internal to the chip. The R
value should have a tolerance of 1% or less, to obtain a clock source with less than
25% tolerance. The oscillator configuration uses one component, REXT
.
In this configuration, the OSC2 pin can be left in the reset state as PTA4. Or, the
OSC2EN bit in the port A pullup enable register can be set to enable the OSC2
output function on the pin. Enabling the OSC2 output slightly increases the external
RC oscillator frequency, fRCCLK. See Figure 11-3.
11.4 Oscillator Module Signals
The following paragraphs describe the signals that are inputs to and outputs from
the oscillator module.
11.4.1 Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1)
The OSC1 pin is either an input to the crystal oscillator amplifier, an input to the RC
oscillator circuit, or an external clock source.
For the internal oscillator configuration, the OSC1 pin can assume other functions
according to Table 1-3. Function Priority in Shared Pins.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
107
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module (OSC)
OSCRCOPT
TO SIM
FROM SIM
TO SIM
BUSCLKX2
INTCLK
RCCLK
0
1
BUSCLKX4
SIMOSCEN
EXTERNAL RC
OSCILLATOR
EN
÷ 2
1
0
PTA4
I/O
PTA4
OSC2EN
MCU
OSC1
PTA4/BUSCLKX4 (OSC2)
VDD
See Section 17. Electrical Specifications
REXT
for component value requirements.
Figure 11-3. RC Oscillator External Connections
11.4.2 Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2/PTA4/BUSCLKX4)
For the XTAL oscillator device, the OSC2 pin is the crystal oscillator inverting
amplifier output.
For the external clock option, the OSC2 pin is dedicated to the PTA4 I/O function.
The OSC2EN bit has no effect.
For the internal oscillator or RC oscillator options, the OSC2 pin can assume other
functions according to Table 1-3. Function Priority in Shared Pins, or the output
of the oscillator clock (BUSCLKX4).
Table 11-1. OSC2 Pin Function
Option
OSC2 Pin Function
Inverting OSC1
PTA4 I/O
XTAL oscillator
External clock
Internal oscillator
or
Controlled by OSC2EN bit in PTAPUE register
OSC2EN = 0: PTA4 I/O
RC oscillator
OSC2EN = 1: BUSCLKX4 output
Data Sheet
108
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module Signals
11.4.3 Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN)
The SIMOSCEN signal comes from the system integration module (SIM) and
enables/disables either the XTAL oscillator circuit, the RC oscillator, or the internal
oscillator.
11.4.4 XTAL Oscillator Clock (XTALCLK)
XTALCLK is the XTAL oscillator output signal. It runs at the full speed of the crystal
(fXCLK) and comes directly from the crystal oscillator circuit. Figure 11-2 shows
only the logical relation of XTALCLK to OSC1 and OSC2 and may not represent
the actual circuitry. The duty cycle of XTALCLK is unknown and may depend on
the crystal and other external factors. Also, the frequency and amplitude of
XTALCLK can be unstable at start up.
11.4.5 RC Oscillator Clock (RCCLK)
RCCLK is the RC oscillator output signal. Its frequency is directly proportional to
the time constant of external R and internal C. Figure 11-3 shows only the logical
relation of RCCLK to OSC1 and may not represent the actual circuitry.
11.4.6 Internal Oscillator Clock (INTCLK)
INTCLK is the internal oscillator output signal. INTCLK is software selectable to be
12.8 MHz or 25.6 MHz, but it can also trimmed using the oscillator trimming feature
of the OSCTRIM register (see 11.3.1.1 Internal Oscillator Trimming).
11.4.7 Oscillator Out 2 (BUSCLKX4)
BUSCLKX4 is the same as the input clock (XTALCLK, RCCLK, or INTCLK). This
signal is driven to the SIM module and is used to determine the COP cycles.
11.4.8 Oscillator Out (BUSCLKX2)
The frequency of this signal is equal to half of the BUSCLKX4, this signal is driven
to the SIM for generation of the bus clocks used by the CPU and other modules on
the MCU. BUSCLKX2 will be divided again in the SIM and results in the internal
bus frequency being one fourth of either the XTALCLK, RCCLK, or INTCLK
frequency.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
109
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module (OSC)
11.5 Low Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low-power consumption standby
modes.
11.5.1 Wait Mode
11.5.2 Stop Mode
The WAIT instruction has no effect on the oscillator logic. BUSCLKX2 and
BUSCLKX4 continue to drive to the SIM module.
The STOP instruction disables either the XTALCLK, the RCCLK, or INTCLK
output, hence BUSCLKX2 and BUSCLKX4.
11.6 Oscillator During Break Mode
The oscillator continues to drive BUSCLKX2 and BUSCLKX4 when the device
enters the break state.
11.7 CONFIG2 Options
Two CONFIG2 register options affect the operation of the oscillator module:
OSCOPT1 and OSCOPT0. All CONFIG2 register bits will have a default
configuration. Refer to Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and
CONFIG2) for more information on how the CONFIG2 register is used.
Table 11-2 shows how the OSCOPT bits are used to select the oscillator clock
source.
Table 11-2. Oscillator Modes
OSCOPT1
OSCOPT0
Oscillator Modes
Internal oscillator
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
External oscillator
External RC
External crystal
Data Sheet
110
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Input/Output (I/O) Registers
11.8 Input/Output (I/O) Registers
The oscillator module contains these two registers:
1. Oscillator status register (OSCSTAT)
2. Oscillator trim register (OSCTRIM)
11.8.1 Oscillator Status Register
The oscillator status register (OSCSTAT) contains the bits for switching from
internal to external clock sources.
$0036
Address:
Bit 7
6
5
R
0
4
R
0
3
R
0
2
BFS
0
1
ECGON
0
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
ECGST
R
R
0
0
0
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
R
Figure 11-4. Oscillator Status Register (OSCSTAT)
BFS — Bus Frequency Select Bit
This read/write bit enables the bus frequency to be increased for 5-V
applications from 3.2 MHz to 6.4 MHz when running off the internal oscillator.
1 = 6.4 MHz Bus Frequency
0 = 3.2 MHz Bus Frequency
ECGON — External Clock Generator On Bit
This read/write bit enables external clock generator, so that the switching
process can be initiated. This bit is forced low during reset. This bit is ignored in
monitor mode with the internal oscillator bypassed.
1 = External clock generator enabled
0 = External clock generator disabled
ECGST — External Clock Status Bit
This read-only bit indicates whether or not an external clock source is engaged
to drive the system clock.
1 = An external clock source engaged
0 = An external clock source disengaged
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
111
Oscillator Module (OSC)
Oscillator Module (OSC)
11.8.2 Oscillator Trim Register (OSCTRIM)
$0038
Address:
Bit 7
6
TRIM6
0
5
TRIM5
0
4
TRIM4
0
3
TRIM3
0
2
TRIM2
0
1
TRIM1
0
Bit 0
TRIM0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
TRIM7
1
Figure 11-5. Oscillator Trim Register (OSCTRIM)
TRIM7–TRIM0 — Internal Oscillator Trim Factor Bits
These read/write bits change the size of the internal capacitor used by the
internal oscillator. By measuring the period of the internal clock and adjusting
this factor accordingly, the frequency of the internal clock can be fine tuned.
Increasing (decreasing) this factor by one increases (decreases) the period by
approximately 0.2% of the untrimmed period (the period for TRIM = $80). The
trimmed frequency is guaranteed not to vary by more than ±5% over the full
specified range of temperature and voltage. The reset value is $80, which sets
the frequency to 12.8 MHz (3.2 MHz bus speed, provided BFS = 0) ±25%.
Data Sheet
112
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Oscillator Module (OSC)
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 12. Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
12.1 Introduction
MC68HC908QL4, MC68HC908QL3, MC68HC908QL2, and MC68HC908QL4
have thirteen bidirectional pins and one input only pin. All input/output (I/O) pins are
programmable as inputs or outputs.
NOTE:
Connect any unused I/O pins to an appropriate logic level, either VDD or VSS.
Although the I/O ports do not require termination for proper operation, termination
reduces excess current consumption and the possibility of electrostatic damage.
Figure 12-1 provides a summary of the I/O registers.
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
AWUL
PTA2
Port A Data Register
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA1
PTA0
$0000
(PTA) Write:
See page 114.
Port B Data Register
Reset:
Read:
Unaffected by reset
PTB4 PTB3
Unaffected by reset
PTB7
0
PTB6
0
PTB5
PTB2
0
PTB1
PTB0
$0001
$0004
$0005
$000B
$000C
(PTB) Write:
See page 117.
Data Direction Register A
Reset:
Read:
DDRA5
DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA1
DDRA0
(DDRA) Write:
See page 115.
Data Direction Register B
Reset:
Read:
0
0
DDRB6
0
0
DDRB5
0
0
DDRB4
0
0
DDRB3
0
0
DDRB2
0
0
DDRB1
0
0
DDRB0
0
DDRB7
(DDRB) Write:
See page 117.
Port A Input Pullup Enable
Reset:
Read:
0
OSC2EN
0
PTAPUE5 PTAPUE4 PTAPUE3 PTAPUE2 PTAPUE1 PTAPUE0
Register (PTAPUE) Write:
See page 116.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Port B Input Pullup Enable
PTBPUE7 PTBPUE6 PTBPUE5 PTBPUE4 PTBPUE3 PTBPUE2 PTBPUE1 PTBPUE0
Register (PTBPUE) Write:
See page 119.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-1. I/O Port Register Summary
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
113
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
12.2 Port A
Port A is an 6-bit special function port that shares all six of its pins with the keyboard
interrupt (KBI) module (see Section 9. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI)). Each
port A pin also has a software configurable pullup device if the corresponding port
pin is configured as an input port.
NOTE:
PTA2 is input only. PTA0, PTA1, PTA4, and PTA5 can also serve as ESCI pins
When the IRQ function is enabled in the configuration register 2 (CONFIG2), bit 2
of the port A data register (PTA) will always read a 0. In this case, the BIH and BIL
instructions can be used to read the logic level on the PTA2 pin. When the IRQ
function is disabled, these instructions will behave as if the PTA2 pin is a logic 1.
However, reading bit 2 of PTA will read the actual logic level on the pin.
12.2.1 Port A Data Register
The port A data register (PTA) contains a data latch for each of the six port A pins.
$0000
Address:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
0
AWUL
PTA2
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA1
PTA0
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
KBI4 KBI3
Additional Functions:
KBI5
KBI2
KBI1
KBI0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-2. Port A Data Register (PTA)
PTA[5:0] — Port A Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of each port A
pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register A.
Reset has no effect on port A data.
AWUL — Auto Wakeup Latch Data Bit
This is a read-only bit which has the value of the auto wakeup interrupt request
latch. The wakeup request signal is generated internally. There is no PTA6 port
nor any of the associated bits such as PTA6 data register, pullup enable or
direction. See Section 4. Auto Wakeup Module (AWU)
KBI[5:0] — Port A Keyboard Interrupts
The keyboard interrupt enable bits, KBIE5–KBIE0, in the keyboard interrupt
control enable register (KBIER) enable the port A pins as external interrupt pins.
See Section 9. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI).
Data Sheet
114
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
MOTOROLA
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Port A
12.2.2 Data Direction Register A
Data direction register A (DDRA) determines whether each port A pin is an input or
an output. Writing a 1 to a DDRA bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding
port A pin; a 0 disables the output buffer.
$0004
Address:
Bit 7
6
0
5
DDRA5
0
4
DDRA4
0
3
DDRA3
0
2
0
1
DDRA1
0
Bit 0
DDRA0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-3. Data Direction Register A (DDRA)
DDRA[5:0] — Data Direction Register A Bits
These read/write bits control port A data direction. Reset clears DDRA[5:0],
configuring all port A pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port A pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port A pin configured as input
NOTE:
Avoid glitches on port A pins by writing to the port A data register before changing
data direction register A bits from 0 to 1.
Figure 12-4 shows the port A I/O logic.
READ DDRA ($0004)
PTAPUEx
WRITE DDRA ($0004)
DDRAx
RESET
30 k
WRITE PTA ($0000)
PTAx
PTAx
READ PTA ($0000)
TO KEYBOARD INTERRUPT CIRCUIT
Figure 12-4. Port A I/O Circuit
NOTE:
Figure 12-4 does not apply to PTA2
When DDRAx is a 1, reading address $0000 reads the PTAx data latch. When
DDRAx is a 0, reading address $0000 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data
latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
115
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
12.2.3 Port A Input Pullup Enable Register
The port A input pullup enable register (PTAPUE) contains a software configurable
pullup device for each if the six port A pins. Each bit is individually configurable and
requires the corresponding data direction register, DDRAx, to be configured as
input. Each pullup device is automatically and dynamically disabled when its
corresponding DDRAx bit is configured as output.
$000B
Address:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
OSC2EN
0
PTAPUE5 PTAPUE4 PTAPUE3 PTAPUE2 PTAPUE2 PTAPUE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 12-5. Port A Input Pullup Enable Register (PTAPUE)
OSC2EN — Enable PTA4 on OSC2 Pin
This read/write bit configures the OSC2 pin function when internal oscillator or
RC oscillator option is selected. This bit has no effect for the XTAL or external
oscillator options.
1 = OSC2 pin outputs the internal or RC oscillator clock (BUSCLKX4)
0 = OSC2 pin configured for PTA4 I/O, having all the interrupt and pullup
functions
PTAPUE[5:0] — Port A Input Pullup Enable Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable to enable pullup devices on
port A pins.
1 = Corresponding port A pin configured to have internal pull if its DDRA bit
is set to 0
0 = Pullup device is disconnected on the corresponding port A pin regardless
of the state of its DDRA bit
Table 12-1 summarizes the operation of the port A pins.
Table 12-1. Port A Pin Functions
Accesses to DDRA
Read/Write
Accesses to PTA
PTAPUE
Bit
DDRA
Bit
PTA
Bit
I/O Pin
Mode
Read
Write
(2)
X(1)
X
PTA5–PTA0(3)
PTA5–PTA0(3)
PTA5–PTA0(5)
1
0
X
0
0
1
DDRA5–DDRA0
DDRA5–DDRA0
DDRA5–DDRA0
Pin
Pin
Input, VDD
Input, Hi-Z(4)
Output
X
PTA5–PTA0
1. X = don’t care
2. I/O pin pulled to VDD by internal pullup.
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
4. Hi-Z = high impedance
5. Output does not apply to PTA2
Data Sheet
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
116
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Port B
12.3 Port B
Port B is an 8-bit general purpose I/O port. Port B is only available on the
MC68HC908QL4, MC68HC908QL3, and MC68HC908QL2.
12.3.1 Port B Data Register
The port B data register (PTB) contains a data latch for each of the eight port B
pins.
$0001
Address:
Bit 7
PTB7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
PTB6
PTB5
PTB4
PTB3
PTB2
PTB1
PTB0
Unaffected by reset
Figure 12-6. Port B Data Register (PTB)
PTB[7:0] — Port B Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of each port B
pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register B.
Reset has no effect on port B data.
12.3.2 Data Direction Register B
Data direction register B (DDRB) determines whether each port B pin is an input or
an output. Writing a 1 to a DDRB bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding
port B pin; a 0 disables the output buffer.
$0005
Address:
Bit 7
6
DDRB6
0
5
DDRB5
0
4
DDRB4
0
3
DDRB3
0
2
DDRB2
0
1
DDRB1
0
Bit 0
DDRB0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
DDRB7
0
Figure 12-7. Data Direction Register B (DDRB)
DDRB[7:0] — Data Direction Register B Bits
These read/write bits control port B data direction. Reset clears DDRB[7:0],
configuring all port B pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port B pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port B pin configured as input
NOTE:
Avoid glitches on port B pins by writing to the port B data register before changing
data direction register B bits from 0 to 1. Figure 12-8 shows the port B I/O logic.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
117
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
READ DDRB ($0005)
PTBPUEx
WRITE DDRB ($0005)
WRITE PTB ($0001)
DDRBx
PTBx
RESET
30 k
PTBx
READ PTB ($0001)
Figure 12-8. Port B I/O Circuit
When DDRBx is a 1, reading address $0001 reads the PTBx data latch. When
DDRBx is a 0, reading address $0001 reads the voltage level on the pin. The
data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit.
Table 12-2 summarizes the operation of the port B pins.
Table 12-2. Port B Pin Functions
Accesses to DDRB
Read/Write
Accesses to PTB
DDRB
Bit
PTB
Bit
I/O Pin
Mode
Read
Write
X(1)
X
Input, Hi-Z(2)
Output
PTB7–PTB0(3)
PTB7–PTB0
0
1
DDRB7–DDRB0
DDRB7–DDRB0
Pin
Pin
1. X = don’t care
2. Hi-Z = high impedance
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect the input.
Data Sheet
118
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Port B
12.3.3 Port B Input Pullup Enable Register
The port B input pullup enable register (PTBPUE) contains a software configurable
pullup device for each of the eight port B pins. Each bit is individually configurable
and requires the corresponding data direction register, DDRBx, be configured as
input. Each pullup device is automatically and dynamically disabled when its
corresponding DDRBx bit is configured as output.
$000C
Address:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
PTBPUE7 PTBPUE6 PTBPUE5 PTBPUE4 PTBPUE3 PTBPUE2 PTBPUE2 PTBPUE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 12-9. Port B Input Pullup Enable Register (PTBPUE)
PTBPUE[7:0] — Port B Input Pullup Enable Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable to enable pullup devices on
port B pins
1 = Corresponding port B pin configured to have internal pull if its DDRB bit
is set to 0
0 = Pullup device is disconnected on the corresponding port B pin regardless
of the state of its DDRB bit.
Table 12-3 summarizes the operation of the port B pins.
Table 12-3. Port B Pin Functions
Accesses to DDRB
Read/Write
Accesses to PTB
PTBPUE
Bit
DDRB
Bit
PTB
Bit
I/O Pin
Mode
Read
Write
(2)
X(1)
X
PTB7–PTB0(3)
1
0
DDRB7–DDRB0
Pin
Input, VDD
Input, Hi-Z(4)
Output
PTB7–PTB0(3)
PTB7–PTB0
0
0
1
DDRB7–DDRB0
DDRB7–DDRB0
Pin
X
X
PTB7–PTB0
1. X = don’t care
2. I/O pin pulled to VDD by internal pullup.
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
4. Hi-Z = high impedance
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Data Sheet
119
MOTOROLA
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Data Sheet
120
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Input/Output Ports (PORTS)
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 13. System Integration Module (SIM)
13.1 Introduction
This section describes the system integration module (SIM), which supports up to
24 external and/or internal interrupts. Together with the central processor unit
(CPU), the SIM controls all microcontroller unit (MCU) activities. A block diagram
of the SIM is shown in Figure 13-1. Figure 13-2 is a summary of the SIM I/O
registers. The SIM is a system state controller that coordinates CPU and exception
timing.
The SIM is responsible for:
•
Bus clock generation and control for CPU and peripherals
–
–
Stop/wait/reset/break entry and recovery
Internal clock control
•
•
Master reset control, including power-on reset (POR) and computer
operating properly (COP) timeout
Interrupt control:
–
–
–
Acknowledge timing
Arbitration control timing
Vector address generation
•
CPU enable/disable timing
13.2 RST and IRQ Pins Initialization
RST and IRQ pins come out of reset as PTA3 and PTA2 respectively. RST and IRQ
functions can be activated by programing CONFIG2 accordingly. Refer to
Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2).
13.3 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation
The bus clock generator provides system clock signals for the CPU and peripherals
on the MCU. The system clocks are generated from an incoming clock,
BUSCLKX2, as shown in Figure 13-3.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
121
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
MODULE STOP
MODULE WAIT
CPU STOP (FROM CPU)
CPU WAIT (FROM CPU)
STOP/WAIT
CONTROL
SIMOSCEN (TO OSCILLATOR)
SIM
COUNTER
COP CLOCK
BUSCLKX4 (FROM OSCILLATOR)
BUSCLKX2 (FROM OSCILLATOR)
÷2
VDD
CLOCK
CONTROL
CLOCK GENERATORS
INTERNAL CLOCKS
INTERNAL
PULL-UP
ILLEGAL OPCODE (FROM CPU)
ILLEGAL ADDRESS (FROM ADDRESS
MAP DECODERS)
RESET
PIN LOGIC
POR CONTROL
RESET PIN CONTROL
MASTER
RESET
CONTROL
COP TIMEOUT (FROM COP MODULE)
LVI RESET (FROM LVI MODULE)
SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER
FORCED MON MODE ENTRY (FROM MENRST MODULE)
RESET
INTERRUPT SOURCES
CPU INTERFACE
INTERRUPT CONTROL
AND PRIORITY DECODE
Figure 13-1. SIM Block Diagram
Table 13-1. Signal Name Conventions
Signal Name
Description
BUSCLKX4
Buffered clock from the internal, RC or XTAL oscillator circuit.
The BUSCLKX4 frequency divided by two. This signal is again divided by two in the SIM to
generate the internal bus clocks (bus clock = BUSCLKX4 ÷ 4).
BUSCLKX2
Address bus
Data bus
PORRST
IRST
Internal address bus
Internal data bus
Signal from the power-on reset module to the SIM
Internal reset signal
R/W
Read/write signal
Data Sheet
122
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
R
6
R
0
5
R
0
4
R
0
3
R
0
2
R
0
1
Bit 0
R
Read:
SBSW
Note 1
0
Break Status Register
$FE00
(BSR) Write:
See page 138.
Reset:
0
0
1. Writing a 0 clears SBSW.
Read:
POR
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
MODRST
LVI
0
SIM Reset Status Register
$FE01
$FE02
(SRSR) Write:
See page 137.
POR:
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Read:
Break Flag Control
Register (BFCR) Write:
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
$FE03
$FE04
$FE05
$FE06
See page 138.
Reset:
0
0
Read:
IF5
R
0
IF4
R
0
IF3
R
0
0
R
0
IF1
0
R
0
0
R
Interrupt Status Register 1
(INT1) Write:
R
R
See page 132.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
IF14
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Interrupt Status Register 2
(INT2) Write:
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
R
0
R
See page 133.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IF15
R
Interrupt Status Register 3
(INT3) Write:
See page 133.
R
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
R
0
Reset:
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 13-2. SIM I/O Register Summary
FROM
OSCILLATOR
BUSCLKX4
BUSCLKX2
SIM COUNTER
FROM
OSCILLATOR
BUS CLOCK
GENERATORS
÷ 2
SIM
Figure 13-3. SIM Clock Signals
13.3.1 Bus Timing
In user mode, the internal bus frequency is the oscillator frequency (BUSCLKX4)
divided by four.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
123
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
13.3.2 Clock Start-Up from POR
When the power-on reset module generates a reset, the clocks to the CPU and
peripherals are inactive and held in an inactive phase until after the 4096
BUSCLKX4 cycle POR time out has completed. The IBUS clocks start upon
completion of the time out.
13.3.3 Clocks in Stop Mode and Wait Mode
Upon exit from stop mode by an interrupt or reset, the SIM allows BUSCLKX4 to
clock the SIM counter. The CPU and peripheral clocks do not become active until
after the stop delay time out. This time out is selectable as 4096 or 32 BUSCLKX4
cycles. See 13.7.2 Stop Mode.
In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive. The SIM also produces two sets of
clocks for other modules. Refer to the wait mode subsection of each module to see
if the module is active or inactive in wait mode. Some modules can be programmed
to be active in wait mode.
13.4 Reset and System Initialization
The MCU has these reset sources:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Power-on reset module (POR)
External reset pin (RST)
Computer operating properly module (COP)
Low-voltage inhibit module (LVI)
Illegal opcode
Illegal address
All of these resets produce the vector $FFFE–FFFF ($FEFE–FEFF in monitor
mode) and assert the internal reset signal (IRST). IRST causes all registers to be
returned to their default values and all modules to be returned to their reset states.
An internal reset clears the SIM counter (see 13.5 SIM Counter), but an external
reset does not. Each of the resets sets a corresponding bit in the SIM reset status
register (SRSR). See 13.8 SIM Registers.
13.4.1 External Pin Reset
The RST pin circuits include an internal pullup device. Pulling the asynchronous
RST pin low halts all processing. The PIN bit of the SIM reset status register
(SRSR) is set as long as RST is held low for a minimum of 67 BUSCLKX4 cycles,
assuming that the POR was not the source of the reset. See Table 13-2 for details.
Figure 13-4 shows the relative timing. The RST pin function is only available if the
RSTEN bit is set in the CONFIG1 register.
Data Sheet
124
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Reset and System Initialization
Table 13-2. PIN Bit Set Timing
Reset Type
POR
Number of Cycles Required to Set PIN
4163 (4096 + 64 + 3)
All others
67 (64 + 3)
BUSCLKX2
RST
ADDRESS BUS
VECT H VECT L
PC
Figure 13-4. External Reset Timing
13.4.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources
The RST pin is initially setup as a general-purpose input after a POR. Setting the
RSTEN bit in the CONFIG1 register enables the pin for the reset function. This
section assumes the RSTEN bit is set when describing activity on the RST pin.
All internal reset sources actively pull the RST pin low for 32 BUSCLKX4 cycles to
allow resetting of external peripherals. The internal reset signal IRST continues to
be asserted for an additional 32 cycles (see Figure 13-5). An internal reset can be
caused by an illegal address, illegal opcode, COP time out, LVI, or POR (see
Figure 13-6).
IRST
RSTPULLED LOW BY MCU
32 CYCLES
RST
32 CYCLES
BUSCLKX4
ADDRESS
BUS
VECTOR HIGH
Figure 13-5. Internal Reset Timing
ILLEGAL ADDRESS RST
ILLEGAL OPCODE RST
COPRST
POR
INTERNAL RESET
LVI
Figure 13-6. Sources of Internal Reset
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
125
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
NOTE:
For POR resets, the SIM cycles through 4096 BUSCLKX4 cycles. The internal
reset signal then follows the sequence from the falling edge of RST shown in
Figure 13-5.
The COP reset is asynchronous to the bus clock.
The active reset feature allows the part to issue a reset to peripherals and other
chips within a system built around the MCU.
13.4.2.1 Power-On Reset
When power is first applied to the MCU, the power-on reset module (POR)
generates a pulse to indicate that power on has occurred. SIM counter counts out
4096 BUSCLKX4 cycles. Sixty-four BUSCLKX4 cycles later, the CPU and
memories are released from reset to allow the reset vector sequence to occur.
At power on, the following events occur:
•
•
•
•
A POR pulse is generated.
The internal reset signal is asserted.
The SIM enables the oscillator to drive BUSCLKX4.
Internal clocks to the CPU and modules are held inactive for
4096 BUSCLKX4 cycles to allow stabilization of the oscillator.
•
The POR bit of the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set and all other bits
in the register are cleared.
See Figure 13-7.
OSC1
PORRST
4096
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
BUSCLKX4
BUSCLKX2
RST
(RST PIN IS A GENERAL-PURPOSE INPUT AFTER A POR)
ADDRESS BUS
$FFFE
$FFFF
Figure 13-7. POR Recovery
Data Sheet
126
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
SIM Counter
13.4.2.2 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset
An input to the SIM is reserved for the COP reset signal. The overflow of the COP
counter causes an internal reset and sets the COP bit in the SIM reset status
register (SRSR). The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal reset
sources.
To prevent a COP module time out, write any value to location $FFFF. Writing to
location $FFFF clears the COP counter and stages 12–5 of the SIM counter. The
SIM counter output, which occurs at least every (212 – 24) BUSCLKX4 cycles,
drives the COP counter. The COP should be serviced as soon as possible out of
reset to guarantee the maximum amount of time before the first time out.
The COP module is disabled during a break interrupt with monitor mode when
BDCOP bit is set in break auxiliary register (BRKAR).
13.4.2.3 Illegal Opcode Reset
The SIM decodes signals from the CPU to detect illegal instructions. An illegal
instruction sets the ILOP bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and causes a
reset.
If the stop enable bit, STOP, in the mask option register is 0, the SIM treats the
STOP instruction as an illegal opcode and causes an illegal opcode reset. The SIM
actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal reset sources.
13.4.2.4 Illegal Address Reset
An opcode fetch from an unmapped address generates an illegal address reset.
The SIM verifies that the CPU is fetching an opcode prior to asserting the ILAD bit
in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and resetting the MCU. A data fetch from
an unmapped address does not generate a reset. The SIM actively pulls down the
RST pin for all internal reset sources.
13.4.2.5 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset
The LVI asserts its output to the SIM when the VDD voltage falls to the LVI trip
voltage VTrip. The LVI bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set, and the
external reset pin (RST) is held low while the SIM counter counts out 4096
BUSCLKX4 cycles. Sixty-four BUSCLKX4 cycles later, the CPU and memories are
released from reset to allow the reset vector sequence to occur. The SIM actively
pulls down the (RST) pin for all internal reset sources.
13.5 SIM Counter
The SIM counter is used by the power-on reset module (POR) and in stop mode
recovery to allow the oscillator time to stabilize before enabling the internal bus
(IBUS) clocks. The SIM counter also serves as a prescaler for the computer
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
127
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
operating properly module (COP). The SIM counter uses 12 stages for counting,
followed by a 13th stage that triggers a reset of SIM counters and supplies the clock
for the COP module. The SIM counter is clocked by the falling edge of BUSCLKX4.
13.5.1 SIM Counter During Power-On Reset
The power-on reset module (POR) detects power applied to the MCU. At
power-on, the POR circuit asserts the signal PORRST. Once the SIM is initialized,
it enables the oscillator to drive the bus clock state machine.
13.5.2 SIM Counter During Stop Mode Recovery
The SIM counter also is used for stop mode recovery. The STOP instruction clears
the SIM counter. After an interrupt, break, or reset, the SIM senses the state of the
short stop recovery bit, SSREC, in the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1). If the
SSREC bit is a 1, then the stop recovery is reduced from the normal delay of 4096
BUSCLKX4 cycles down to 32 BUSCLKX4 cycles. This is ideal for applications
using canned oscillators that do not require long start-up times from stop mode.
External crystal applications should use the full stop recovery time, that is, with
SSREC cleared in the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1).
13.5.3 SIM Counter and Reset States
External reset has no effect on the SIM counter (see 13.7.2 Stop Mode for details.)
The SIM counter is free-running after all reset states. See 13.4.2 Active Resets
from Internal Sources for counter control and internal reset recovery sequences.
13.6 Exception Control
Normal sequential program execution can be changed in three different ways:
1. Interrupts
a. Maskable hardware CPU interrupts
b. Non-maskable software interrupt instruction (SWI)
2. Reset
3. Break interrupts
13.6.1 Interrupts
An interrupt temporarily changes the sequence of program execution to respond to
a particular event. Figure 13-8 flow charts the handling of system interrupts.
Interrupts are latched, and arbitration is performed in the SIM at the start of
interrupt processing. The arbitration result is a constant that the CPU uses to
determine which vector to fetch. Once an interrupt is latched by the SIM, no other
interrupt can take precedence, regardless of priority, until the latched interrupt is
serviced (or the I bit is cleared).
Data Sheet
128
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Exception Control
FROM RESET
YES
BREAK INTERRUPT?
NO
YES
I BIT SET?
NO
YES
YES
IRQ
INTERRUPT?
NO
TIMER
INTERRUPT?
NO
STACK CPU REGISTERS
SET I BIT
LOAD PC WITH INTERRUPT VECTOR
(AS MANY INTERRUPTS AS EXIST ON CHIP)
FETCH NEXT
INSTRUCTION
SWI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
YES
NO
RTI
INSTRUCTION?
UNSTACK CPU REGISTERS
EXECUTE INSTRUCTION
NO
Figure 13-8. Interrupt Processing
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
129
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
At the beginning of an interrupt, the CPU saves the CPU register contents on the
stack and sets the interrupt mask (I bit) to prevent additional interrupts. At the end
of an interrupt, the RTI instruction recovers the CPU register contents from the
stack so that normal processing can resume. Figure 13-9 shows interrupt entry
timing. Figure 13-10 shows interrupt recovery timing.
MODULE
INTERRUPT
I BIT
ADDRESS BUS
DATA BUS
R/W
DUMMY
SP
SP – 1
SP – 2
SP – 3
SP – 4
VECT H
VECT L START ADDR
DUMMY PC – 1[7:0] PC – 1[15:8]
X
A
CCR
V DATA H V DATA L OPCODE
Figure 13-9. Interrupt Entry
MODULE
INTERRUPT
I BIT
ADDRESS BUS
DATA BUS
R/W
SP – 4
SP – 3
SP – 2
SP – 1
SP
PC
PC + 1
CCR
A
X
PC – 1[7:0] PC – 1[15:8] OPCODE OPERAND
Figure 13-10. Interrupt Recovery
13.6.1.1 Hardware Interrupts
A hardware interrupt does not stop the current instruction. Processing of a
hardware interrupt begins after completion of the current instruction. When the
current instruction is complete, the SIM checks all pending hardware interrupts. If
interrupts are not masked (I bit clear in the condition code register), and if the
corresponding interrupt enable bit is set, the SIM proceeds with interrupt
processing; otherwise, the next instruction is fetched and executed.
If more than one interrupt is pending at the end of an instruction execution, the
highest priority interrupt is serviced first. Figure 13-11 demonstrates what happens
when two interrupts are pending. If an interrupt is pending upon exit from the
original interrupt service routine, the pending interrupt is serviced before the LDA
instruction is executed.
Data Sheet
130
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Exception Control
CLI
LDA #$FF
BACKGROUND ROUTINE
INT1
PSHH
INT1 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE
PULH
RTI
INT2
PSHH
INT2 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE
PULH
RTI
Figure 13-11. Interrupt Recognition Example
The LDA opcode is prefetched by both the INT1 and INT2 return-from-interrupt
(RTI) instructions. However, in the case of the INT1 RTI prefetch, this is a
redundant operation.
NOTE:
To maintain compatibility with the M6805 Family, the H register is not pushed on
the stack during interrupt entry. If the interrupt service routine modifies the H
register or uses the indexed addressing mode, software should save the H register
and then restore it prior to exiting the routine.
13.6.1.2 SWI Instruction
The SWI instruction is a non-maskable instruction that causes an interrupt
regardless of the state of the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register.
NOTE:
A software interrupt pushes PC onto the stack. A software interrupt does not push
PC – 1, as a hardware interrupt does.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
131
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
13.6.2 Interrupt Status Registers
The flags in the interrupt status registers identify maskable interrupt sources.
Table 13-3 summarizes the interrupt sources and the interrupt status register flags
that they set. The interrupt status registers can be useful for debugging.
Table 13-3. Interrupt Sources
INT
Register
Flag
Vector
Address
Mask(1)
Priority
Source
Flag
Reset
—
—
—
—
—
—
$FFFE–$FFFF
$FFFC–$FFFD
$FFFA–$FFFB
$FFF6–$FFF7
$FFF4–$FFF5
$FFF2–$FFF3
$FFEA–$FFEB
$FFE0–$FFE1
$FFDE–$FFDF
Highest
SWI instruction
IRQ pin
IRQF1 IMASK1
IF1
IF3
IF4
IF5
IF9
IF14
IF15
Timer channel 0 interrupt
Timer channel 1 interrupt
Timer overflow interrupt
SLIC interrupt
CH0F
CH1F
TOF
CH0IE
CH1IE
TOIE
SLCF
SLCIE
Keyboard interrupt
KEYF IMASKK
COCO AIEN
Lowest
ADC conversion complete interrupt
1. The I bit in the condition code register is a global mask for all interrupt sources except the SWI
instruction.
13.6.2.1 Interrupt Status Register 1
Address: $FE04
Bit 7
6
5
IF4
R
4
IF3
R
3
0
2
IF1
R
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
IF5
R
0
R
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 13-12. Interrupt Status Register 1 (INT1)
IF1 and IF3–IF5 — Interrupt Flags
These flags indicate the presence of interrupt requests from the sources shown
in Table 13-3.
1 = Interrupt request present
0 = No interrupt request present
Bit 0, 1, 3, and 7 — Always read 0
Data Sheet
132
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Exception Control
13.6.2.2 Interrupt Status Register 2
Address: $FE05
Bit 7
6
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
IF9
R
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
IF14
R
0
R
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 13-13. Interrupt Status Register 2 (INT2)
IF14 and IF11–IF9 — Interrupt Flags
These flags indicate the presence of interrupt requests from the sources shown
in Table 13-3.
1 = Interrupt request present
0 = No interrupt request present
Bit 0, 1, 3–6 — Always read 0
13.6.2.3 Interrupt Status Register 3
Address: $FE06
Bit 7
6
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
IF15
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
R
0
R
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 13-14. Interrupt Status Register 3 (INT3)
IF15 — Interrupt Flags
These flags indicate the presence of interrupt requests from the sources shown
in Table 13-3.
1 = Interrupt request present
0 = No interrupt request present
Bit 1–7 — Always read 0
13.6.3 Reset
All reset sources always have equal and highest priority and cannot be arbitrated.
13.6.4 Break Interrupts
The break module can stop normal program flow at a software programmable
break point by asserting its break interrupt output. (See Section 16. Development
Support.) The SIM puts the CPU into the break state by forcing it to the SWI vector
location. Refer to the break interrupt subsection of each module to see how each
module is affected by the break state.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
133
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
13.6.5 Status Flag Protection in Break Mode
The SIM controls whether status flags contained in other modules can be cleared
during break mode. The user can select whether flags are protected from being
cleared by properly initializing the break clear flag enable bit (BCFE) in the break
flag control register (BFCR).
Protecting flags in break mode ensures that set flags will not be cleared while in
break mode. This protection allows registers to be freely read and written during
break mode without losing status flag information.
Setting the BCFE bit enables the clearing mechanisms. Once cleared in break
mode, a flag remains cleared even when break mode is exited. Status flags with a
two-step clearing mechanism — for example, a read of one register followed by the
read or write of another — are protected, even when the first step is accomplished
prior to entering break mode. Upon leaving break mode, execution of the second
step will clear the flag as normal.
13.7 Low-Power Modes
Executing the WAIT or STOP instruction puts the MCU in a low
power-consumption mode for standby situations. The SIM holds the CPU in a
non-clocked state. The operation of each of these modes is described below. Both
STOP and WAIT clear the interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register, allowing
interrupts to occur.
13.7.1 Wait Mode
In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive while the peripheral clocks continue to
run. Figure 13-15 shows the timing for wait mode entry.
ADDRESS BUS
DATA BUS
R/W
WAIT ADDR
WAIT ADDR + 1
SAME
SAME
PREVIOUS DATA
NEXT OPCODE
SAME
SAME
NOTE: Previous data can be operand data or the WAIT opcode, depending on the
last instruction.
Figure 13-15. Wait Mode Entry Timing
A module that is active during wait mode can wake up the CPU with an interrupt if
the interrupt is enabled. Stacking for the interrupt begins one cycle after the WAIT
instruction during which the interrupt occurred. In wait mode, the CPU clocks are
inactive. Refer to the wait mode subsection of each module to see if the module is
active or inactive in wait mode. Some modules can be programmed to be active in
wait mode.
Data Sheet
134
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Low-Power Modes
Wait mode can also be exited by a reset (or break in emulation mode). A break
interrupt during wait mode sets the SIM break stop/wait bit, SBSW, in the break
status register (BSR). If the COP disable bit, COPD, in the configuration register
is 0, then the computer operating properly module (COP) is enabled and remains
active in wait mode.
Figure 13-16 and Figure 13-17 show the timing for wait recovery.
ADDRESS BUS
DATA BUS
$6E0B
$A6
$6E0C
$00FF
$00FE
$00FD
$00FC
$A6
$A6
$01
$0B
$6E
EXITSTOPWAIT
NOTE: EXITSTOPWAIT = RST pin OR CPU interrupt
Figure 13-16. Wait Recovery from Interrupt
32
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
ADDRESS BUS
$6E0B
$A6
RSTVCTH RSTVCTL
DATA BUS $A6
$A6
RST(1)
BUSCLKX4
1. RST is only available if the RSTEN bit in the CONFIG1 register is set.
Figure 13-17. Wait Recovery from Internal Reset
13.7.2 Stop Mode
In stop mode, the SIM counter is reset and the system clocks are disabled. An
interrupt request from a module can cause an exit from stop mode. Stacking for
interrupts begins after the selected stop recovery time has elapsed. Reset or break
also causes an exit from stop mode.
The SIM disables the oscillator signals (BUSCLKX2 and BUSCLKX4) in stop
mode, stopping the CPU and peripherals. Stop recovery time is selectable using
the SSREC bit in the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1). If SSREC is set, stop
recovery is reduced from the normal delay of 4096 BUSCLKX4 cycles down to 32.
This is ideal for the internal oscillator, RC oscillator, and external oscillator options
which do not require long start-up times from stop mode.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
135
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
NOTE:
External crystal applications should use the full stop recovery time by clearing the
SSREC bit.
The SIM counter is held in reset from the execution of the STOP instruction until
the beginning of stop recovery. It is then used to time the recovery period.
Figure 13-18 shows stop mode entry timing and Figure 13-19 shows the stop
mode recovery time from interrupt or break
NOTE:
To minimize stop current, all pins configured as inputs should be driven to a logic 1
or logic 0.
CPUSTOP
ADDRESS BUS
DATA BUS
R/W
STOP ADDR
STOP ADDR + 1
SAME
SAME
PREVIOUS DATA
NEXT OPCODE
SAME
SAME
NOTE: Previous data can be operand data or the STOP opcode, depending on the last
instruction.
Figure 13-18. Stop Mode Entry Timing
STOP RECOVERY PERIOD
BUSCLKX4
INTERRUPT
ADDRESS BUS
STOP + 2
STOP + 2
SP
SP – 1
SP – 2
SP – 3
STOP +1
Figure 13-19. Stop Mode Recovery from Interrupt
13.8 SIM Registers
The SIM has three memory mapped registers. Table 13-4 shows the mapping of
these registers.
Table 13-4. SIM Registers
Address
$FE00
$FE01
$FE03
Register
BSR
Access Mode
User
SRSR
BFCR
User
User
Data Sheet
136
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
SIM Registers
13.8.1 SIM Reset Status Register
This register contains seven flags that show the source of the last reset. Clear the
SIM reset status register by reading it. A power-on reset sets the POR bit and
clears all other bits in the register.
$FE01
Address:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
POR:
POR
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
MODRST
LVI
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 13-20. SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR)
POR — Power-On Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by POR circuit
0 = Read of SRSR
PIN — External Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by external reset pin (RST)
0 = POR or read of SRSR
COP — Computer Operating Properly Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by COP counter
0 = POR or read of SRSR
ILOP — Illegal Opcode Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by an illegal opcode
0 = POR or read of SRSR
ILAD — Illegal Address Reset Bit (opcode fetches only)
1 = Last reset caused by an opcode fetch from an illegal address
0 = POR or read of SRSR
MODRST — Monitor Mode Entry Module Reset bit
1 = Last reset caused by monitor mode entry when vector locations $FFFE
and $FFFF are $FF after POR while IRQ = VDD
0 = POR or read of SRSR
LVI — Low Voltage Inhibit Reset bit
1 = Last reset caused by LVI circuit
0 = POR or read of SRSR
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
137
System Integration Module (SIM)
System Integration Module (SIM)
13.8.2 Break Flag Control Register
The break control register (BFCR) contains a bit that enables software to clear
status bits while the MCU is in a break state.
$FE03
Address:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
= Reserved
R
Figure 13-21. Break Flag Control Register (BFCR)
BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing status
registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits during the break
state, the BCFE bit must be set.
1 = Status bits clearable during break
0 = Status bits not clearable during break
13.8.3 Break Status Register
The break status register (BSR) contains a flag to indicate that a break caused an
exit from wait mode. This register is only used in emulation mode.
Address: $FE00
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
SBSW
Note 1
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
= Reserved
1. Writing a 0 clears SBSW.
Figure 13-22. Break Status Register (BSR)
SBSW — SIM Break Stop/Wait
SBSW can be read within the break state SWI routine. The user can modify the
return address on the stack by subtracting one from it.
1 = Wait mode was exited by break interrupt
0 = Wait mode was not exited by break interrupt
Data Sheet
138
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 14. Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.1 Introduction
The slave LIN interface controller (SLIC) is designed to provide slave node
connectivity on a local interconnect network (LIN) sub-bus. LIN is an
open-standard serial protocol developed for the automotive industry to connect
sensors, motors, and actuators.
The SLIC provides full standard LIN message buffering for a slave node,
minimizing the need for CPU intervention. Routine protocol functions (such as
synchronization to the communication channel, reception, and verification of
header data) and generation of the checksum are handled automatically by the
SLIC. This allows application software to be greatly simplified relative to standard
UART implementations, as well as reducing the impact of interrupts needed in
those applications to handle each byte of a message independently.
Additionally, the SLIC has the ability to automatically synchronize to any LIN
message, regardless of the LIN bus bit rate (1–20 kbps), properly receiving that
message without prior programming of the target LIN bit rate. Furthermore, this can
even be accomplished using an untrimmed internal oscillator, provided it’s
accuracy is at least ±50% of nominal.
The SLIC also has a simple UART-like byte transfer mode, which allows the user
to send and receive single bytes of data in half-duplex 8-N-1 format (8-bit data, no
parity, 1 stop bit) without the need for LIN message framing.
Figure 14-2 is a block diagram of the SLIC module, showing the basic functional
blocks contained in the module.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
139
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
CLOCK
GENERATOR
(OSCILLATOR)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
SINGLE INTERRUPT
MODULE
M68HC08 CPU
PTB0/TCH0
PTB1
BREAK
MODULE
PTB2/AD4
PTB3/AD5
PTB4/SLCRX
PTB5/SLCTX
PTB6
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
KEYBOARD INTERRUPT
MODULE
PTB7
2-CH 16-BIT TIMER
MODULE
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL3: 4096 BYTES
MC68HC908QL2: 2048 BYTES
USER FLASH
SLAVE LIN INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
COP
MODULE
6-CHANNEL 10-BIT
ADC
MONITOR ROM
128 BYTES RAM
VDD
VSS
POWER SUPPLY
RST, IRQ: Pins have internal (about 30 kΩ) pull up
PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5: High current sink and source capability
PTA0–PTA5: Pins have programmable keyboard interrupt and pull up
ADC pins only available on MC68HC908QL4 and MC68HC908QL2
Figure 14-1. Block Diagram Highlighting SLIC Block and Pins
Data Sheet
140
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Features
LSVR AND LINIF
LSVR CONTROL
STATUS REGISTERS
CONTROL REGISTERS
LIN PROTOCOL STATE MACHINE
(PSM)
MESSAGE BUFFER — 9 BYTES
SLCID
SLCD7, SLCD6, SLCD5, SLCD4
SLCD3, SLCD2, SLCD1, SLCD0
SHADOW REGISTER
1 BYTE
SLIC CLOCK
BUS CLOCK
DIGITAL RX FILTER
DIGITAL RX FILTER
PRESCALER (RXFP[1:0])
SLCTX
SLCRX
Figure 14-2. SLIC Module Block Diagram
14.2 Features
The SLIC includes these distinctive features:
•
•
Full LIN message buffering of identifier and 8 data bytes
Automatic bit rate and LIN message frame synchronization:
–
–
–
–
–
No prior programming of bit rate required, 1–20 kbps LIN bus speed
operation
All LIN messages will be received (no message loss due to
synchronization process)
Input clock tolerance as high as ±50%, allowing internal oscillator to
remain untrimmed
Incoming break symbols always allowed to be 10 or more bit times
without message loss
Supports automatic software trimming of internal oscillator using LIN
synchronization data
•
Automatic processing and verification of LIN SYNCH BREAK and SYNCH
BYTE
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
141
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Automatic checksum calculation and verification with error reporting
Maximum of two interrupts per standard LIN message frame with no errors
Full LIN error checking and reporting
High-speed LIN capability up to 83.33 kbps to 120.00 kbps(1)
Configurable digital receive filter
Streamlined interrupt servicing through use of a state vector register
Switchable UART-like byte transfer mode for processing bytes one at a time
without LIN message framing constraints
•
Enhanced checksum (includes ID) generation and verification
14.3 Modes of Operation
Figure 14-3 shows the modes in which the SLIC will operate.
POWER OFF
V
DD <= VDD (MIN)
VDD > VDD (MIN) AND ANY
MCU RESET SOURCE ASSERTED
(FROM ANY MODE)
ANY MCU RESET SOURCE
ASSERTED
SLIC RESET
NO MCU RESET SOURCE ASSERTED
INITREQ = 0; (INITACK = 0)
SLIC INIT
REQUESTED
(INITACK = 1)
SLIC DISABLED
(FROM ANY MODE)
INITREQ SET TO 1 IN
SLCC1 REGISTER
SLCE SET IN SLCC2 REGISTER
SLCE CLEARED IN
SLCC2 REGISTER
NETWORK ACTIVITY
OR OTHER MCU
WAKEUP
NETWORK ACTIVITY OR OTHER
MCU WAKEUP
SLIC RUN
SLIC WAIT
SLIC STOP
(WAIT INSTRUCTION
AND SLCWCM = 0)
STOP INSTRUCTION
(WAIT INSTRUCTION
AND SLCWCM = 1)
Figure 14-3. SLIC Operating Modes
1. Maximum bit rate of SLIC module dependent upon frequency of SLIC input clock.
Data Sheet
142
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Modes of Operation
14.3.1 Power Off
This mode is entered from the reset mode whenever the SLIC module supply
voltage VDD drops below its minimum specified value for the SLIC module to
guarantee operation. The SLIC module will be placed in the reset mode by a
system low-voltage reset (LVR) before being powered down. In this mode, the pin
input and output specifications are not guaranteed.
14.3.2 Reset
This mode is entered from the power off mode whenever the SLIC module supply
voltage VDD rises above its minimum specified value (VDD(MIN)) and some MCU
reset source is asserted. To prevent the SLIC from entering an unknown state, the
internal MCU reset is asserted while powering up the SLIC module. SLIC reset
mode is also entered from any other mode as soon as one of the MCU's possible
reset sources (e.g., LVR, POR, COP watchdog, RST pin, etc.) is asserted. SLIC
reset mode may also be entered by the user software by asserting the INITREQ
bit. INITACK indicates whether the SLIC module is in the reset mode as a result of
writing INITREQ in SLCC1. While in the reset state the SLIC module clocks are
stopped. Clearing the INITREQ allows the SLIC to proceed and enter SLIC run
mode (if SLCE is set). The module will clear INITACK once the module has left
reset mode and the SLIC will seek the next LIN header. It is the responsibility of the
user to verify that this operation is compatible with the application before
implementing this feature.
In this mode, the internal SLIC module voltage references are operative, VDD is
supplied to the internal circuits, which are held in their reset state and the internal
SLIC module system clock is running. Registers will assume their reset condition.
Outputs are held in their programmed reset state, inputs and network activity are
ignored.
14.3.3 SLIC Disabled
This mode is entered from the reset mode after all MCU reset sources are no
longer asserted or INITREQ bit is cleared by the user and the SLIC module clears
the INITACK bit. It is entered from the run mode whenever the SLCE bit in the
SLCC2 register is cleared. In this mode the SLIC clock is stopped to conserve
power and allow the SLIC module to be configured for proper operation on the LIN
bus. The IP bus interface clocks are left running in this mode to allow access to all
SLIC module registers for initialization.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
143
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.3.4 SLIC Run
This mode is entered from the SLIC disabled mode when the SLCE bit in the
SLCC2 register is set. It is entered from the SLIC wait mode whenever activity is
sensed on the LIN bus or some other MCU source wakes the CPU out of wait
mode.
It is entered from the SLIC stop mode whenever network activity is sensed or some
other MCU source wakes the CPU out of stop mode. Messages will not be received
properly until the clocks have stabilized and the CPU is also in the run mode.
14.3.5 SLIC Wait (Core Specific)
This power conserving mode is automatically entered from the run mode whenever
the CPU executes a WAIT instruction and the SLCWCM bit in the SLCC1 register
is previously cleared. In this mode, the SLIC module internal clocks continue to run.
Any activity on the LIN network will cause the SLIC module to exit SLIC wait mode
and return to SLIC run.
14.3.6 Wakeup from SLIC Wait with CPU in WAIT
If the CPU executes the WAIT instruction and the SLIC module enters the wait
mode (SLCWCM = 0), the clocks to the SLIC module as well as the clocks in the
MCU continue to run. Therefore, the message which wakes up the SLIC module
from WAIT and the CPU from wait mode will also be received correctly by the SLIC
module. This is because all of the required clocks continue to run in the SLIC
module in wait mode.
14.3.7 SLIC Stop (Core Specific)
This power conserving mode is automatically entered from the run mode whenever
the CPU executes a STOP instruction, or if the CPU executes a WAIT instruction
and the SLCWCM bit in the SLCC1 register is previously set. In this mode, the SLIC
internal clocks are stopped. Any activity on the network will cause the SLIC module
to exit SLIC stop mode and generate an unmaskable interrupt of the CPU. This
wakeup interrupt state is reflected in the SLCSV, encoded as the highest priority
interrupt. This interrupt can be cleared by the CPU with a read of the SLCSV and
clearing of the SLCF interrupt flag. Depending upon which low-power mode
instruction the CPU executes to cause the SLIC module to enter SLIC stop, the
message which wakes up the SLIC module (and the CPU) may or may not be
received.
Data Sheet
144
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Modes of Operation
There are two different possibilities:
1. Wakeup from SLIC Stop with CPU in STOP
When the CPU executes the STOP instruction, all clocks in the MCU,
including clocks to the SLIC module, are turned off. Therefore, the message
which wakes up the SLIC module and the CPU from stop mode will not be
received. This is due primarily to the amount of time required for the MCU's
oscillator to stabilize before the clocks can be applied internally to the other
MCU modules, including the SLIC module.
2. Wakeup from SLIC Stop with CPU in WAIT
If the CPU executes the WAIT instruction and the SLIC module enters the
stop mode (SLCWCM = 1), the clocks to the SLIC module are turned off, but
the clocks in the MCU continue to run. Therefore, the message which wakes
up the SLIC module from stop and the CPU from wait mode will be received
correctly by the SLIC module. This is because very little time is required for
the CPU to turn the clocks to the SLIC module back on once the wakeup
interrupt occurs.
NOTE:
While the SLIC module will correctly receive a message which arrives when the
SLIC module is in stop or wait mode and the MCU is in wait mode, if the user enters
this mode while a message is being received, the data in the message will become
corrupted. This is due to the steps required for the SLIC module to resume
operation upon exiting stop or wait mode, and its subsequent resynchronization
with the LIN bus.
14.3.8 Normal and Emulation Mode Operation (Core Specific)
The SLIC module operates in the same manner in all normal and emulation modes.
All SLIC module registers can be read and written except those that are reserved,
unimplemented, or write once. The user must be careful not to unintentionally write
a register when using 16-bit writes in order to avoid unexpected SLIC module
behavior.
14.3.9 Special Mode Operation (Core Specific)
Some aspects of SLIC module operation can be modified in special test mode. This
mode is reserved for internal use only.
14.3.10 Low-Power Options (Core Specific)
The SLIC module can save power in disabled, wait, and stop modes. A complete
description of what the SLIC module does while in a low-power mode can be found
in 14.3 Modes of Operation.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
145
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.4 External Signal Description
The SLIC module has only two external signals which may be brought out to MCU
pins. These might share functionality with other modules or general-purpose
input/output functions of the pins. When used in a LIN system, these pins will be
connected to the TX and RX pins of the LIN physical layer.
14.4.1 SLCTX — SLIC Transmit Pin
The SLCTX pin serves as the serial output of the SLIC module.
14.4.2 SLCRX — SLIC Receive Pin
The SLCRX pin serves as the serial input of the SLIC module. This input feeds
directly into the digital receive filter block which filters out noise glitches from the
incoming data stream.
14.5 Memory Map/Register Definition
Table 14-1 shows the registers for the SLIC module.
Table 14-1. SLIC Module Memory Map
Address
$0040
$0041
$0042
$0043
$0044
$0045
$0046
$0047
$0048
$0049
$004A
$004B
$004C
$004D
$004E
$004F
$0050
Use
Access
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
SLIC control register 1 (SLCC1)
SLIC control register 2 (SLCC2)
SLIC status register (SLCS)
SLIC prescaler register (SLCP)
SLIC bit time register high (SLCBTH)
SLIC bit time register low (SLCBTL)
SLIC state vector register (SLCSV)
SLIC data length code register (SLCDLC)
SLIC identifier register (SLCID)
SLIC data register 7 (SLCD7)
SLIC data register 6 (SLCD6)
SLIC data register 5 (SLCD5)
SLIC data register 4 (SLCD4)
SLIC data register 3 (SLCD3)
SLIC data register 2 (SLCD2)
SLIC data register 1 (SLCD1)
SLIC data register 0 (SLCD0)
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
14.6 SLIC Registers and Control Bits
This subsection provides information about all registers and control bits associated
with the SLIC module.
Data Sheet
146
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
SLIC Registers and Control Bits
14.6.1 SLIC Control Register 1
SLIC control register 1 (SLCC1) contains bits used to control various basic features
of the SLIC module, including features used for initialization and at runtime.
Address: $0040
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
INITREQ
1
4
0
3
2
1
IMSG
0
Bit 0
SLCIE
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
WAKETX TXABRT
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 14-4. SLIC Control Register 1 (SLCC1)
INITREQ —Initialization Request
Requesting initialization mode by setting this bit will place the SLIC module into
its initialized state immediately. If transmission or reception of data is in
progress, the transaction will be terminated immediately upon entry into
initialization mode (signified by INITACK being set to 1). To return to normal
SLIC operation after the SLIC has been initialized (the INITACK is high), the
INITREQ has to be cleared by software.
1 = Request for SLIC to be put into reset state immediately
0 = Normal operation
WAKETX — Transmit Wakeup Symbol
This bit allows the user to transmit a wakeup symbol on the LIN bus. When set,
this sends a wakeup symbol, as defined in the LIN specification a single time,
then resets to 0. This bit will read 1 while the wakeup symbol is being
transmitted on the bus. This bit will be automatically cleared when the wakeup
symbol is complete.
1 = Send wakeup symbol on LIN bus
0 = Normal operation
TXABRT — Transmit Abort Message
1 = Transmitter aborts current transmission at next byte boundary; TXABRT
resets to 0 after the transmission is successfully aborted
0 = Normal operation
IMSG — SLIC Ignore Message Bit
The IMSG bit cannot be cleared by a write of 0, but is cleared automatically by
the SLIC module after the next BREAK/SYNC symbol pair is validated.
1 = SLIC to ignore data field of message, SLIC interrupts are suppressed
until the next message header arrives
0 = Normal operation
SLCIE — SLIC Interrupt Enable
1 = SLIC interrupt sources are enabled
0 = SLIC interrupt sources are disabled
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
147
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.6.2 SLIC Control Register 2
SLIC control register 2 (SLCC2) contains bits used to control various features of
the SLIC module.
Address: $0041
Bit 7
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
SLCWCM
0
2
BTM
0
1
0
Bit 0
SLCE
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 14-5. SLIC Control Register 2 (SLCC2)
SLCWCM — SLIC Wait Clock Mode
This bit can only be written once out of reset state.
1 = SLIC clocks stop when the CPU is placed into wait mode
0 = SLIC clocks continue to run when the CPU is placed into wait mode so
that the SLIC can receive messages and wakeup the CPU.
BTM — UART Byte Transfer Mode
Byte transmit mode bypasses the normal LIN message framing and checksum
monitoring and allows the user to send and receive single bytes in a method
similar to a half-duplex UART. When enabled, this mode reads the bit time
register (SLCBT) value and assumes this is the value corresponding to the
number of SLIC clock counts for one bit time to establish the desired UART bit
rate. The user software must initialize this register prior to sending or receiving
data, based on the input clock selection, prescaler stage choice, and desired bit
rate.
BTM forces the data length in SLCDLC register to one byte (DLC = 0x00) and
disables the checksum circuitry so that CHKMOD has no effect. Refer to 14.18
Byte Transfer Mode Operation for more detailed information about how to use
this mode.
BTM sets up the SLIC module to send and receive one byte at a time, with 8-bit
data, no parity, and 1 STOP bit (8-N-1). This is the most commonly used setup
for UART communications and should work for most applications. This is fixed
in the SLIC and is not configurable.
1 = UART byte transfer mode enabled
0 = UART byte transfer mode disabled
SLCE — SLIC Module Enable
1 = SLIC module enabled
0 = SLIC module disabled
NOTE:
In order to guarantee timing, the user must ensure that clock source used allows
the proper communications timing tolerances and therefore internal oscillator
circuits might not be appropriate for use with BTM mode.
Data Sheet
148
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
SLIC Registers and Control Bits
14.6.3 SLIC Status Register
SLIC status register (SLCS) contains bits used to monitor the status of the SLIC
module.
Address: $0042
Bit 7
Read: SLCACT
Write:
6
0
5
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
SLCF
0
INITACK
Reset:
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 14-6. SLIC Status Register (SLCS)
SLCACT — SLIC Active (Oscillator Trim Blocking Semaphore)
SLCACT is used to indicate if it is safe to trim the oscillator based upon current
SLIC activity. This bit indicates that the SLIC module might be currently
receiving a message header, synchronization byte, ID byte, or sending or
receiving data bytes. This bit is read-only.
1 = SLIC module activity (not safe to trim oscillator)
SLCACT is automatically set to 1 if a falling edge is seen on the SLCRX
pin and has successfully been passed through the digital RX filter. This
edge is the potential beginning of a LIN message frame.
0 = SLIC module not active (safe to trim oscillator)
The SLCACT bit is cleared by the SLIC module only upon assertion of
the RX Message Buffer Full Checksum OK (SLCSV = $10) or the TX
Message Buffer Empty Checksum Transmitted (SLCSV = $08) interrupt
sources.
INITACK — Initialization Mode Acknowledge
INITACK indicates whether the SLIC module is in the reset mode as a result of
writing INITREQ in SLCC1. While in the reset state the SLIC module clocks are
stopped. Clearing the INITREQ allows the SLIC to proceed and enter SLIC run
mode (if SLCE is set). The module will clear INITACK once the module has left
reset mode and the SLIC will seek the next LIN header. This bit is read-only.
1 = SLIC module is in reset state
0 = Normal operation
SLCF — SLIC Interrupt Flag
The SLCF interrupt flag indicates if a SLIC module interrupt is pending. If set,
the SLCSV is then used to determine what interrupt is pending. This flag is
cleared by writing a 1 to the bit. If additional interrupt sources are pending, the
bit will be automatically set to 1 again by the SLIC.
1 = SLIC interrupt pending
0 = No SLIC interrupt pending
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
149
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.6.4 SLIC Prescaler Register
SLIC prescaler register (SLCP) is used to divide the CPU bus clock for the digital
receive filter circuit. The SLIC clock is divided through a prescaler (controlled by
RXFP[1:0]) to drive the digital receive circuit. Variations on the input clock will
propagate through these prescale stages, so if internal oscillators are used, worst
case oscillator frequencies must be accounted for when determining prescaler
settings to ensure that the frequency of the SLIC clock always remains between
2 MHz and 8 MHz.
Address: $0043
Bit 7
RXFP1
1
6
RXFP0
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 14-7. SLIC Prescale Register (SLCP)
Table 14-2. Digital Receive Filter Clock Prescaler
Maximum Filter Delay (in µs)
Digital RX Filter
Clock Prescaler
(Divide by)
RXFP[1:0]
SLIC Clock (in MHz)
2
3.2
5
4
4
6
6.4
2.5
5
8
2
4
6
8
$00
$01
$10
$11
1
8
2.67
5.33
8
2
3 (default)
4
16
24
32
10
15
20
8
12
16
7.5
10
10.67
RXFP[1:0] — Receive Filter Prescaler
These bits set the prescale value for the clock for the digital receive filter circuit.
This is a further prescaling of the SLIC input clock, which must be kept between
2 MHz and 8 MHz for proper SLIC operation in LIN. The RXFP bits control the
speed of the clock feeding the digital receive filter circuit, which determines the
total maximum filter delay. Any pulse which is smaller than the maximum filter
delay value will be rejected by the filter and ignored as noise. For this reason,
the user must choose the prescaler value appropriately to ensure that all valid
message traffic is able to pass the filter for the desired bit rate. For more details
about setting up the digital receive filter, please refer to 14.20 Digital Receive
Filter.
Data Sheet
150
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
SLIC Registers and Control Bits
The frequency of the SLIC clock must be between 2 MHz and 8 MHz, factoring in
worst case possible numbers due to untrimmed process variations, as well as
temperature and voltage variations in oscillator frequency. This will guarantee
greater than 1.5% accuracy for all LIN messages from 1–20 kbps. The faster this
input clock is, the greater the resulting accuracy and the higher the possible bit
rates at which the SLIC can send and receive. In LIN systems, the bit rates will not
exceed 20 kbps; however, the SLIC module is capable of much higher speeds
without any configuration changes, for cases such as high-speed downloads for
reprogramming of FLASH memory or diagnostics in a test environment where
radiated emissions requirements are not as stringent. In these situations, the user
may choose to run faster than the 20 kbps limit which is imposed by the LIN
specification for EMC reasons. Details of how to calculate maximum bit rates and
operate the SLIC above 20 kbps are detailed in 14.17 High-Speed LIN Operation.
Refer to 14.9 SLIC Module Initialization Procedure for more information on when
to set up this register.
14.6.5 SLIC Bit Time Registers
NOTE:
In this subsection, the SLIC bit time registers are collectively referred to as SLCBT.
In LIN operating mode (BTM = 0), the SLCBT is updated by the SLIC upon
reception of a LIN break-synch combination and provides the number of SLIC
clock counts that equal one LIN bit time to the user software. This value can be
used by the software to calculate the clock drift in the oscillator as an offset to a
known count value (based on nominal oscillator frequency and LIN bus speed).
The user software can then trim the oscillator to compensate for clock drift. Refer
to 14.19 Oscillator Trimming with SLIC for more information on this procedure.
The user cannot read the bit time value from SLCBTH and SLCBTL any time after
the identifier byte is received until the beginning of the next LIN message frame on
the bus. The beginning of this message frame activity will be indicated by the
SLCACT bit.
When in byte transfer mode (BTM = 1), the SLCBT must be written by the user to
set the length of one bit at the desired bit rate in SLIC clock counts. The user
software must initialize this number prior to sending or receiving data, based on the
input clock selection, prescaler stage choice, and desired bit rate. This setting is
similar to choosing an input capture or output compare value for a timer. The
closest even value should be chosen for this value, as BT0 will be forced to 0 by
the SLIC module and any odd value will always be reduced to the next lowest even
integer value. For example, a write of value 51 (0x33) will be forced to value of 50
and read back as 0x32. A write to both registers is required to update the bit time
value.
NOTE:
The SLIC bit time will not be updated until a write of the SLCBTL has occurred.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
151
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Address: $0044
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
0
4
BT12
0
3
BT11
0
2
BT10
0
1
BT9
0
Bit 0
BT8
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 14-8. SLIC Bit Time Register High (SLCBTH)
Address: $0045
Bit 7
6
BT6
0
5
BT5
0
4
BT4
0
3
BT3
0
2
BT2
0
1
BT1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
BT7
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 14-9. SLIC Bit Time Register Low (SLCBTL)
BT — Bit Time Value
BT displays the number of SLIC clocks that equals one bit time in LIN mode
(BTM = 0). For details of the use of the SLCBT registers in LIN mode for
trimming of the internal oscillator, refer to 14.19 Oscillator Trimming with
SLIC.
BT sets the number of SLIC clocks that equals one bit time in byte transfer mode
(BTM = 1). For details of the use of the SLCBT registers in BTM mode, refer to
14.18 Byte Transfer Mode Operation.
14.6.6 SLIC State Vector Register
SLIC state vector register (SLCSV) is provided to substantially decrease the CPU
overhead associated with servicing interrupts while under operation of a LIN
protocol. It provides an index offset that is directly related to the LIN module’s
current state, which can be used with a user supplied jump table to rapidly enter an
interrupt service routine. This eliminates the need for the user to maintain a
duplicate state machine in software.
Address:
$0046
Bit 7
0
6
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
I3
I2
I1
I0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 14-10. SLIC State Vector Register (SLCSV)
READ: any time
WRITE: ignored
I[3:0] — Interrupt State Vector (Bits 5–2)
These bits indicate the source of the interrupt request that is currently pending.
Data Sheet
152
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
SLIC Registers and Control Bits
14.6.6.1 LIN Mode Operation
Table 14-3 shows the possible values for the possible sources for a SLIC interrupt
while in LIN mode operation (BTM = 0).
Table 14-3. Interrupt Sources Summary (BTM = 0)
SLCSV
$00
I3
0
I2
0
I1
0
I0
0
Interrupt Source
No Interrupts Pending
No-Bus-Activity
Priority
0 (Lowest)
1
$04
0
0
0
1
TX Message Buffer Empty
Checksum Transmitted
$08
$0C
$10
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
2
3
4
TX Message Buffer Empty
RX Message Buffer Full
Checksum OK
RX Data Buffer Full
No Errors
$14
0
1
0
1
5
$18
$1C
$20
$24
$28
$2C
$30
$34
$38
$3C
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Bit-Error
Receiver Buffer Overrun
(RESERVED)
6
7
8
Checksum Error
9
Byte Framing Error
Identifier Received Successfully
Identifier Parity Error
Inconsistent-Synch-Field-Error
Reserved
10
11
12
13
14
Wakeup
15 (Highest)
•
No Interrupts Pending
This value indicates that all pending interrupt sources have been serviced.
In polling mode, the SLCSV is read and interrupts serviced until this value
reads back 0. This source will not generate an interrupt of the CPU,
regardless of state of the SLCIE bit.
•
•
No Bus Activity (LIN specified error)
The No-Bus-Activity condition occurs if no valid SYNCH BREAK FIELD or
BYTE FIELD was received for more than tTIMEOUT (as defined in LIN
Protocol Specification) since the reception of the last valid message.
TX Message Buffer Empty — Checksum Transmitted
When the entire LIN message frame has been transmitted successfully,
complete with the appropriately selected checksum byte, this interrupt
source is asserted. This source is used for all standard LIN message frames
and the final set of bytes with extended LIN message frames.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
153
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
•
•
TX Message Buffer Empty
This interrupt source indicates that all 8 bytes in the LIN message buffer
have been transmitted with no checksum appended. This source is used for
intermediate sets of 8 bytes in extended LIN message frames.
RX Message Buffer Full — Checksum OK
When the entire LIN message frame has been received successfully,
complete with the appropriately selected checksum byte, and the checksum
calculates correctly, this interrupt source is asserted. This source is used for
all standard LIN message frames and the final set of bytes with extended
LIN message frames. In order to clear this source, the SLCD0 register must
be read.
•
•
RX Data Buffer Full — No Errors
This interrupt source indicates that 8 bytes have been received with no
checksum byte and are waiting in the LIN message buffer. This source is
used for intermediate sets of 8 bytes in extended LIN message frames. In
order to clear this source, the SLCD0 register must be read.
Bit Error
A unit that is sending a bit on the bus also monitors the bus. A BIT_ERROR
has to be detected at that bit time, when the bit value that is monitored is
different from the bit value that is sent. The SLIC will terminate the data
transmission at the next byte boundary, according to the LIN specification.
Bit errors are not checked when the LIN bus is running at high speed due to
the effects of physical layer round trip delay. Bit errors are fully checked at
all LIN 2.0 compliant speeds of 20 kbps and below.
•
Receiver Buffer Overrun Error
This error is an indication that the receive buffer has not been emptied and
additional bytes have been received, resulting in lost data.
•
•
Reserved
This source is reserved for future use.
Checksum Error (LIN specified error)
The checksum error occurs when the calculated checksum value does not
match the expected value. If this error is encountered, it is important to verify
that the correct checksum calculation method was employed for this
message frame. Refer to the LIN specification for more details on the
calculations.
•
•
Byte Framing Error
This error comes from the standard UART definition for byte encoding and
occurs when the STOP bit is sampled and reads back as a 0. The STOP bit
should always read as 1.
Identifier Received Successfully
This interrupt source indicates that a LIN identifier byte has been received
with correct parity and is waiting in the LIN identifier buffer (SLCID). Upon
Data Sheet
154
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
SLIC Registers and Control Bits
reading this interrupt source from the SLCSV register, the user can then
decode the identifier in software to determine the nature of the LIN message
frame. In order to clear this source, the SLCID register must be read.
•
•
Identifier-Parity-Error
A parity error in the identifier (i.e., corrupted identifier) will be flagged.
Typical LIN slave applications do not distinguish between an unknown but
valid identifier, and a corrupted identifier. However, it is mandatory for all
slave nodes to evaluate in case of a known identifier all 8 bits of the ID-Field
and distinguish between a known and a corrupted identifier. The received
identifier value is reported in the SLCID register so that the user software
can choose to acknowledge or ignore the parity error message.
Inconsistent-Synch-Field-Error
An Inconsistent-Synch-Field-Error has to be detected if a slave detects the
edges of the SYNCH FIELD outside the given tolerance.
•
•
Reserved
This source is reserved for future use.
Wakeup
The wakeup interrupt source indicates that the SLIC module has entered
SLIC run mode from SLIC wait or SLIC stop mode.
14.6.6.2 Byte Transfer Mode Operation
When byte transfer mode is enabled (BTM = 1), many of the interrupt sources for
the SLCSV no longer apply, as they are specific to LIN operations. Table 14-4
shows those interrupt sources which are applicable to BTM operations. The value
of the SLCSV for each interrupt source remains the same, as well as the priority of
the interrupt source.
I
Table 14-4. Interrupt Sources Summary (BTM = 1)
SLCSV
$00
I3
0
I2
0
I1
0
I0
0
Interrupt Source
No Interrupts Pending
TX Message Buffer Empty
Priority
0 (Lowest)
3
$0C
0
0
1
1
RX Data Buffer Full
No Errors
$14
0
1
0
1
5
$18
$1C
$28
$38
$3C
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
Bit-Error
Receiver Buffer Overrun
Byte Framing Error
Reserved
6
7
10
14
Wakeup
15 (Highest)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
155
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
•
No Interrupts Pending
This value indicates that all pending interrupt sources have been serviced.
In polling mode, the SLCSV is read and interrupts serviced until this value
reads back 0. This source will not generate an interrupt of the CPU,
regardless of state of the SLCIE bit.
•
•
TX Message Buffer Empty
In byte transfer mode, this interrupt source indicates that the byte in the
SLCID has been transmitted.
RX Data Buffer Full — No Errors
This interrupt source indicates that a byte has been received and is waiting
in the SLCID register. In order to clear this source, the SLCID register must
be read.
•
Bit-Error
A unit that is sending a bit on the bus also monitors the bus. A BIT_ERROR
has to be detected at that bit time, when the bit value that is monitored is
different from the bit value that is sent.
•
•
Receiver Buffer Overrun Error
This error is an indication that the receive buffer has not been emptied and
additional byte(s) have been received, resulting in lost data.
Byte Framing Error
This error comes from the standard UART definition for byte encoding and
occurs when the STOP bit is sampled and reads back as a 0. The STOP bit
should always read as 1.
•
•
Reserved
This source is reserved for future use.
Wakeup
The wakeup interrupt source indicates that the SLIC module has entered
SLIC run mode from SLIC wait or SLIC stop mode.
14.6.7 SLIC Data Length Code Register
The SLIC data length code register (SLCDLC) is the primary functional control
register for the SLIC module during normal LIN operations. It contains the data
length code of the message buffer, indicating how many bytes of data are to be
sent or received, as well as the checksum mode control and transmit enabling bit.
Data Sheet
156
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
SLIC Registers and Control Bits
Address:
$0047
Bit 7
6
CHKMOD
0
5
DLC5
0
4
DLC4
0
3
DLC3
0
2
DLC2
0
1
DLC1
0
Bit 0
DLC0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
TXGO
0
Figure 14-11. SLIC Data Length Code Register (SLCDLC)
TXGO — SLIC Transmit Go
This bit controls whether the SLIC module is sending or receiving data bytes.
This bit is automatically reset to 0 once a transmit operation is complete or an
error is encountered and transmission has been aborted.
1 = Initiate SLIC transmit
The SLIC assumes the user has loaded the proper data into the message
buffer and will begin transmitting the number of bytes indicated in the
SLCDLC bits. If the number of bytes is greater than 8, the first 8 bytes will
be transmitted and an interrupt will be triggered (if unmasked) for the user
to enter the next bytes of the message. If the number of bytes is 8 or
fewer, the SLIC will transmit the appropriate number of bytes and
automatically append the checksum to the transmission.
0 = SLIC receive data
CHKMOD — LIN Checksum Mode
CHKMOD is used to decide what checksum method to use for this message
frame. Resets after error code or message frame complete.
1 = Checksum calculated without the identifier byte (LIN spec <= 1.3)
0 = Checksum calculated with the identifier byte included
(SAE J2602/LIN 2.0)
DLC — Data Length Control Bits
The value of the bits indicate the number of data bytes in message. Values
$00–$07 are for ’normal’ LIN messaging. Values $08–$3F are for "extended"
LIN messaging.
Table 14-5. Data Length Control
Message Data Length
DLC[5:0]
(Number of Bytes)
$00
$01
$02
...
1
2
3
...
62
63
64
$3D
$3E
$3F
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
157
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.6.8 SLIC Identifier and Data Registers
The SLIC identifier (SLCID) and data registers (SLCD[7:0]) comprise the transmit
and receive buffer and are used to read/write the identifier and message buffer
8 data bytes. In BTM mode (BTM = 0), only the SLCID register is used to send and
receive bytes, as only one byte is handled at any one time. The number of bytes to
be read from or written to these registers is determined by the user software and
written to the SLCDLC register. In order to obtain proper data, reads and writes to
these registers must be made based on the proper length corresponding to a
particular message. It is the responsibility of the user software to keep track of this
value in order to prevent data corruption. For example, it is possible to read data
from locations in the message buffer which contain erroneous or old data if the user
software reads more data registers than were updated by the incoming message,
as indicated in the SLCDLC.
NOTE:
An incorrect length value written to the SLCDLC register can result in the user
software misreading or miswriting data in the message buffer. An incorrect length
value might also result in SLIC error messages. For example, if a 4-byte message
is to be received, but the user software incorrectly reports a 3-byte length to the
DLC, the SLIC will assume the 4th data byte is actually a checksum value and
attempt to validate it as such. If this value doesn’t match the calculated value, an
incorrect checksum error will occur. If it does happen to match the expected value,
then the message would be received as a 3-byte message with valid checksum.
Either case is incorrect behavior for the application and can be avoided by ensuring
that the correct length code is used for each identifier.
The first data byte received after the LIN identifier in a LIN message frame will be
loaded into SLCD0. The next byte (if applicable) will be loaded into SLCD1, and so
forth.
.
Address:
$0048
Bit 7
R7
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
T7
0
Figure 14-12. SLIC Identifier Register (SLCID)
The SLIC identifier register is used to capture the incoming LIN identifier and when
the SLCSV value indicates that the identifier has been received successfully, this
register contains the received identifier value. If the incoming identifier contained a
parity error, this register value will not contain valid data.
In byte transfer mode (BTM = 1), this register is used for sending and receiving
each byte of data.
Data Sheet
158
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
SLIC Registers and Control Bits
Address:
$0049
Bit 7
R7
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
T7
0
Figure 14-13. SLIC Data Register 7 (SLCD7)
Address:
$004A
Bit 7
R7
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
T7
0
Figure 14-14. SLIC Data Register 6 (SLCD6)
Address:
$004B
Bit 7
R7
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
T7
0
Figure 14-15. SLIC Data Register 5 (SLCD5)
Address:
$004C
Bit 7
R7
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
T7
0
Figure 14-16. SLIC Data Register 4 (SLCD4)
Address:
$004D
Bit 7
R7
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
T7
0
Figure 14-17. SLIC Data Register 3 (SLCD3)
Address:
$004E
Bit 7
R7
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
T7
0
Figure 14-18. SLIC Data Register 2 (SLCD2)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
159
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Address:
$004F
Bit 7
R7
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
T7
0
Figure 14-19. SLIC Data Register 1 (SLCD1)
Address:
$0050
Bit 7
R7
6
R6
T6
0
5
R5
T5
0
4
R4
T4
0
3
R3
T3
0
2
R2
T2
0
1
R1
T1
0
Bit 0
R0
T0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
T7
0
Figure 14-20. SLIC Data Register 0 (SLCD0)
R — Read SLC Receive Data
T — Write SLC Transmit Data
14.7 Initialization/Application Information
The LIN specification defines a standard LIN "MESSAGE FRAME" as the basic
format for transferring data across a LIN network. A standard MESSAGE FRAME
is composed as shown in Figure 14-21 (shown with 8 data bytes).
LIN transmits all data, identifier, and checksum characters as standard UART
characters with 8 data bits, no parity, and 1 stop bit. Therefore, each byte has a
length of 10 bits, including the start and stop bits. The data bits are transmitted least
significant bit (LSB) first.
HEADER
0x55
DATA
SYNCH
BREAK
SYNCH
BYTE
IDENT
FIELD
DATA
FIELD
DATA
FIELD
DATA
FIELD
DATA
FIELD
DATA
FIELD
DATA
FIELD
DATA
FIELD
DATA
FIELD
CHECKSUM
FIELD
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
13 OR MORE BITS (LIN 1.3)
Figure 14-21. Typical LIN MESSAGE FRAME
Data Sheet
160
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Initialization/Application Information
14.7.1 LIN Message Frame Header
The HEADER section of all LIN messages is transmitted by the master node in the
network and contains synchronization data, as well as the identifier to define what
information is to be contained in the message frame. Formally, the header is
comprised of three parts:
1. SYNCH BREAK
2. SYNCH BYTE (0x55)
3. IDENTIFIER FIELD
The first two components are present to allow the LIN slave nodes to recognize the
beginning of the message frame and derive the bit rate of the master module.
The SYNCH BREAK allows the slave to see the beginning of a message frame on
the bus. The SLIC module can receive a standard 10-bit break character for the
SYNCH BREAK, or any break symbol 10 or more bit times in length. This
encompasses the LIN requirement of 13 or more bits of length for the SYNCH
BREAK character.
The SYNCH BYTE is always a 0x55 data byte, providing five falling edges for the
slave to derive the bit rate of the master node.
The identifier byte indicates to the slave what is the nature of the data in the
message frame. This data might be supplied from either the master node or the
slave node, as determined at system design time. The slave node must read this
identifier, check for parity errors, and determine whether it is to send or receive data
in the data field.
More information on the HEADER is contained in 14.10.1 LIN Message Headers.
14.7.2 LIN Data Field
The data field is comprised of standard bytes (8 data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit) of
data, from 0–8 bytes for normal LIN frames and greater than 8 bytes for extended
LIN frames. The SLIC module will either transmit or receive these bytes, depending
upon the user code interpretation of the identifier byte. Data is always transmitted
into the data field least significant byte (LSB) first.
The SLIC module can automatically handle up to 64 bytes in extended LIN
message frames without significantly changing program execution.
14.7.3 LIN Checksum Field
The checksum field is a data integrity measure for LIN message frames, used to
signal errors in data consistency. The LIN 1.3 checksum calculation only covers the
data field, but the SLIC module also supports an enhanced checksum calculation
which also includes the identifier field. For more information on the checksum
calculation, refer to 14.16 LIN Data Integrity Checking Methods.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
161
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.7.4 SLIC Module Constraints
In designing a practical module, certain reasonable constraints must be placed on
the LIN message traffic which are not necessarily explicitly specified in the LIN
specification. The SLIC module presumes that:
•
Timeout for no-bus-activity = 1 second.
14.8 SLCSV Interrupt Handling
Each change of state of the SLIC module is encoded in the SLIC state vector
register (SLCSV). This is an efficient method of handling state changes, indicating
to the user not only the current status of the SLIC module, but each state change
will also generate an interrupt (if SLIC interrupts are enabled). For more detailed
information on the SLCSV, please refer to 14.6.6 SLIC State Vector Register.
In the software diagrams in the following subsections, when an interrupt is shown,
the first step must always be reading the SLCSV register to determine what is the
current status of the SLIC module. Likewise, when the diagrams indicate to "EXIT
ISR", the final step to exiting the interrupt service routine is to clear the SLCF
interrupt flag. This can only be done if the SLCSV has first been read, and in the
case that data has been received (such as an ID byte or command message data)
the SLCD has been read at least one time.
Once the SLCSV register is read, it will switch to the next pending state, so the user
must be sure it is copied only once into a software variable at the beginning of the
interrupt service routine in order to avoid inadvertently clearing a pending interrupt
source. Additional decisions based on this value should be made from the software
variable, rather than from the SLCSV itself.
After exiting the ISR, normal application code may resume. If the diagram indicates
to "RETURN TO IDLE," it indicates that all processing for the current message
frame has been completed. If an error was detected and the corresponding error
code loaded into the SLCSV, any pending data in the data buffer will be flushed out
and the SLIC returned to its idle state, seeking out the next message frame header.
14.9 SLIC Module Initialization Procedure
14.9.1 LIN Mode Initialization
The SLIC module does not require very much initialization, due to it’s
self-synchronizing design. Since no prior knowledge of the bit rate is required in
order to synchronize to the LIN bus, no programming of bit rate is required.
At initialization time, the user must configure:
•
•
SLIC prescale register (SLIC digital receive filter adjustment).
Wait clock mode operation.
Data Sheet
162
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
SLIC Module Initialization Procedure
The SLIC clock is the same as the CPU bus clock. The module is designed to
provide better than 1% bit rate accuracy at the lowest value of the SLIC clock
frequency and the accuracy improves as the SLIC clock frequency is increased.
For this reason, it is advantageous to choose the fastest SLIC clock which is still
within the acceptable operating range of the SLIC. Since the SLIC may be used
with MCUs with internal oscillators, the tolerance of the oscillator must be taken
into account to ensure that the SLIC clock frequency does not exceed the bounds
of the SLIC clock operating range. This is especially important if the user wishes to
use the oscillator untrimmed, where process variations might result in MCU
frequency offsets of ±25%.
The acceptable range of SLIC clock frequencies is 2–8 MHz to guarantee LIN
operations with greater than 1.5% accuracy across the 1–20 kbps range of LIN bit
rates. The user must ensure that the fastest possible SLIC clock frequency never
exceeds 8 MHz or that the slowest possible SLIC clock never falls below 2 MHz
under worst case conditions. This would include, for example, oscillator frequency
variations due to untrimmed oscillator tolerance, temperature variation, or supply
voltage variation.
In order to initialize the SLIC module into LIN operating mode, the user should
perform the following steps prior to needing to receive any LIN message traffic.
These steps assume the MCU has been reset either by a power-on reset (POR) or
any other MCU reset mechanism.
The steps for SLIC Initialization for LIN operation are:
1. Write SLCC1 to clear INITREQ.
2. When INITACK = 0, write SLCC1 & SLCC2 with desired values for:
a. SLCWCM — Wait clock mode (default = leaving SLIC clock running
when in CPU wait).
3. Write SLCP to set up prescalers for:
a. RXFP — Digital receive filter clock prescaler
(default = SLIC divided by 3).
4. Enable the SLIC module by writing SLCC2:
a. SLCE = 1 to place SLIC module into run mode.
b. BTM = 0 to disable byte transfer mode (default).
5. Write SLCC1 to enable SLIC interrupts (if desired).
14.9.2 Byte Transfer Mode Initialization
Bit rate synchronization is handled automatically in LIN mode, using the
synchronization data contained in each LIN message to derive the desired bit rate.
In byte transfer mode (BTM = 1); however, the user must set up the bit rate for
communications using the clock selection, prescaler, and SLCBT register.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
163
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
More information on byte transfer mode is described in 14.18 Byte Transfer Mode
Operation, including the performance parameters on recommended maximum
speeds, bit time resolution, and oscillator tolerance requirements.
Once the desired settings of prescalers and bit time are determined, the SLIC
Initialization for BTM operation is virtually identical to that of LIN operation.
The steps are:
1. Write SLCC1 to clear INITREQ.
2. When INITACK = 0, write SLCC2 with desired values for:
a. SLCWCM — Wait clock mode (default = leaving SLIC clock running
when in CPU wait).
3. Write SLCICP to set up prescalers for:
a. RXFP — Digital receive filter clock prescaler
(default = SLIC divided by 3).
4. Enable the SLIC module by writing SLCC2:
a. SLCE = 1 to place SLIC module into run mode.
b. BTM = 1 to enable byte transfer mode (default = disabled).
5. Write SLCC1 to enable SLIC interrupts (if desired).
14.10 Handling LIN Message Headers
Figure 14-22 shows how the SLIC module deals with incoming LIN message
headers.
14.10.1 LIN Message Headers
All LIN message frame headers are comprised of three components:
•
•
•
The first is the SYNCHRONIZATION BREAK (SYNCH BREAK) symbol,
which is a dominant (low) pulse at least 13 or more bit times long, followed
by a recessive (high) synchronization delimiter of at least one bit time. In
LIN 2.0, this is allowed to be 10 or more bit times in length.
The second part is called the SYNCHRONIZATION FIELD (SYNCH FIELD)
and is a single byte with value 0x55. This value was chosen as it is the only
one which provides a series of five falling (recessive to dominant) transitions
on the bus.
The third section of the message frame header is the IDENTIFIER FIELD
(ID). The identifier is covered more in 14.11 Handling Command Message
Frames and 14.12 Handling Request LIN Message Frames.
Data Sheet
164
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Handling LIN Message Headers
LIN MESSAGE
HEADER RECEIVED
N
VALID BREAK
AND SYNCH
DATA?
INTERRUPT
READ SLCSV
Y
SLIC UPDATES SLCBT
ID ARRIVING IN RX BUFFER
PROCESS ERROR CODE:
INCONSISTENT-SYNCH-FIELD-ERROR
INTERRUPT
READ SLCSV
EXIT ISR
RETURN TO
LIN BUS IDLE
PROCESS ERROR CODE:
IDENTIFIER-PARITY ERROR
FRAMING ERROR
Y
ERROR CODE
?
N
READ ID FROM SLCID
N
ID FOR THIS
NODE
SET IMSG BIT
?
Y
PROCESS VALID ID
Figure 14-22. Handling LIN Message Headers
The SLIC automatically reads the incoming pattern of the SYNCHRONIZATION
BREAK and FIELD and determines the bit rate of the LIN data frame, as well as
checking for errors in form and discerning between a genuine BREAK/FIELD
combination and a similar byte pattern somewhere in the data stream. Once the
header has been verified to be valid and has been processed, the SLIC module
updates the SLIC bit time register (SLICBT) with the value obtained from the
SYNCH FIELD and begins to receive the ID.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
165
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
If there are errors in the SYNCH BREAK/FIELD pattern, then an interrupt is
generated. If unmasked, it will trigger an MCU interrupt request and the resulting
code in the SLIC state vector register (SLCSV) will be an
"Inconsistent-Synch-Field-Error," based on the LIN protocol specification.
Once the ID for the message frame has been received, an interrupt is generated
by the SLIC and will trigger an MCU interrupt request if unmasked. At this point, it
might be possible that the ID was received with errors such as a parity error (based
on the LIN specification) or a byte framing error. If the ID did not have any errors,
it will be copied into the SLCD for the software to read. The SLCSV will indicate the
type error or that the ID was received correctly.
In a LIN system, the meaning and function of all messages, and therefore all
message identifiers, is pre-defined by the system designer. This information can be
collected and stored in a standardized format file, called a Configuration Language
Description (CLD) file. In using the SLIC module, it is the responsibility of the user
software to determine the nature of the incoming message, and therefore how to
further handle that message.
The simplest case is when the SLIC receives a message which the user software
determines is of no interest to the application. In other words, the slave node does
not need to receive or transmit any data for this message frame. This might also
apply to messages with zero data bytes (which is allowed by the LIN specification).
At this point, the user can set the IMSG control bit, and exit the interrupt service
routine by clearing the SLCIF flag. Because there is no data to be sent or received,
the SLIC will not generate another interrupt until the next message frame header
or bus goes idle long enough to trigger a "No-Bus-Activity" error according to the
LIN specification.
NOTE:
IMSG will prevent another interrupt from occurring for the current message frame;
however, if data bytes are appearing on the bus they may be received and copied
into the message buffer. This will delete any previous data which might have been
present in the buffer, even though no interrupt is triggered to indicate the arrival of
this data.
At the time the ID is read, the user might also choose to read the SLCBT register
and copy this value out to an application variable. This data can then be used at a
time appropriate to both the application software and the LIN communications to
adjust the trim of the internal oscillator. This operation must be handled very
carefully to avoid adjusting the base timing of the MCU at the wrong time, adversely
affecting the operation of the SLIC module or of the application itself. More
information about this is contained in 14.19 Oscillator Trimming with SLIC.
If the user software determines that the ID read out of the SLCD corresponds to a
command or request message for which this node needs to receive or transmit
data (respectively), it will then move on to procedures described in 14.11 Handling
Command Message Frames and 14.12 Handling Request LIN Message
Frames.
Data Sheet
166
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Handling Command Message Frames
For clarification, in this document, "command" messages will refer to any message
frame where the SLIC module is receiving data bytes and "request" messages
refer to message frames where the SLIC module will be expected to transmit data
bytes. This is a generic description and should not be confused with the
terminology in the LIN specification. The LIN use of the terms "command" and
"request" have the same basic meaning, but are limited in scope to specific
identifier values of 0x3C and 0x3D. In the SLIC module documentation, these
terms have been used to describe these functional types of messages, regardless
of the specific identifier value used.
14.10.2 Possible Errors on Message Headers
Possible errors on message headers are:
•
•
•
Inconsistent-Synch-Field-Error
Identifier-Parity-Error
Framing Error
14.11 Handling Command Message Frames
Figure 14-23 shows how to handle command message frames, where the SLIC
module is receiving data from the master node.
Command message frames refer to LIN messages frames where the master node
is ’commanding’ the slave node to do something. The implication is that the slave
will then be receiving data from the master for this message frame. This can be a
standard LIN message frame of 1–8 data bytes, a reserved LIN system message
(using 0x3C identifier), or an extended command message frame utilizing the
reserved 0x3E user defined identifier or perhaps the 0x3F LIN reserved extended
identifier. The SLIC module is capable of handling message frames containing up
to 64 bytes of data, while still automatically calculating and/or verifying the
checksum.
14.11.1 Standard Command Message Frames
Once the application software has read the incoming identifier and determined that
it is a valid identifier which cannot be ignored using the IMSG bit, it must determine
if this message frame is a command message frame or a request message frame.
(i.e., should the application receive data from the master or send data back to the
master?)
The first case, shown in Figure 14-23 deals with command messages, where the
SLIC will be receiving data from the master node. If the received identifier
corresponds to a standard LIN command frame (i.e., 1–8 data bytes), the user
must then write the number of bytes (determined by the system designer and
directly linked with this particular identifier) corresponding to the length of the
message frame into the SLCDLC register. The two most significant bits of this
register are used for special control bits describing the nature of this message
frame.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
167
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
PROCESS
VALID ID
N
PROCESS
REQUEST MESSAGE
COMMAND MESSAGE
?
Y
INITIALIZE SW BYTE COUNT
WRITE SLCDLC FOR THIS ID
0nxx xxxx
Y
EXTENDED FRAME
(TXGO = 0)
?
(CHKMOD = n)
N
WRITE SLCDLC FOR THIS ID
0n00 0xxx
EXIT ISR
(TXGO = 0)
(CHKMOD = n)
INTERRUPT
READ SLCSV
EXIT ISR
PROCESS ERROR CODE:
FRAMING ERROR
NO-BUS-ACTIVITY
Y
ERROR CODE
?
RECEIVE BUFFER OVERRUN
INTERRUPT
READ SLCSV
N
PROCESS ERROR CODE:
FRAMING ERROR
CHECKSUM-ERROR
EXIT ISR
RETURN TO IDLE
1. EMPTY RX BUFFER
NO-BUS-ACTIVITY
Y
2. DECREMENT SW BYTE COUNT BY 8
ERROR CODE
?
RECEIVE BUFFER OVERRUN
N
LAST FRAME
N
EXIT ISR
RETURN TO IDLE
(SW BYTE COUNT ≤8)
EMPTY RX BUFFER
?
Y
Figure 14-23. Handling Command Messages (Data Receive)
Data Sheet
168
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Handling Command Message Frames
The SLIC transmit go (TXGO) bit should be 0 for command frames, indicating to
the SLIC that data is coming from the master. The checksum mode control
(CHKMOD) bit allows the user to select which method of checksum calculation is
desired for this message frame. The LIN 1.3 checksum does not include the
identifier byte in the calculation, while the SAE version does include this byte. Since
the identifier is already received by the SLIC by this time, the default is to include
it in the calculation. If a LIN 1.3 checksum is desired, a 1 in the CHKMOD bit will
reset the checksum circuitry to begin calculating the checksum on the first data
byte. Using the CHKMOD bit in this way allows the SLIC to receive messages with
either method of data consistency check and change on a frame-by-frame basis. If
a system uses both types of data consistency checking methods, the software
must simply change the setting of this bit based on the identifier of each message.
If the network only uses one type of check, the CHKMOD bit can be set as a
constant value in the user’s code. If CHKMOD is not written on each frame, care
must be taken not to accidentally modify the bit when writing the data length and
TXGO bits. This is especially true if using C code without carefully inspecting the
output of the compiler and assembler.
The control bits and data length code are contained in one register, allowing the
user to maximize the efficiency of the identifier processing by writing a single byte
value to indicate the nature of the message frame. This allows very efficient
identifier processing code, which is important in a command frame, as the master
node can be sending data immediately following the identifier byte which might be
as little as one byte in length. The SLIC module uses a separate internal storage
area for the incoming data bytes, so there is no danger of losing incoming data, but
the user should spend as little time as possible within the ISR to ensure that the
application or other ISRs are able to use the majority of the CPU bandwidth.
The identifier must be processed in a maximum of 2 byte times on the LIN bus to
ensure that the ISR completes before the checksum would be received for the
shortest possible message. This should be easily achievable, as the only
operations required are to read the SLCID register and look up the checksum
method, data length, and command/request state of that identifier, then write that
value to the SLCDLC. This can be easily streamlined in code with a lookup table of
identifiers and corresponding SLCDLC bytes.
14.11.2 Extended Command Message Frames
Handling of extended frames is very similar to handling of standard frames,
providing that the length is less than or equal to 64 bytes. Since the SLIC module
can only receive 8 bytes at a time, the receive buffer must be emptied periodically
for long message frames. This is not standard LIN operation, and is likely only to
be used for downloading calibration data or reprogramming FLASH devices in a
factory or service facility, so the added steps required for processing are not as
critical to performance. During these types of operations, the application code is
likely very limited in scope and special adjustments can be made to compensate
for added message processing time.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
169
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
For extended command frames, the data length is still written one time at the time
the identifier is decoded, along with the TXGO and CHKMOD bits. When this is
done, a software counter must also be initialized to keep track of how many bytes
are expected to be received in the message frame. The ISR completes, clearing
the SLCF flag, and resumes application execution. The SLIC will generate an
interrupt, if unmasked, after 8 bytes are received or an error is detected. At this
interrupt, the SLCSV will indicate an error condition (in case of framing error, idle
bus) or that the receive buffer is full. If the data is successfully received, the user
must then empty the buffer by reading SLCD7-SLCD0 and then subtract 8 from the
software byte count. When this software counter reaches 8 or fewer, the remaining
data bytes will fit in the buffer and only one interrupt should occur. At this time, the
final interrupt may be handled normally, continuing to use the software counter to
read the proper number of bytes from the appropriate SLCD registers.
NOTE:
Do not write the SLCDLC register more than one time per LIN message frame. The
SLIC tracks the number of sent or received bytes based on the value written to this
register at the beginning of the data field and rewriting this register will corrupt the
checksum calculation and cause unpredictable behavior in the SLIC module. The
application software must track the number of sent or received bytes to know what
the current byte count in the SLIC is. If programming in C, make sure to use the
VOLATILE modifier on this variable (or make it a global variable) in order to ensure
that it keeps it’s value between interrupts.
14.11.3 Possible Errors on Command Message Data
Possible errors on command message data are:
Framing Error
Checksum-Error (LIN specified error)
•
•
•
•
No-Bus-Activity (LIN specified error)
Receiver Buffer Overrun Error
14.12 Handling Request LIN Message Frames
Figure 14-24 shows how to handle request message frames, where the SLIC
module is sending data to the master node.
Request message frames refer to LIN messages frames where the master node is
’requesting’ the slave node to supply information. The implication is that the slave
will then be transmitting data to the master for this message frame. This can be a
standard LIN message frame of 1–8 data bytes, a reserved LIN system message
(using 0x3D identifier), or an extended request message frame utilizing the
reserved 0x3E identifier or perhaps the 0x3F LIN reserved extended identifier. The
SLIC module is capable of handling request message frames containing up to 64
bytes of data, while still automatically calculating and/or verifying the checksum.
Data Sheet
170
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Handling Request LIN Message Frames
PROCESS
REQUEST MESSAGE
Y
EXTENDED FRAME
?
1. INITIALIZE SW BYTE COUNT
2. LOAD FIRST 8 DATA BYTES
3. WRITE SLCDLC FOR THIS ID
1nxx xxxx
N
(TXGO = 1)
(CHKMOD = n)
1. LOAD DATA INTO MESSAGE BUFFER
2. WRITE SLCDLC FOR THIS ID
1n00 0xxx
(TXGO = 1)
(CHKMOD = n)
EXIT ISR
EXIT ISR
INTERRUPT
READ SLCSV
INTERRUPT
READ SLCSV
PROCESS ERROR CODE:
FRAMING ERROR
BIT-ERROR
Y
ERROR CODE
PROCESS ERROR CODE:
FRAMING ERROR
BIT-ERROR
?
Y
ERROR CODE
N
CHECKSUM-ERROR
?
EXIT ISR
RETURN TO IDLE
DECREMENT SW BYTE COUNT BY 8
N
EXIT ISR
RETURN TO IDLE
TRANSMIT COMPLETE
N
LAST FRAME
(SW BYTE COUNT ≤8)
?
Y
1. LOAD NEXT 8 BYTES TO TRANSMIT
2. WRITE TXGO BIT TO START TRANSMIT(1)
1. LOAD LAST (≤8) BYTES TO TRANSMIT
2. WRITE TXGO BIT TO START TRANSMIT(1)
Note 1. When writing TXGO bit only, ensure that CHKMOD and data length values are not accidentally modified.
Figure 14-24. Handling Request LIN Message Frames
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Data Sheet
171
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.12.1 Standard Request Message Frames
Dealing with request messages with the SLIC is very similar to dealing with
command messages, with one important difference. Since the SLIC is now to be
transmitting data in the LIN message frame, the user software must load the data
to be transmitted into the message buffer prior to initiating the transmission. This
means an extra step is taken inside the interrupt service routine once the identifier
has been decoded and is determined to be an ID for a request message frame.
Figure 14-24 deals with request messages, where the SLIC will be transmitting
data to the master node. If the received identifier corresponds to a standard LIN
command frame (i.e., 1-8 data bytes), the message processing is very simple. The
user must load the data to be transmitted into the transmit buffer by writing it to the
SLCD registers. The first byte to be transmitted on the LIN bus should be loaded
into SLCD0, then SLCD1 for the second byte, etc. Once all of the bytes to be
transmitted are loaded in this way, a single write to the SLCDLC register will allow
the user to encode the number of data bytes to be transmitted (1–8 bytes for
standard request frames), set the proper checksum calculation method for the data
(CHKMOD), as well as signal the SLIC that the buffer is ready by writing a 1 to the
TXGO bit. The TXGO bit will remain set to 1 until the buffer is sent successfully or
an error is encountered, signaling to the application code that the buffer is in
process of transmitting. In cases of 1–8 data bytes only being sent (standard LIN
request frames), the SLIC automatically calculates and transmits the checksum
byte at the end of the message frame. The user can exit the ISR once the SLCDLC
register has been written and the SLCF flag has been cleared.
The next SLIC interrupt which occurs, if unmasked, will indicate the end of the
request message frame and will either indicate that the frame was properly
transmitted or that an error was encountered during transmission. Refer to 14.12.4
Possible Errors on Request Message Data for more detailed explanation of
these possible errors. This interrupt also signals to the application that the
message frame is complete and all data bytes and the checksum value have been
properly transmitted onto the bus.
The SLIC module cannot begin to transmit the data until the user writes a 1 to the
TXGO bit, indicating that data is ready. If the user writes the TXGO bit without
loading data into the transmit buffer, whatever data is in storage will be transmitted,
where the number of bytes transmitted is based on the data length value in the data
length register. Similarly, if the user writes the wrong value for the number of data
bytes to transmit, the SLIC will transmit that number of bytes, potentially
transmitting garbage data onto the bus. The checksum calculation is performed
based on the data transmitted, and will therefore still be calculated.
The identifier must be processed, data must be loaded into the transmit buffer, and
the SLCDLC value written to initiate data transmission in a certain amount of time,
based on the LIN specification. If the user waits too long to start transmission, the
master node will observe an idle bus and trigger a Slave Not Responding error
condition. The same error can be triggered if the transmission begins too late and
Data Sheet
172
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Handling Request LIN Message Frames
does not complete before the message frame times out. Refer to the LIN
specification for more details on timing constraints and requirements for LIN slave
devices. This is especially important when dealing with extended request frames,
when the data must be loaded in 8 byte sections (maximum) to be transmitted at
each interrupt.
14.12.2 Extended Request Message Frames
Handling of extended frames is very similar to handling of standard frames,
providing that the length is less than or equal to 64 bytes. Since the SLIC module
can only transmit 8 bytes at a time, the transmit buffer must be loaded periodically
for extended message frames. This is not standard LIN operation, and is likely only
to be used for special cases, so the added steps required for processing should not
be as critical to performance. During these types of operations, the application
code is likely very limited in scope and special adjustments can be made to
compensate for added message processing time.
For extended request frames, the data length is still written only one time, at the
time the identifier is decoded, along with the TXGO and CHKMOD bits, after the
first 8 data bytes are loaded into the transmit buffer. When this is done, a software
counter must also be initialized to keep track of how many bytes are to be
transmitted in the message frame. The ISR completes, clearing the SLCF flag, and
resumes application execution. The SLIC will generate an interrupt, if unmasked,
after 8 bytes are transmitted or an error is detected. At this interrupt, the SLCSV
will indicate an error condition (in case of framing error or bit error) or that the
transmit buffer is empty. If the data is transmitted successfully, the user must then
subtract 8 from the software byte count, load the next 8 bytes into the SLCD
registers, and write a 1 to the TXGO bit to tell the SLIC that the buffers are loaded
and transmission can commence. When this software counter reaches 8 or fewer,
the remaining data bytes will fit in the transmit buffer and the SLIC will automatically
append the checksum value to the frame after the last byte is sent.
NOTE:
Do not write the CHKMOD or data length values in the SLCDLC register more than
one time per message frame. The SLIC tracks the number of sent or received bytes
based on the value written to this register at the beginning of the data field and
rewriting this register will corrupt the checksum calculation and cause
unpredictable behavior in the SLIC module. The application software must track
the number of sent or received bytes to know what the current byte count in the
SLIC is. If programming in C, make sure to use the VOLATILE modifier on this
variable (or make it a global variable) in order to ensure that it keeps it’s value
between interrupts.
14.12.3 Transmit Abort
The transmit abort bit (TXABRT) in SLCC1 allows the user to cease transmission
of data on the next byte boundary. When this bit is set to 1, it will finish transmitting
the byte currently being transmitted, then cease transmission. Once the
transmission is successfully aborted, the TXABRT bit will automatically be reset by
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
173
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
the SLIC to 0. If the SLIC is not in process of transmitting at the time TXABRT is
written to 1, there is no effect and TXABRT will read back as 0.
14.12.4 Possible Errors on Request Message Data
Possible errors on request message data are:
•
•
•
Framing Error.
Checksum-Error (LIN specified error).
Bit-Error.
14.13 Handling IMSG to Minimize Interrupts
The IMSG feature is designed to minimize the number of interrupts required to
maintain LIN communications. On a network with many slave nodes, it is very likely
that a particular slave will observe messages which are not intended for that node.
When the SLIC module detects any message header, it synchronizes to that
message frame and bit rate, then interrupts the CPU once the identifier byte has
been successfully received and parity checked. At this time, if the software
determines that the message may be ignored, the IMSG bit may be set to indicate
to the module that the data field of the message frame is to be ignored and no
additional interrupts should be generated until the next valid message header is
received. The bit is automatically reset to 0 once the current message frame is
complete and the LIN bus returns to idle state. This reduces the load on the CPU
and allows the application software to immediately begin performing any
operations which might otherwise not be allowed while receiving messaging.
NOTE:
IMSG will prevent another interrupt from occurring for the current message frame,
however if data bytes are appearing on the bus they may be received and copied
into the message buffer. This will delete any previous data which might have been
present in the buffer, even though no interrupt is triggered to indicate the arrival of
this data.
14.14 Sleep and Wakeup Operation
The SLIC module itself has no special sleep mode, but does support low-power
modes and wake-up on network activity. For low-power operations, the user must
select whether or not to allow the SLIC clock to continue operating when the MCU
issues a wait instruction through the SLC wait clock mode (SLCWCM) bit in SLCC1
register. If SLCWCM = 1, the SLIC will enter SLIC STOP mode when the MCU
executes a WAIT instruction. If SLCWCM = 0, the SLIC will enter SLIC WAIT mode
when the MCU executes a WAIT instruction. For more information on these modes,
as well as wakeup options from these modes, please refer to 14.3 Modes of
Operation.
When network activity occurs, the SLIC module will wake the MCU out of stop or
wait mode, and return the SLIC module to SLIC run mode. If the SLIC was in SLIC
wait mode, normal SLIC interrupt processing will resume. If the SLIC was in SLIC
Data Sheet
174
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Polling Operation
stop mode, the SLCSV register will indicate wakeup as the interrupt source so that
the user knows that the SLIC module brought the MCU out of stop or wait.
In a LIN system, a system message is generally sent to all nodes to indicate that
they are to enter low-power network sleep mode. Once a node enters sleep mode,
it waits for outside events, such as switch or sensor inputs or network traffic to bring
it out of network sleep mode. If the node using the SLIC module is awakened by a
source other than network traffic, such as a switch input, the LIN specification
requires this node to issue a wake-up signal to the rest of the network. The SLIC
module supports this feature using the WAKETX bit in the SLCC2 register. The
user software may set this bit and one LIN wake-up signal is immediately
transmitted on the bus, then the bit is automatically cleared by the SLIC module. If
another wake-up signal is required to be sent, the user must set the WAKETX bit
again.
In a LIN system, the LIN physical interface can often also provide an output to the
IRQ pin to provide a wake-up mechanism on network activity. The physical layer
might also control voltage regulation supply to the MCU, cutting power to the MCU
when the physical layer is placed in its low-power mode. The user must take care
to ensure that the interaction between the physical layer, IRQ pin, SLIC transmit
and receive pins, and power supply regulator is fully understood and designed to
ensure proper operation.
14.15 Polling Operation
It is possible to operate the SLIC module in polling mode, if desired. The primary
difference is that the SLIC interrupt request should not be enabled (SLCIE = 0).
The SLCSV will update and operate properly and interrupt requests will be
indicated with the SLCF flag, which can be polled to determine status changes in
the SLIC module. It is required that the polling rate be fast enough to ensure that
SLIC status changes be recognized and processed in time to ensure that all
application timings can be met.
14.16 LIN Data Integrity Checking Methods
The SLIC module supports two different LIN-based data integrity options:
•
The first option supports LIN 1.3 and older methods of checksum
calculations.
•
The second option supports an optional additional enhanced checksum
calculation which has greater data integrity coverage.
The LIN 1.3 and earlier specifications transmit a checksum byte in the
"CHECKSUM FIELD" of the LIN message frame. This CHECKSUM FIELD
contains the inverted modulo-256 sum over all data bytes. The sum is calculated
by an "ADD with Carry" where the carry bit of each addition is added to the least
significant bit (LSB) of it’s resulting sum. This guarantees security also for the
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
175
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MSBs of the data bytes. The sum of modulo-256 sum over all data bytes and the
checksum byte must be’0xFF’.
An optional checksum calculation can also be performed on a LIN data frame
which is very similar to the LIN 1.3 calculation, but with one important distinction.
This enhanced calculation simply includes the identifier field as the first value in the
calculation, whereas the LIN 1.3 calculation begins with the least significant byte of
the data field (which is the first byte to be transmitted on the bus). This enhanced
calculation further ensures that the identifier field is correct and ties the identifier
and data together under a common calculation, ensuring greater reliability.
In the SLIC module, either checksum calculation can be performed on any given
message frame by simply writing or clearing the CHKMOD bit in the SLCDLC
register, as desired, when the identifier for the message frame is decoded. The
appropriate calculation for each message frame should be decided at system
design time and documented in the LIN description file, indicating to the user which
calculation to use for a particular identifier.
14.17 High-Speed LIN Operation
High-speed LIN operation does not necessarily require any reconfiguration of the
SLIC module, depending upon what maximum LIN bit rate is desired. Several
factors affect the performance of the SLIC module at LIN speeds higher than
20 kbps, all of which are functions of the speed of the SLIC clock and the prescaler
of the digital filter. The tightest constraint comes from the need to maintain ±1.5%
accuracy with the master node timing. This requires that the SLIC module be able
to sample the incoming data stream accurately enough to guarantee that accuracy.
Table 14-6 shows the maximum LIN bit rates allowable in order to maintain this
accuracy.
Table 14-6. Maximum LIN Bit Rates for High-Speed Operation
Maximum LIN Bit Rate
for ±1% SLIC Accuracy
(Bits / Second)
Maximum LIN Bit Rate
for ±1.5% SLIC Accuracy
(Bits / Second)
SLIC Clock (MHz)
8
80,000
64,000
48,000
40,000
32,000
24,000
20,000
120,000
96,000
72,000
60,000
48,000
36,000
30,000
6.4
4.8
4
3.2
2.4
2
Data Sheet
176
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
High-Speed LIN Operation
The above numbers assume a perfect input waveforms into the SLCRX pin,
where 1 and 0 bits are of equal length and are exactly the correct length for the
appropriate speed. Factors such as physical layer wave shaping and ground shift
can affect the symmetry of these waveforms, causing bits to appear shortened or
lengthened as seen by the SLIC module. The user must take these factors into
account and base the maximum speed upon the shortest possible bit time that the
SLIC module may observe, factoring in all physical layer effects. On some LIN
physical layer devices it is possible to turn off wave shaping circuitry for high-speed
operation, removing this portion of the physical layer error.
The digital receive filter can also affect high speed operation if it is set too low and
begins to filter out valid message traffic. Under ideal conditions, this will not
happen, as the digital filter maximum speeds allowable are higher than the speeds
allowed for ±1.5% accuracy. If the digital receive filter prescaler is set to divide-
by-4; however, the filter delay is very close to the ±1.5% accuracy maximum bit
time.
For example, with a SLIC clock of 4 MHz, the SLIC module is capable of
maintaining ±1.5% accuracy up to 60,000 bps. If the digital receive filter prescaler
is set to divide-by-4, this means that the filter will only pass message traffic which
is 62,500 bps or slower under ideal circumstances. This is only a difference of
2,500 bps (4.17% of the nominal valid message traffic speed). In this case, the user
must ensure that with all errors accounted for, no bit will appear shorter than 16 µs
(1 bit at 62,500 bps) or the filter will block that bit. This is far too narrow a margin
for safe design practices. The better solution would be to reduce the filter prescaler,
increasing the gap between the filter cut-off point and the nominal speed of valid
message traffic. Changing the prescaler to divide by 2 in this example gives a filter
cut-off of 125,000 bps, which is 60,000 bps faster than the nominal speed of the
LIN bus and much less likely to interfere with valid message traffic.
To ensure that all valid messages pass the filter stage in high-speed operation, it
is best to ensure that the filter cut-off point is at least 2 times the nominal speed of
the fastest message traffic to appear on the bus. Refer to Table 14-6 for a more
complete list of the digital receive filter delays as they relate to the maximum LIN
bus frequency. Table 14-7 repeats much of the data found in Table 14-6; however,
the filter delay values have been converted to the frequency domain.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
177
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Table 14-7. Maximum LIN Bit Rates for High-Speed Operation Due to Digital Receive Filter
Maximum LIN
Bit Rate for ±1.5%
SLIC Accuracy
(for Master-Slave
Communication
(Bits / Second)
Maximum LIN
Bit Rate with
Digital RX Filter
Set to ÷4
Maximum LIN
Bit Rate with
Digital RX Filter
Set to ÷3
Maximum LIN
Bit Rate with
Digital RX Filter
Set to ÷2
Maximum LIN
Bit Rate with
Digital RX Filter
Set to ÷1
SLIC
Clock
(MHz)
(Bits / Second)
(Bits / Second)
THESE PRESCALERS
NOT RECOMMENDED FOR
HIGH-SPEED LIN OPERATION
(Bits / Second)
(Bits / Second)
DIGITAL RX FILTER
NOT CONSIDERED
8
120,000
96,000
72,000
60,000
48,000
36,000
30,000
125,000
100,000
75,000
62,500
50,000
37,500
31,250
166,667
133,333
100,000
83,333
66,667
50,000
41,667
250,000
200,000
150,000
125,000
100,000
75,000
500,000
400,000
300,000
250,000
200,000
150,000
125,000
6.4
4.8
4
3.2
2.4
2
62,500
14.18 Byte Transfer Mode Operation
This subsection describes the operation and limitations of the optional UART-like
byte transfer mode (BTM). This mode allows sending and receiving individual
bytes, but changes the behavior of the SLCBT registers (now read/write registers)
and locks the SLCDLC to 1 byte data length. The SLCBT value now becomes the
bit time reference for the SLIC, where the software sets the length of one bit time
rather than the SLIC module itself. This is similar to an input capture/output
compare (IC/OC) count in a timer module, where the count value represents the
number of SLIC clock counts in one bit time.
Byte transfer mode assumes that the user has a very stable, precise oscillator,
resonator, or clock reference input into the MCU and is therefore not appropriate
for use with internal oscillators. There is no synchronization method available to the
user in this mode and the user must tell the SLIC how many clock counts comprise
a bit time. Figure 14-25, Figure 14-26, Figure 14-27, and Figure 14-28 show
calculations to determine the SLCBT value for different settings.
In the example in Figure 14-25, the user should write 0x16, as a write of 0x15
(decimal value of 21) would automatically revert to 0x14, resulting in transmitted bit
times that are 1.33 SLIC clock periods too short rather than 0.667 SLIC clock
periods too long. The optimal choice, which gives the smallest resolution error, is
the closest even number of SLIC clocks to the exact calculated SLCBT value.
There is a trade-off between maximum bit rate and resolution with the SLIC in BTM
mode. Faster SLIC clock speeds improve resolution, but require higher numbers to
be written to the SLCBT registers for a given desired bit rate. It is up to the user to
determine what level of resolution is acceptable for the given application.
Data Sheet
178
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Byte Transfer Mode Operation
Desired Bit Rate:
57,600 bps
External Crystal Frequency: 4.9152 MHz
1 Second
57,600 Bits
17.36111 ms
1 Bit
=
=
1 Second
4 CGMXCLK Period
1 SLIC Clock Period
813.802 ns
X
X
4,915,200 CGMXCLK Periods
1 SLIC Clock Period
17.36111 ms
1 Bit
1 SLIC Clock Period
813.802 ns
21.33 SLIC Clock Periods
1 Bit
=
Therefore, the closest SLCBT value would be 21 SLIC clocks (SLCBT = 0x0015).
Since you can only use even values in SLCBT, the closest acceptable value is 22 (0x0016).
Figure 14-25. SLCBT Value Calculation Example 1
Desired Bit Rate:
57,600 bps
External Crystal Frequency: 9.8304 MHz
1 Second
17.36111 ms
1 Bit
=
=
57,600 Bits
1 Second
4 CGMXCLK Period
1 SLIC Clock Period
406.90 ns
X
X
9,830,400 CGMXCLK Periods
1 SLIC Clock Period
17.36111 ms
1 Bit
1 SLIC Clock Period
406.90 ns
42.67 SLIC Clock Periods
1 Bit
=
Therefore, the closest SLCBT value would be 42 SLIC clocks (SLCBT = 0x002A).
Figure 14-26. SLCBT Value Calculation Example 2
Desired Bit Rate:
15,625 bps
External Crystal Frequency: 8.000 MHz
1 Second
64 ms
1 Bit
=
=
15,625 Bits
1 Second
4 CGMXCLK Period
1 SLIC Clock Period
500 ns
X
X
8,000,000 CGMXCLK Periods
1 SLIC Clock Period
64 ms
1 Bit
1 SLIC Clock Period
500 ns
128 SLIC Clock Periods
1 Bit
=
Therefore, the closest SLCBT value would be 128 SLIC clocks (SLCBT = 0x0080).
Figure 14-27. SLCBT Value Calculation Example 3
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
179
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Desired Bit Rate:
9.615 bps
External Crystal Frequency: 8.000 MHz
1 Second
9,615 Bits
104.004 ms
1 Bit
=
=
1 Second
4 CGMXCLK Period
1 SLIC Clock Period
500 ns
X
X
8,000,000 CGMXCLK Periods
1 SLIC Clock Period
104.004 ms
1 Bit
1 SLIC Clock Period
500 ns
208.008 SLIC Clock Periods
1 Bit
=
Therefore, the closest SLCBT value would be 42 SLIC clocks (SLCBT = 0x00D0).
Figure 14-28. SLCBT Value Calculation Example 4
This resolution affects the sampling accuracy of the SLIC module on receiving
bytes, but only as far as locating the sample point of each bit within a given byte.
The best sample point of the bit may be off by as much as one SLIC clock period
from the exact center of the bit, if the proper SLCBT value for the desired bit rate
is an odd number of SLIC clock periods.
Figure 14-29 shows an example of this error. In this example, the user has
additionally chosen an incorrect value of 30 SLIC clocks for the length of one bit
time, and a filter prescaler of 1. This makes little difference in the receive sampling
of this particular bit, as the sample point is still within the bit and the digital filter will
catch any noise pulses shorter than 16 filter clocks long.The ideal value of SLCBT
would be 35 SLIC clocks, but the closest available value is 34, placing the sample
point at 17 SLIC clocks into the bit.
The error in the bit time value chosen by the user in the above example will grow
throughout the byte, as the sample point for the next bit will be only 30 SLIC clock
cycles later (1 full bit time at this bit rate setting). The SLIC resynchronizes upon
every falling edge received. In a 0x00 data byte, however, there are no falling
edges after the beginning of the start bit. This means that the accumulated error of
the sampling point over the data byte with these settings could be as high as 30
SLIC clock cycles (10 bits x {2 SLIC clocks due to user error + 1 SLIC clock
resolution error}) placing it at the boundary between the last bit and the stop bit.
This could result in missampling and missing a framing error on the last bit on high
speed communications when the SLCBT count is relatively low. A properly chosen
SLCBT value would result in a maximum error of 10 SLIC clock counts over a given
byte. This is less than one filter delay time, and will not cause missampling of any
of the bits in that byte. At the falling edge of the next start bit, the SLIC will
resynchronize and any accumulated sampling error returns to 0. The sampling
error becomes even less significant at lower speeds, when higher values of SLCBT
are used to define a bit time, as the worst case bit time resolution error is still only
one SLIC clock per bit (or maximum of 10 SLIC clocks per byte).
Data Sheet
180
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Byte Transfer Mode Operation
UNFILTERED
RX DATA
FILTERED
RX DATA
(÷1 PRESCALE)
FILTER CLOCK
(÷1 PRESCALE)
16 FILTER CLOCKS
(÷1 PRESCALE)
16 FILTER CLOCKS
(÷1 PRESCALE)
FILTER REACHES 0XF
AND TOGGLES FILTER OUTPUT
FILTER REACHES 0X0
AND TOGGLES FILTER OUTPUT
FILTER BEGINS
COUNTING DOWN
FILTER BEGINS
COUNTING UP
SLIC CLOCK
15 SLIC CLOCKS
(1/2 OF SLCBT VALUE)
35 SLIC CLOCKS
(ACTUAL FILTERED BIT LENGTH)
IDEAL SLIC SAMPLE POINT (17 SLIC CLOCKS)
SLIC SAMPLE POINT
(BASED ON SLCBT VALUE)
This example assumes a SLCBT value of 30 (0x1E).
Transmitted bits will be sent out as 30 SLIC clock cycles long.
The proper closest SLCBT setting would be 34 (0x22),
which gives the ideal sample point of 17 SLIC clocks and
transmitted bits are 34 SLIC clocks long.
Figure 14-29. BTM Mode Receive Byte Sampling Example
The error also comes into effect with transmitted bit times. Using the previous
example with a SLCBT value of 34, transmitted bits will appear as 34 SLIC clock
periods long. This is one SLIC clock short of the proper length. Depending on the
frequency of the SLIC clock, one period of the SLIC clock might be a large or a
small fraction of one ideal bit time. Raising the frequency of the SLIC clock will
reduce this error relative to the ideal bit time, improving the resolution of the SLIC
clock relative to the bit rate of the bus. In any case, the error is still one SLIC clock
cycle. Raising the SLIC clock frequency, however, requires programming a higher
value for SLCBT to maintain the same target bit rate.
Smaller values of SLCBT combined with higher values of the SLIC clock frequency
(smaller clock period) will give faster bit rates, but the SLIC clock period becomes
an increasingly significant portion of one bit time.
Since BTM mode does not perform any synchronization and relies on the accuracy
of the data provided by the user software to set its sample point and generate
transmitted bits, the constraint on maximum speeds is only limited to the limits
imposed by the digital filter delay and the SLIC input clock. Since the digital filter
delay cannot be less than 16 SLIC clock cycles, the fastest possible pulse which
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
181
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
would pass the filter is 16 clock periods at 8 MHz, or 500,000 bits/second. The
values shown in Table 14-8 are the same values shown in Table 14-9 and indicate
the absolute fastest bit rates which could just pass the minimum digital filter
settings (prescaler = divide by 1) under perfect conditions.
Table 14-8. Digital Receive Filter Absolute Cutoff Frequencies
Maximum BTM
Bit Rate with
Digital RX Filter
Set to ÷4
Maximum BTM
Bit Rate with
Digital RX Filter
Set to ÷3
Maximum BTM
Bit Rate with
Digital RX Filter
Set to ÷2
Maximum BTM
Bit Rate with
Digital RX Filter
Set to ÷1
SLIC
Clock
(MHz)
(Bits / Second)
(Bits / Second)
(Bits / Second)
(Bits / Second)
8
125,000
100,000
75,000
62,500
50,000
37,500
31,250
166,667
133,333
100,000
83,333
66,667
50,000
41,667
250,000
200,000
150,000
125,000
100,000
75,000
500,000
400,000
300,000
250,000
200,000
150,000
125,000
6.4
4.8
4
3.2
2.4
2
62,500
Since perfect conditions are almost impossible to attain, more robust values must
be chosen for bit rates. For reliable communication, it is best to ensure that a bit
time is no smaller 2x–3x longer than the filter delay on the digital receive filter. This
is true in LIN or BTM mode and ensures that valid data bits which have been
shortened due to ground shift, asymmetrical rise and fall times, etc., are accepted
by the filter without exception. This would translate to 2x to 3x reduction in the
maximum speeds shown in Table 14-8. Recommended maximum bit rates are
shown in Table 14-9, and ensure that a single bit time is at least twice the length
of one filter delay value. If system noise is not adequately filtered out it might be
necessary to change the prescaler of the filter and lower the bit rate of the
communication. If valid communications are being absorbed by the filter, corrective
action must be taken to ensure that either the bit rate is reduced or whatever
physical fault is causing bit times to shorten is corrected (ground offset,
asymmetrical rise/fall times, insufficient physical layer supply voltage, etc.).
Data Sheet
182
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Oscillator Trimming with SLIC
Table 14-9. Recommended Maximum Bit Rates
for BTM Operation Due to Digital Filter
Maximum BTM
Bit Rate with
Maximum BTM
Bit Rate with
Maximum BTM
Bit Rate with
Maximum BTM
Bit Rate with
SLIC
Clock DigitalRXFilterSet DigitalRXFilterSet DigitalRXFilterSet DigitalRXFilterSet
(MHz)
to ÷4
to ÷3
to ÷2
to ÷1
(Bits / Second)
(Bits / Second)
(Bits / Second)
(Bits / Second)
8
62,500
50,000
37,500
31,250
25,000
18,750
15,625
83,333
66,667
50,000
41,667
33,333
25,000
20,833
125,000
100,000
75,000
62,500
50,000
37,500
31,250
250,000
200,000
150,000
125,000
100,000
125,000
62,500
6.4
4.8
4
3.2
2.4
2
14.19 Oscillator Trimming with SLIC
The SLCACT bit can be used as an indicator of LIN bus activity. SLCACT tells the
user that the SLIC is currently processing a message header (therefore
synchronizing to the bus) or processing a message frame (including checksum).
Therefore, at idle times between message frames or during a message frame
which has been marked as a "don’t care" by writing the IMSG bit, it is possible to
trim the oscillator circuit of the MCU with no impact to the LIN communications.
It is important to note the exact mechanisms with which the SLIC sets and clears
the SLCACT bit. Any falling edge which successfully passes through the digital
receive filter will cause the SLCACT bit to become set. This might even include
noise pulses, if they are of sufficient length to pass through the digital RX filter.
Although in these cases the SLCACT bit is becoming set on a noise spike, it is very
probable that noise of this nature will cause other system issues as well such as
corruption of the message frame. The software can then further qualify if it is
appropriate to trim the oscillator.
The SLCACT bit will only be cleared by the SLIC upon successful completion of a
normal LIN message frame (see 14.6.3 SLIC Status Register description for more
detail). This means that in some cases, if a message frame terminates with an error
condition or some source other than those cited in the SLCACT bit description, the
SLCACT might remain set during an otherwise idle bus time. The SLCACT will then
clear upon the successful completion of the next LIN message frame.
These mechanisms might result in SLCACT being set when it is safe (from the
SLIC module perspective) to trim the oscillator. However, the SLCACT bit will only
be clear when the SLIC considers it safe to trim the oscillator.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
183
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
In a particular system, it might also be possible to improve the opportunities for
trimming by utilizing system knowledge and use of the IMSG bit. If a message ID
is known to be considered a "don’t care" by this particular node, it should be safe
to trim the oscillator during that message frame (provided that it is safe for the
application software as well). After the software has done an identifier lookup and
determined that the ID corresponds to a "don’t care" message, the software might
choose to set the IMSG bit. From that time, the application software should have
at least one byte time of message traffic in which to trim the oscillator before that
ignored message frame expires, regardless of the state of the SLCACT bit. If the
length of that ignored message frame is known, that knowledge might also be
utilized to extend the time of this oscillator trimming opportunity.
Now that the mechanisms for recognizing when the SLIC module indicates safe
oscillator trimming opportunities are understood, it is important to understand how
to derive the information needed to perform the trimming.
The value in the SLCBT register will indicate how many SLIC clock cycles comprise
one bit time and for any given LIN bus speed, this will be a fixed value if the
oscillator is running at its ideal frequency. It is possible to use this ideal value
combined with the measured value in the SLCBT register to determine how to
adjust the oscillator of the microcontroller.
The actual oscillator trimming algorithm is very specific to each particular
implementation, and applications might or might not require the oscillator even to
be trimmed. The SLIC can maintain communications even with input oscillator
variation of ±50% (with 4 MHz nominal, that means that any input clock into the
SLIC from 2 MHz to 6 MHz will still guarantee communications). Since most
Motorola internal oscillators are at least within ±25% of their nominal value, even
when untrimmed, this means that trimming of the oscillator is not even required for
LIN communications. If the application can tolerate the range of frequencies which
might appear within this manufacturing range, then it is not necessary ever to trim
the oscillator. This can be a tremendous advantage to the customer, enabling
migration to very low-cost ROM devices which have no non-volatile memory in
which to store the trim value.
NOTE:
Even though most internal oscillators are within ±25% before trimming, they are
stable at some frequency in that range, within at least ±5% over the entire
operating voltage and temperature range. The trimming operation simply
eliminates the offset due to factory manufacturing variations to re-center the base
oscillator frequency to the nominal value. Please refer to the electrical
specifications for the oscillator for more specific information, as exact specifications
might differ from module to module.
14.20 Digital Receive Filter
The receiver section of the SLIC module includes a digital low-pass filter to remove
narrow noise pulses from the incoming message. An outline of the digital filter is
shown in Figure 14-30.
Data Sheet
184
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Digital Receive Filter
INPUT
SYNC
4-BIT UP/DOWN COUNTER
RX DATA
FROM
SLCRX PAD
4
EDGE &
COUNT
COMPARATOR
FILTERED
RX DATA OUT
OUT
D
Q
D
Q
UP/DOWN
DIGITAL RX FILTER
SLIC CLOCK
PRESCALER (RXFP[1:0])
Figure 14-30. SLIC Module Rx Digital Filter Block Diagram
14.20.1 Operation
The clock for the digital filter is provided by the SLIC Interface clock. At each
positive edge of the clock signal, the current state of the receiver input signal from
the SLCRX pad is sampled. The SLCRX signal state is used to determine whether
the counter should increment or decrement at the next positive edge of the clock
signal.
The counter will increment if the input data sample is high but decrement if the input
sample is low. The counter will thus progress up towards ‘15’ if, on average, the
SLCRX signal remains high or progress down towards ‘0’ if, on average, the
SLCRX signal remains low.
When the counter eventually reaches the value ‘15’, the digital filter decides that
the condition of the SLCRX signal is at a stable logic level 1 and the data latch is
set, causing the filtered Rx data signal to become a logic level 1. Furthermore, the
counter is prevented from overflowing and can only be decremented from this
state.
Alternatively, should the counter eventually reach the value ‘0’, the digital filter
decides that the condition of the SLCRX signal is at a stable logic level 0 and the
data latch is reset, causing the filtered Rx data signal to become a logic level 0.
Furthermore, the counter is prevented from underflowing and can only be
incremented from this state.
The data latch will retain its value until the counter next reaches the opposite end
point, signifying a definite transition of the SLCRX signal.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
185
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
14.20.2 Performance
The performance of the digital filter is best described in the time domain rather than
the frequency domain.
If the signal on the SLCRX signal transitions, then there will be a delay before that
transition appears at the filtered Rx data output signal. This delay will be between
15 and 16 clock periods, depending on where the transition occurs with respect to
the sampling points. This ‘filter delay’ is not an issue for SLIC operation, as there
is no need for message arbitration.
The effect of random noise on the SLCRX signal depends on the characteristics of
the noise itself. Narrow noise pulses on the SLCRX signal will be completely
ignored if they are shorter than the filter delay. This provides a degree of low-pass
filtering. Figure 14-30 shows the configuration of the digital receive filter and the
consequential effect on the filter delay. This filter delay value indicates that for a
particular setup, only pulses of which are greater than the filter delay will pass the
filter.
For example, if the frequency of the SLIC clock (fSLIC) is 3.2 MHz, then the period
(tSLIC) is of the SLIC clock is 313 ns. With the default receive filter prescaler setting
of division by 3, the resulting maximum filter delay in the absence of noise will be
15.00 µs. By simply changing the prescaler of the receive filter, the user can then
select alternatively 5 µs, 10 µs, or 20 µs as a minimum filter delay according to the
systems requirements.
If noise occurs during a symbol transition, the detection of that transition may be
delayed by an amount equal to the length of the noise burst. This is just a reflection
of the uncertainty of where the transition is truly occurring within the noise.
NOTE:
The user must always account for the worst case bit timing of their LIN bus when
configuring the digital receive filter, especially if running at faster speeds. Ground
offset and other physical layer conditions can cause shortening of bits as seen at
the digital receive pin, for example. If these shortened bit lengths are less than the
filter delay, the bits will be interpreted by the filter as noise and will be blocked, even
though the nominal bit timing might be greater than the filter delay.
Data Sheet
186
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Slave LIN Interface Controller (SLIC)
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 15. Timer Interface Module (TIM)
15.1 Introduction
This section describes the timer interface module (TIM). The TIM is a two-channel
timer that provides a timing reference with input capture, output compare, and
pulse-width-modulation functions. Figure 15-2 is a block diagram of the TIM.
15.2 Features
Features of the TIM include the following:
•
Two input capture/output compare channels
–
–
Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger
Set, clear, or toggle output compare action
•
•
Buffered and unbuffered pulse width modulation (PWM) signal generation
Programmable TIM clock input
–
–
7-frequency internal bus clock prescaler selection
External TIM clock input
•
•
•
Free-running or modulo up-count operation
Toggle any channel pin on overflow
TIM counter stop and reset bits
15.3 Pin Name Conventions
The TIM shares two input/output (I/O) pins with two port A I/O pins. The full names
of the TIM I/O pins are listed in Table 15-1. The generic pin name appear in the
text that follows.
Table 15-1. Pin Name Conventions
TIM Generic Pin Names:
Full TIM Pin Names:
TCH0
TCH1
TCLK
PTB0/TCH0
PTA1/TCH1
PTA2/TCLK
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
187
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
CLOCK
GENERATOR
(OSCILLATOR)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
SINGLE INTERRUPT
MODULE
M68HC08 CPU
PTB0/TCH0
PTB1
BREAK
MODULE
PTB2/AD4
PTB3/AD5
PTB4/SLCRX
PTB5/SLCTX
PTB6
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
KEYBOARD INTERRUPT
MODULE
PTB7
2-CH 16-BIT TIMER
MODULE
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL3: 4096 BYTES
MC68HC908QL2: 2048 BYTES
USER FLASH
SLAVE LIN INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
COP
MODULE
6-CHANNEL 10-BIT
ADC
MONITOR ROM
128 BYTES RAM
VDD
VSS
POWER SUPPLY
RST, IRQ: Pins have internal (about 30 kΩ) pull up
PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5: High current sink and source capability
PTA0–PTA5: Pins have programmable keyboard interrupt and pull up
ADC pins only available on MC68HC908QL4 and MC68HC908QL2
Figure 15-1. Block Diagram Highlighting TIM Block and Pins
Data Sheet
188
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Functional Description
15.4 Functional Description
Figure 15-2 shows the structure of the TIM. The central component of the TIM is
the 16-bit TIM counter that can operate as a free-running counter or a modulo
up-counter. The TIM counter provides the timing reference for the input capture
and output compare functions. The TIM counter modulo registers,
TMODH:TMODL, control the modulo value of the TIM counter. Software can read
the TIM counter value at any time without affecting the counting sequence.
The two TIM channels are programmable independently as input capture or output
compare channels.
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PRESCALER SELECT
PRESCALER
INTERNAL
BUS CLOCK
TSTOP
TRST
PS2
PS1
PS0
16-BIT COUNTER
TOF
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
TOIE
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TMODH:TMODL
TOV0
ELS0B
ELS0A
PORT
LOGIC
CHANNEL 0
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH0H:TCH0L
CH0MAX
TCH0
CH0F
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
16-BIT LATCH
CH0IE
MS0A
MS0B
CH1F
TOV1
ELS1B
ELS1A
PORT
LOGIC
CHANNEL 1
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH1H:TCH1L
CH1MAX
TCH1
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
16-BIT LATCH
CH1IE
MS1A
Figure 15-2. TIM Block Diagram
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
189
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
TOF
0
6
5
4
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
TIM Status and Control
TOIE
TSTOP
PS2
PS1
PS0
$0020
Register (TSC) Write:
See page 197.
Reset:
TRST
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
Read:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
TIM Counter Register High
$0021
$0022
$0023
$0024
$0025
$0026
$0027
$0028
$0029
$002A
(TCNTH) Write:
See page 199.
TIM Counter Register Low
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
(TCNTL) Write:
See page 199.
TIM Counter Modulo
Reset:
Read:
0
Bit 15
1
0
Bit 14
1
0
Bit 13
1
0
Bit 12
1
0
Bit 11
1
0
Bit 10
1
0
Bit 9
1
0
Bit 8
Register High (TMODH) Write:
See page 199.
Reset:
1
Bit 0
1
Read:
TIM Counter Modulo
Register Low (TMODL) Write:
Bit 7
Bit 6
1
Bit 5
1
Bit 4
1
Bit 3
1
Bit 2
1
Bit 1
1
See page 199.
Reset:
1
CH0F
0
Read:
TIM Channel 0 Status and
Control Register (TSC0) Write:
CH0IE
0
MS0B
0
MS0A
0
ELS0B
0
ELS0A
0
TOV0
0
CH0MAX
0
See page 200.
Reset:
0
Read:
TIM Channel 0
Register High (TCH0H) Write:
Bit 15
Bit 7
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
See page 203.
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 4 Bit 3
Indeterminate after reset
Read:
TIM Channel 0
Register Low (TCH0L) Write:
Bit 6
Bit 5
0
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
See page 203.
Reset:
Read:
CH1F
TIM Channel 1 Status and
Control Register (TSC1) Write:
CH1IE
0
MS1A
0
ELS1B
0
ELS1A
0
TOV1
0
CH1MAX
0
0
See page 200.
Reset:
0
0
Read:
TIM Channel 1
Register High (TCH1H) Write:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
See page 203.
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 4 Bit 3
Indeterminate after reset
Read:
TIM Channel 1
Register Low (TCH1L) Write:
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
See page 203.
Reset:
= Unimplemented
Figure 15-3. TIM I/O Register Summary
Data Sheet
190
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Functional Description
15.4.1 TIM Counter Prescaler
The TIM clock source is one of the seven prescaler outputs or the TIM clock pin,
TCLK. The prescaler generates seven clock rates from the internal bus clock. The
prescaler select bits, PS[2:0], in the TIM status and control register (TSC) select
the TIM clock source.
15.4.2 Input Capture
With the input capture function, the TIM can capture the time at which an external
event occurs. When an active edge occurs on the pin of an input capture channel,
the TIM latches the contents of the TIM counter into the TIM channel registers,
TCHxH:TCHxL. The polarity of the active edge is programmable. Input captures
can generate TIM central processor unit (CPU) interrupt requests.
15.4.3 Output Compare
With the output compare function, the TIM can generate a periodic pulse with a
programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the counter reaches the
value in the registers of an output compare channel, the TIM can set, clear, or
toggle the channel pin. Output compares can generate TIM CPU interrupt
requests.
15.4.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered output compare pulses as
described in 15.4.3 Output Compare. The pulses are unbuffered because
changing the output compare value requires writing the new value over the old
value currently in the TIM channel registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIM channel registers to change an output compare
value could cause incorrect operation for up to two counter overflow periods. For
example, writing a new value before the counter reaches the old value but after the
counter reaches the new value prevents any compare during that counter overflow
period. Also, using a TIM overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller output
compare value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIM may pass the new
value before it is written.
Use the following methods to synchronize unbuffered changes in the output
compare value on channel x:
•
When changing to a smaller value, enable channel x output compare
interrupts and write the new value in the output compare interrupt routine.
The output compare interrupt occurs at the end of the current output
compare pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the counter
overflow period to write the new value.
•
When changing to a larger output compare value, enable TIM overflow
interrupts and write the new value in the TIM overflow interrupt routine. The
TIM overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the current counter overflow
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
191
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt routine (at the
end of the current pulse) could cause two output compares to occur in the
same counter overflow period.
15.4.3.2 Buffered Output Compare
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered output compare channel whose
output appears on the TCH0 pin. The TIM channel registers of the linked pair
alternately control the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIM channel 0 status and control register (TSC0) links
channel 0 and channel 1. The output compare value in the TIM channel 0 registers
initially controls the output on the TCH0 pin. Writing to the TIM channel 1 registers
enables the TIM channel 1 registers to synchronously control the output after the
TIM overflows. At each subsequent overflow, the TIM channel registers (0 or 1) that
control the output are the ones written to last. TSC0 controls and monitors the
buffered output compare function, and TIM channel 1 status and control register
(TSC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, TCH1, is available
as a general-purpose I/O pin.
NOTE:
In buffered output compare operation, do not write new output compare values to
the currently active channel registers. User software should track the currently
active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active channel. Writing to the
active channel registers is the same as generating unbuffered output compares.
15.4.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM)
By using the toggle-on-overflow feature with an output compare channel, the TIM
can generate a PWM signal. The value in the TIM counter modulo registers
determines the period of the PWM signal. The channel pin toggles when the
counter reaches the value in the TIM counter modulo registers. The time between
overflows is the period of the PWM signal.
As Figure 15-4 shows, the output compare value in the TIM channel registers
determines the pulse width of the PWM signal. The time between overflow and
output compare is the pulse width. Program the TIM to clear the channel pin on
output compare if the state of the PWM pulse is logic 1. Program the TIM to set the
pin if the state of the PWM pulse is logic 0.
The value in the TIM counter modulo registers and the selected prescaler output
determines the frequency of the PWM output. The frequency of an 8-bit PWM
signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing $00FF (255) to the TIM counter
modulo registers produces a PWM period of 256 times the internal bus clock period
if the prescaler select value is 000. See 15.9.1 TIM Status and Control Register.
The value in the TIM channel registers determines the pulse width of the PWM
output. The pulse width of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments.
Writing $0080 (128) to the TIM channel registers produces a duty cycle of 128/256
or 50%.
Data Sheet
192
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Functional Description
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
PULSE
WIDTH
TCHx
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
Figure 15-4. PWM Period and Pulse Width
15.4.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered PWM pulses as described
in 15.4.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM). The pulses are unbuffered because
changing the pulse width requires writing the new pulse width value over the old
value currently in the TIM channel registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIM channel registers to change a pulse width
value could cause incorrect operation for up to two PWM periods. For example,
writing a new value before the counter reaches the old value but after the counter
reaches the new value prevents any compare during that PWM period. Also, using
a TIM overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller pulse width value may
cause the compare to be missed. The TIM may pass the new value before it is
written.
Use the following methods to synchronize unbuffered changes in the PWM pulse
width on channel x:
•
•
When changing to a shorter pulse width, enable channel x output compare
interrupts and write the new value in the output compare interrupt routine.
The output compare interrupt occurs at the end of the current pulse. The
interrupt routine has until the end of the PWM period to write the new value.
When changing to a longer pulse width, enable TIM overflow interrupts and
write the new value in the TIM overflow interrupt routine. The TIM overflow
interrupt occurs at the end of the current PWM period. Writing a larger value
in an output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse) could
cause two output compares to occur in the same PWM period.
NOTE:
In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on output
compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0% duty cycle generation
and removes the ability of the channel to self-correct in the event of software error
or noise. Toggling on output compare also can cause incorrect PWM signal
generation when changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
193
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
15.4.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose output
appears on the TCH0 pin. The TIM channel registers of the linked pair alternately
control the pulse width of the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIM channel 0 status and control register (TSC0) links
channel 0 and channel 1. The TIM channel 0 registers initially control the pulse
width on the TCH0 pin. Writing to the TIM channel 1 registers enables the TIM
channel 1 registers to synchronously control the pulse width at the beginning of the
next PWM period. At each subsequent overflow, the TIM channel registers (0 or 1)
that control the pulse width are the ones written to last. TSC0 controls and monitors
the buffered PWM function, and TIM channel 1 status and control register (TSC1)
is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, TCH1, is available as a
general-purpose I/O pin.
NOTE:
In buffered PWM signal generation, do not write new pulse width values to the
currently active channel registers. User software should track the currently active
channel to prevent writing a new value to the active channel. Writing to the active
channel registers is the same as generating unbuffered PWM signals.
15.4.4.3 PWM Initialization
To ensure correct operation when generating unbuffered or buffered PWM signals,
use the following initialization procedure:
1. In the TIM status and control register (TSC):
a. Stop the TIM counter by setting the TIM stop bit, TSTOP.
b. Reset the TIM counter and prescaler by setting the TIM reset bit,
TRST.
2. In the TIM counter modulo registers (TMODH:TMODL), write the value for
the required PWM period.
3. In the TIM channel x registers (TCHxH:TCHxL), write the value for the
required pulse width.
4. In TIM channel x status and control register (TSCx):
a. Write 0:1 (for unbuffered output compare or PWM signals) or 1:0 (for
buffered output compare or PWM signals) to the mode select bits,
MSxB:MSxA. See Table 15-3.
b. Write 1 to the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx.
c. Write 1:0 (to clear output on compare) or 1:1 (to set output on compare)
to the edge/level select bits, ELSxB:ELSxA. The output action on
compare must force the output to the complement of the pulse width
level. See Table 15-3.
NOTE:
In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on output
compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0% duty cycle generation
and removes the ability of the channel to self-correct in the event of software error
Data Sheet
194
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Interrupts
or noise. Toggling on output compare can also cause incorrect PWM signal
generation when changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value.
5. In the TIM status control register (TSC), clear the TIM stop bit, TSTOP.
Setting MS0B links channels 0 and 1 and configures them for buffered PWM
operation. The TIM channel 0 registers (TCH0H:TCH0L) initially control the
buffered PWM output. TIM status control register 0 (TSCR0) controls and monitors
the PWM signal from the linked channels. MS0B takes priority over MS0A.
Clearing the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx, inhibits output toggles on TIM overflows.
Subsequent output compares try to force the output to a state it is already in and
have no effect. The result is a 0% duty cycle output.
Setting the channel x maximum duty cycle bit (CHxMAX) and setting the TOVx bit
generates a 100% duty cycle output. See 15.9.4 TIM Channel Status and Control
Registers.
15.5 Interrupts
The following TIM sources can generate interrupt requests:
•
TIM overflow flag (TOF) — The TOF bit is set when the TIM counter reaches
the modulo value programmed in the TIM counter modulo registers. The TIM
overflow interrupt enable bit, TOIE, enables TIM overflow CPU interrupt
requests. TOF and TOIE are in the TIM status and control register.
•
TIM channel flags (CH1F:CH0F) — The CHxF bit is set when an input
capture or output compare occurs on channel x. Channel x TIM CPU
interrupt requests are controlled by the channel x interrupt enable bit,
CHxIE. Channel x TIM CPU interrupt requests are enabled when CHxIE =1.
CHxF and CHxIE are in the TIM channel x status and control register.
15.6 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby mode.
The TIM remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait mode the
TIM registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request
from the TIM can bring the MCU out of wait mode.
If TIM functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power consumption by
stopping the TIM before executing the WAIT instruction.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
195
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
15.7 TIM During Break Interrupts
A break interrupt stops the TIM counter.
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in other modules
can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the break flag control
register (BFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. See
13.8.2 Break Flag Control Register.
To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a 1 to the BCFE
bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU
exits the break state.
To protect status bits during the break state, write a 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE
at 0 (its default state), software can read and write I/O registers during the break
state without affecting status bits. Some status bits have a two-step read/write
clearing procedure. If software does the first step on such a bit before the break,
the bit cannot change during the break state as long as BCFE is at 0. After the
break, doing the second step clears the status bit.
15.8 Input/Output Signals
Port A shares two of its pins and port B shares one of its pins with the TIM. Two
TIM channel I/O pins are PTB0/TCH0 and PTA1/TCH1 and an alternate clock
source is PTA2/TCLK.
15.8.1 TIM Clock Pin (PTA2/TCLK)
PTA2/TCLK is an external clock input that can be the clock source for the TIM
counter instead of the prescaled internal bus clock. Select the PTA2/TCLK input
by writing logic 1s to the three prescaler select bits, PS[2–0]. (See 15.9.1 TIM
Status and Control Register.) When the PTA2/TCLK pin is the TIM clock input, it
is an input regardless of port pin initialization.
15.8.2 TIM Channel I/O Pins (PTB0/TCH0 and PTA1/TCH1)
Each channel I/O pin is programmable independently as an input capture pin or an
output compare pin. PTB0/TCH0 can be configured as a buffered output compare
or buffered PWM pin.
Data Sheet
196
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Input/Output Registers
15.9 Input/Output Registers
The following I/O registers control and monitor operation of the TIM:
•
•
•
•
•
TIM status and control register (TSC)
TIM control registers (TCNTH:TCNTL)
TIM counter modulo registers (TMODH:TMODL)
TIM channel status and control registers (TSC0 and TSC1)
TIM channel registers (TCH0H:TCH0L and TCH1H:TCH1L)
15.9.1 TIM Status and Control Register
The TIM status and control register (TSC) does the following:
•
•
•
•
•
Enables TIM overflow interrupts
Flags TIM overflows
Stops the TIM counter
Resets the TIM counter
Prescales the TIM counter clock
Address: $0020
Bit 7
6
TOIE
0
5
TSTOP
1
4
0
3
0
2
PS2
0
1
PS1
0
Bit 0
PS0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
TOF
0
0
TRST
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 15-5. TIM Status and Control Register (TSC)
TOF — TIM Overflow Flag Bit
This read/write flag is set when the TIM counter reaches the modulo value
programmed in the TIM counter modulo registers. Clear TOF by reading the TIM
status and control register when TOF is set and then writing a 0 to TOF. If
another TIM overflow occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then
writing 0 to TOF has no effect. Therefore, a TOF interrupt request cannot be lost
due to inadvertent clearing of TOF. Reset clears the TOF bit. Writing a 1 to TOF
has no effect.
1 = TIM counter has reached modulo value
0 = TIM counter has not reached modulo value
TOIE — TIM Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIM overflow interrupts when the TOF bit becomes
set. Reset clears the TOIE bit.
1 = TIM overflow interrupts enabled
0 = TIM overflow interrupts disabled
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
197
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
TSTOP — TIM Stop Bit
This read/write bit stops the TIM counter. Counting resumes when TSTOP is
cleared. Reset sets the TSTOP bit, stopping the TIM counter until software
clears the TSTOP bit.
1 = TIM counter stopped
0 = TIM counter active
NOTE:
Do not set the TSTOP bit before entering wait mode if the TIM is required to exit
wait mode.
TRST — TIM Reset Bit
Setting this write-only bit resets the TIM counter and the TIM prescaler. Setting
TRST has no effect on any other registers. Counting resumes from $0000.
TRST is cleared automatically after the TIM counter is reset and always reads
as 0. Reset clears the TRST bit.
1 = Prescaler and TIM counter cleared
0 = No effect
NOTE:
Setting the TSTOP and TRST bits simultaneously stops the TIM counter at a value
of $0000.
PS[2:0] — Prescaler Select Bits
These read/write bits select either the PTA2/TCLK pin or one of the seven
prescaler outputs as the input to the TIM counter as Table 15-2 shows. Reset
clears the PS[2:0] bits.
Table 15-2. Prescaler Selection
PS2
0
PS1
0
PS0
0
TIM Clock Source
Internal bus clock ÷ 1
Internal bus clock ÷ 2
Internal bus clock ÷ 4
Internal bus clock ÷ 8
Internal bus clock ÷ 16
Internal bus clock ÷ 32
Internal bus clock ÷ 64
PTA2/TCLK
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
Data Sheet
198
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Input/Output Registers
15.9.2 TIM Counter Registers
The two read-only TIM counter registers contain the high and low bytes of the value
in the TIM counter. Reading the high byte (TCNTH) latches the contents of the low
byte (TCNTL) into a buffer. Subsequent reads of TCNTH do not affect the latched
TCNTL value until TCNTL is read. Reset clears the TIM counter registers. Setting
the TIM reset bit (TRST) also clears the TIM counter registers.
NOTE:
If you read TCNTH during a break interrupt, be sure to unlatch TCNTL by reading
TCNTL before exiting the break interrupt. Otherwise, TCNTL retains the value
latched during the break.
Address: $0021
Bit 7
TCNTH
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Reset:
0
0
TCNTL
6
0
0
0
0
0
0
$0022
Address:
Bit 7
Bit 7
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 15-6. TIM Counter Registers (TCNTH:TCNTL)
15.9.3 TIM Counter Modulo Registers
The read/write TIM modulo registers contain the modulo value for the TIM counter.
When the TIM counter reaches the modulo value, the overflow flag (TOF) becomes
set, and the TIM counter resumes counting from $0000 at the next timer clock.
Writing to the high byte (TMODH) inhibits the TOF bit and overflow interrupts until
the low byte (TMODL) is written. Reset sets the TIM counter modulo registers.
Address: $0023
Bit 7
TMODH
6
5
Bit 13
1
4
Bit 12
1
3
Bit 11
1
2
Bit 10
1
1
Bit 9
1
Bit 0
Bit 8
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 15
1
Bit 14
1
TMODL
6
Address: $0024
Bit 7
5
Bit 5
1
4
Bit 4
1
3
Bit 3
1
2
Bit 2
1
1
Bit 1
1
Bit 0
Bit 0
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
1
Bit 6
1
Figure 15-7. TIM Counter Modulo Registers (TMODH:TMODL)
NOTE:
Reset the TIM counter before writing to the TIM counter modulo registers.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
199
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
15.9.4 TIM Channel Status and Control Registers
Each of the TIM channel status and control registers does the following:
•
•
•
•
•
Flags input captures and output compares
Enables input capture and output compare interrupts
Selects input capture, output compare, or PWM operation
Selects high, low, or toggling output on output compare
Selects rising edge, falling edge, or any edge as the active input capture
trigger
•
•
•
Selects output toggling on TIM overflow
Selects 0% and 100% PWM duty cycle
Selects buffered or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
Address: $0025
Bit 7
TSC0
6
5
MS0B
0
4
MS0A
0
3
ELS0B
0
2
ELS0A
0
1
TOV0
0
Bit 0
CH0MAX
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
CH0F
CH0IE
0
0
0
$0028
TSC1
Address:
Bit 7
CH1F
0
6
CH1IE
0
5
0
4
MS1A
0
3
ELS1B
0
2
ELS1A
0
1
TOV1
0
Bit 0
CH1MAX
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 15-8. TIM Channel Status and Control
Registers (TSC0:TSC1)
CHxF — Channel x Flag Bit
When channel x is an input capture channel, this read/write bit is set when an
active edge occurs on the channel x pin. When channel x is an output compare
channel, CHxF is set when the value in the TIM counter registers matches the
value in the TIM channel x registers.
Clear CHxF by reading the TIM channel x status and control register with CHxF
set and then writing a 0 to CHxF. If another interrupt request occurs before the
clearing sequence is complete, then writing 0 to CHxF has no effect. Therefore,
an interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of CHxF.
Reset clears the CHxF bit. Writing a 1 to CHxF has no effect.
1 = Input capture or output compare on channel x
0 = No input capture or output compare on channel x
Data Sheet
200
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Input/Output Registers
CHxIE — Channel x Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIM CPU interrupt service requests on channel x.
Reset clears the CHxIE bit.
1 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests enabled
0 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests disabled
MSxB — Mode Select Bit B
This read/write bit selects buffered output compare/PWM operation. MSxB
exists only in the TIM channel 0 status and control register.
Setting MS0B disables the channel 1 status and control register and reverts
TCH1 to general-purpose I/O.
Reset clears the MSxB bit.
1 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation enabled
0 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation disabled
MSxA — Mode Select Bit A
When ELSxB:A ≠ 00, this read/write bit selects either input capture operation or
unbuffered output compare/PWM operation.
See Table 15-3.
1 = Unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
0 = Input capture operation
When ELSxB:A = 00, this read/write bit selects the initial output level of the
TCHx pin (see Table 15-3). Reset clears the MSxA bit.
1 = Initial output level low
0 = Initial output level high
NOTE:
Before changing a channel function by writing to the MSxB or MSxA bit, set the
TSTOP and TRST bits in the TIM status and control register (TSC).
Table 15-3. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection
MSxB MSxA
ELSxB
ELSxA
Mode
Configuration
Pin under port control;
initial output level high
X
X
0
1
0
0
Output preset
Pin under port control;
initial output level low
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
X
X
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
Capture on rising edge only
Capture on falling edge only
Capture on rising or falling edge
Software compare only
Input capture
Toggle output on compare
Clear output on compare
Set output on compare
Output compare
or PWM
Buffered
output
compare or
buffered PWM
Toggle output on compare
Clear output on compare
1
X
1
1
Set output on compare
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
201
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
ELSxB and ELSxA — Edge/Level Select Bits
When channel x is an input capture channel, these read/write bits control the
active edge-sensing logic on channel x.
When channel x is an output compare channel, ELSxB and ELSxA control the
channel x output behavior when an output compare occurs.
When ELSxB and ELSxA are both clear, channel x is not connected to an I/O
port, and pin TCHx is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. Table 15-3 shows
how ELSxB and ELSxA work. Reset clears the ELSxB and ELSxA bits.
NOTE:
After initially enabling a TIM channel register for input capture operation and
selecting the edge sensitivity, clear CHxF to ignore any erroneous edge detection
flags.
TOVx — Toggle-On-Overflow Bit
When channel x is an output compare channel, this read/write bit controls the
behavior of the channel x output when the TIM counter overflows. When
channel x is an input capture channel, TOVx has no effect. Reset clears the
TOVx bit.
1 = Channel x pin toggles on TIM counter overflow.
0 = Channel x pin does not toggle on TIM counter overflow.
NOTE:
When TOVx is set, a TIM counter overflow takes precedence over a channel x
output compare if both occur at the same time.
CHxMAX — Channel x Maximum Duty Cycle Bit
When the TOVx bit is at 1, setting the CHxMAX bit forces the duty cycle of
buffered and unbuffered PWM signals to 100%. As Figure 15-9 shows, the
CHxMAX bit takes effect in the cycle after it is set or cleared. The output stays
at the 100% duty cycle level until the cycle after CHxMAX is cleared.
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
TCHx
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
CHxMAX
Figure 15-9. CHxMAX Latency
Data Sheet
202
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Input/Output Registers
15.9.5 TIM Channel Registers
These read/write registers contain the captured TIM counter value of the input
capture function or the output compare value of the output compare function. The
state of the TIM channel registers after reset is unknown.
In input capture mode (MSxB:MSxA = 0:0), reading the high byte of the TIM
channel x registers (TCHxH) inhibits input captures until the low byte (TCHxL) is
read.
In output compare mode (MSxB:MSxA ≠ 0:0), writing to the high byte of the TIM
channel x registers (TCHxH) inhibits output compares until the low byte (TCHxL) is
written.
Address: $0026
Bit 7
TCH0H
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
$0027
TCH0L
6
Address:
Bit 7
Bit 7
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
$0029
TCH1H
6
Address:
Bit 7
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
$02A
TCH1L
6
Address:
Bit 7
Bit 7
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 15-10. TIM Channel Registers (TCH0H/L:TCH1H/L)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
203
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Data Sheet
204
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface Module (TIM)
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 16. Development Support
16.1 Introduction
This section describes the break module, the monitor module, and the monitor
mode entry methods.
16.2 Break Module (BRK)
The break module can generate a break interrupt that stops normal program flow
at a defined address to enter a background program.
Features include:
•
•
•
•
Accessible input/output (I/O) registers during the break Interrupt
Central processor unit (CPU) generated break interrupts
Software-generated break interrupts
Computer operating properly (COP) disabling during break interrupts
16.2.1 Functional Description
When the internal address bus matches the value written in the break address
registers, the break module issues a breakpoint signal (BKPT) to the system
integration module (SIM). The SIM then causes the CPU to load the instruction
register with a software interrupt instruction (SWI). The program counter vectors to
$FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC and $FEFD in monitor mode).
The following events can cause a break interrupt to occur:
•
A CPU generated address (the address in the program counter) matches
the contents of the break address registers.
•
Software writes a 1 to the BRKA bit in the break status and control register.
When a CPU generated address matches the contents of the break address
registers, the break interrupt is generated. A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI)
in the break routine ends the break interrupt and returns the microcontroller unit
(MCU) to normal operation.
Figure 16-2 shows the structure of the break module.
Figure 16-3 provides a summary of the I/O registers.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
205
Development Support
Development Support
PTA0/AD0/KBI0
PTA1/AD1/TCH1/KBI1
PTA2/IRQ/KBI2/TCLK
PTA3/RST/KBI3
CLOCK
GENERATOR
(OSCILLATOR)
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
PTA4/OSC2/AD2/KBI4
PTA5/OSC1/AD3/KBI5
SINGLE INTERRUPT
MODULE
M68HC08 CPU
PTB0/TCH0
PTB1
BREAK
MODULE
PTB2/AD4
PTB3/AD5
PTB4/SLCRX
PTB5/SLCTX
PTB6
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
KEYBOARD INTERRUPT
MODULE
PTB7
2-CH 16-BIT TIMER
MODULE
MC68HC908QL4 AND MC68HC908QL3: 4096 BYTES
MC68HC908QL2: 2048 BYTES
USER FLASH
SLAVE LIN INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
COP
MODULE
6-CHANNEL 10-BIT
ADC
MONITOR ROM
128 BYTES RAM
VDD
POWER SUPPLY
VSS
RST, IRQ: Pins have internal (about 30 kΩ) pull up
PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5: High current sink and source capability
PTA0–PTA5: Pins have programmable keyboard interrupt and pull up
ADC pins only available on MC68HC908QL4 and MC68HC908QL2
Figure 16-1. Block Diagram Highlighting BRK and MON Blocks
Data Sheet
206
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Development Support
Development Support
Break Module (BRK)
ADDRESS BUS[15:8]
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH
8-BIT COMPARATOR
ADDRESS BUS[15:0]
CONTROL
BKPT
(TO SIM)
8-BIT COMPARATOR
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW
ADDRESS BUS[7:0]
Figure 16-2. Break Module Block Diagram
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
SBSW
Note(1)
0
Bit 0
Read:
Break Status Register
(BSR) Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
$FE00
See page 211.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Break Auxiliary Register
BDCOP
$FE02
$FE03
$FE09
$FE0A
$FE0B
(BRKAR) Write:
See page 210.
Reset:
Read:
0
BCFE
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Break Flag Control
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Register (BFCR) Write:
See page 211.
Reset:
Read:
Break Address High
Register (BRKH) Write:
Bit 15
0
Bit 14
0
Bit 13
0
Bit 12
0
Bit 11
0
Bit 10
0
Bit 9
0
Bit 8
0
See page 210.
Reset:
Read:
Break Address Low
Register (BRKL) Write:
Bit 7
0
Bit 6
0
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
See page 210.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Break Status and Control
Register (BRKSCR) Write:
BRKE
0
BRKA
0
See page 209.
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
1. Writing a 0 clears SBSW.
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
Figure 16-3. Break I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
207
Development Support
Development Support
When the internal address bus matches the value written in the break address
registers or when software writes a 1 to the BRKA bit in the break status and control
register, the CPU starts a break interrupt by:
•
•
Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction
Loading the program counter with $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC and $FEFD
in monitor mode)
The break interrupt timing is:
•
When a break address is placed at the address of the instruction opcode,
the instruction is not executed until after completion of the break interrupt
routine.
•
•
When a break address is placed at an address of an instruction operand, the
instruction is executed before the break interrupt.
When software writes a 1 to the BRKA bit, the break interrupt occurs just
before the next instruction is executed.
By updating a break address and clearing the BRKA bit in a break interrupt routine,
a break interrupt can be generated continuously.
CAUTION:
A break address should be placed at the address of the instruction opcode. When
software does not change the break address and clears the BRKA bit in the first
break interrupt routine, the next break interrupt will not be generated after exiting
the interrupt routine even when the internal address bus matches the value written
in the break address registers.
16.2.1.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether or not module status bits
can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the break flag control
register (BFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. See
13.8.2 Break Flag Control Register and the Break Interrupts subsection for
each module.
16.2.1.2 TIM During Break Interrupts
A break interrupt stops the timer counter.
16.2.1.3 COP During Break Interrupts
The COP is disabled during a break interrupt with monitor mode when BDCOP bit
is set in break auxiliary register (BRKAR).
Data Sheet
208
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Development Support
MOTOROLA
Development Support
Break Module (BRK)
16.2.2 Break Module Registers
These registers control and monitor operation of the break module:
•
•
•
•
•
Break status and control register (BRKSCR)
Break address register high (BRKH)
Break address register low (BRKL)
Break status register (BSR)
Break flag control register (BFCR)
16.2.2.1 Break Status and Control Register
The break status and control register (BRKSCR) contains break module enable
and status bits.
$FE0B
Bit 7
Address:
6
BRKA
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
BRKE
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 16-4. Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR)
BRKE — Break Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables breaks on break address register matches. Clear
BRKE by writing a 0 to bit 7. Reset clears the BRKE bit.
1 = Breaks enabled on 16-bit address match
0 = Breaks disabled
BRKA — Break Active Bit
This read/write status and control bit is set when a break address match occurs.
Writing a 1 to BRKA generates a break interrupt. Clear BRKA by writing a 0 to
it before exiting the break routine. Reset clears the BRKA bit.
1 = Break address match
0 = No break address match
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
209
Development Support
Development Support
16.2.2.2 Break Address Registers
The break address registers (BRKH and BRKL) contain the high and low bytes of
the desired breakpoint address. Reset clears the break address registers.
$FE09
Address:
Bit 7
6
Bit 14
0
5
Bit 13
0
4
Bit 12
0
3
Bit 11
0
2
Bit 10
0
1
Bit 9
0
Bit 0
Bit 8
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Bit 15
0
Figure 16-5. Break Address Register High (BRKH)
$FE0A
Address:
Bit 7
Bit 7
0
6
Bit 6
0
5
Bit 5
0
4
Bit 4
0
3
Bit 3
0
2
Bit 2
0
1
Bit 1
0
Bit 0
Bit 0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 16-6. Break Address Register Low (BRKL)
16.2.2.3 Break Auxiliary Register
The break auxiliary register (BRKAR) contains a bit that enables software to
disable the COP while the MCU is in a state of break interrupt with monitor mode.
$FE02
Address:
Bit 7
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
Bit 0
BDCOP
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 16-7. Break Auxiliary Register (BRKAR)
BDCOP — Break Disable COP Bit
This read/write bit disables the COP during a break interrupt. Reset clears the
BDCOP bit.
1 = COP disabled during break interrupt
0 = COP enabled during break interrupt
Data Sheet
210
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Development Support
MOTOROLA
Development Support
Break Module (BRK)
16.2.2.4 Break Status Register
The break status register (BSR) contains a flag to indicate that a break caused an
exit from wait mode. This register is only used in emulation mode.
Address: $FE00
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
SBSW
Note(1)
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
= Reserved
1. Writing a 0 clears SBSW.
Figure 16-8. Break Status Register (BSR)
SBSW — SIM Break Stop/Wait
SBSW can be read within the break state SWI routine. The user can modify the
return address on the stack by subtracting one from it.
1 = Wait mode was exited by break interrupt
0 = Wait mode was not exited by break interrupt
16.2.2.5 Break Flag Control Register
The break control register (BFCR) contains a bit that enables software to clear
status bits while the MCU is in a break state.
$FE03
Address:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
= Reserved
R
Figure 16-9. Break Flag Control Register (BFCR)
BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing status
registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits during the break
state, the BCFE bit must be set.
1 = Status bits clearable during break
0 = Status bits not clearable during break
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
211
Development Support
Development Support
16.2.3 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby
modes. If enabled, the break module will remain enabled in wait and stop modes.
However, since the internal address bus does not increment in these modes, a
break interrupt will never be triggered.
16.3 Monitor Module (MON)
The monitor module (MON) allows debugging and programming of the
microcontroller unit (MCU) through a single-wire interface with a host computer.
Monitor mode entry can be achieved without use of the higher test voltage, VTST
as long as vector addresses $FFFE and $FFFF are blank, thus reducing the
hardware requirements for in-circuit programming.
,
Features include:
•
•
Normal user-mode pin functionality
One pin dedicated to serial communication between MCU and host
computer
•
•
•
•
•
Standard non-return-to-zero (NRZ) communication with host computer
Execution of code in random-access memory (RAM) or FLASH
FLASH memory security feature(1)
FLASH memory programming interface
Use of external 9.8304 MHz crystal or clock to generate internal frequency
of 2.4576 MHz
•
•
•
Simple internal oscillator mode of operation (no external clock or high
voltage)
Monitor mode entry without high voltage, VTST, if reset vector is blank
($FFFE and $FFFF contain $FF)
Normal monitor mode entry if VTST is applied to IRQ
16.3.1 Functional Description
Figure 16-10 shows a simplified diagram of monitor mode entry.
The monitor module receives and executes commands from a host computer.
Figure 16-11, Figure 16-12, and Figure 16-13 show example circuits used to
enter monitor mode and communicate with a host computer via a standard RS-232
interface.
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading or
copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users.
Data Sheet
212
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Development Support
MOTOROLA
Development Support
Monitor Module (MON)
POR RESET
YES
NO
IRQ = VTST
?
CONDITIONS
FROM Table 16-1
PTA0 = 1,
PTA1 = 1, AND
PTA4 = 0?
PTA0 = 1,
RESET VECTOR
BLANK?
NO
NO
YES
YES
FORCED
MONITOR MODE
NORMAL
USER MODE
NORMAL
MONITOR MODE
INVALID
USER MODE
HOST SENDS
8 SECURITY BYTES
YES
IS RESET
POR?
NO
ARE ALL
SECURITY BYTES
CORRECT?
YES
NO
ENABLE FLASH
DISABLE FLASH
MONITOR MODE ENTRY
DEBUGGING
AND FLASH
PROGRAMMING
(IF FLASH
IS ENABLED)
EXECUTE
MONITOR CODE
NO
YES
DOES RESET
OCCUR?
Figure 16-10. Simplified Monitor Mode Entry Flowchart
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
213
Development Support
Development Support
VDD
VDD
10 kΩ*
VDD
RST (PTA3)
0.1 µF
9.8304 MHz CLOCK
VTST
MAX232
VDD
OSC1 (PTA5)
1
16
15
2
C1+
+
+
+
VDD
1 µF
1 µF
3
4
C1–
C2+
1 µF
+
1 kΩ
10 kΩ*
10 kΩ*
PTA1
V+
V–
IRQ (PTA2)
VDD
1 µF
6
5
9.1 V
C2–
1 µF
10 kΩ
+
PTA4
74HC125
6
DB9
5
10
9
2
7
8
PTA0
74HC125
3
2
4
3
5
VSS
1
* Value not critical
Figure 16-11. Monitor Mode Circuit (External Clock, with High Voltage)
VDD
N.C.
RST (PTA3)
VDD
0.1 µF
MAX232
VDD
1
16
15
2
9.8304 MHz CLOCK
C1+
OSC1 (PTA5)
+
+
+
1 µF
1 µF
3
4
1 µF
C1–
C2+
+
PTA1
PTA4
N.C.
N.C.
10 kΩ*
V+
V–
VDD
IRQ (PTA2)
1 µF
6
5
C2–
1 µF
10 kΩ
+
74HC125
DB9
5
10
9
2
7
8
6
PTA0
74HC125
3
4
3
5
2
VSS
1
* Value not critical
Figure 16-12. Forced Monitor Mode Circuit (External Clock, No High Voltage)
Data Sheet
214
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Development Support
Development Support
Monitor Module (MON)
VDD
N.C.
N.C.
RST (PTA3)
VDD
0.1 µF
MAX232
VDD
OSC1 (PTA5)
IRQ (PTA2)
1
16
15
2
C1+
+
+
+
1 µF
1 µF
PTA1
PTA4
N.C.
N.C.
3
4
1 µF
C1–
C2+
+
10 kΩ*
V+
V–
VDD
1 µF
6
5
C2–
1 µF
10 kΩ
+
74HC125
DB9
5
10
9
2
7
8
6
PTA0
VSS
74HC125
3
2
4
3
5
1
* Value not critical
Figure 16-13. Forced Monitor Mode Circuit (Internal Clock, No High Voltage)
Simple monitor commands can access any memory address. In monitor mode, the
MCU can execute code downloaded into RAM by a host computer while most MCU
pins retain normal operating mode functions. All communication between the host
computer and the MCU is through the PTA0 pin. A level-shifting and multiplexing
interface is required between PTA0 and the host computer. PTA0 is used in a
wired-OR configuration and requires a pullup resistor.
The monitor code has been updated from previous versions of the monitor code to
allow enabling the internal oscillator to generate the internal clock. This addition,
which is enabled when IRQ is held low out of reset, is intended to support serial
communication/programming at 9600 baud in monitor mode by using the internal
oscillator, and the internal oscillator user trim value OSCTRIM (FLASH location
$FFC0, if programmed) to generate the desired internal frequency (3.2 MHz).
Since this feature is enabled only when IRQ is held low out of reset, it cannot be
used when the reset vector is programmed (i.e., the value is not $FFFF) because
entry into monitor mode in this case requires VTST on IRQ. The IRQ pin must
remain low during this monitor session in order to maintain communication.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
215
Development Support
Development Support
Table 16-1 shows the pin conditions for entering monitor mode. As specified in the
table, monitor mode may be entered after a power-on reset (POR) and will allow
communication at 9600 baud provided one of the following sets of conditions is
met:
•
•
•
If $FFFE and $FFFF do not contain $FF (programmed state):
–
–
The external clock is 9.8304 MHz
IRQ = VTST
If $FFFE and $FFFF contain $FF (erased state):
–
–
The external clock is 9.8304 MHz
IRQ = VDD (this can be implemented through the internal IRQ pullup)
If $FFFE and $FFFF contain $FF (erased state):
IRQ = VSS (internal oscillator is selected, no external clock required)
–
Table 16-1. Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options
Serial
Communi-
cation
Mode
Selection
Communication
Speed
IRQ
RST
Reset
Mode
COP
Comments
(PTA2) (PTA3) Vector
External
Clock
Bus
Baud
PTA0
PTA1 PTA4
Frequency Rate
Normal
Monitor
9.8304
MHz
2.4576
9600
Provide external
clock at OSC1.
VTST
VDD
X
1
1
0
Disabled
MHz
$FFFF
(blank)
9.8304
MHz
2.4576
9600
Provide external
clock at OSC1.
VDD
VSS
X
X
X
X
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
MHz
Forced
Monitor
$FFFF
(blank)
3.2 MHz
9600
Internal clock is
active.
X
X
(Trimmed)
Not
$FFFF
User
X
X
MON08
Function
[Pin No.]
VTST
[6]
RST
[4]
COM
[8]
MOD0 MOD1
[12] [10]
OSC1
[13]
—
—
—
—
1. PTA0 must have a pullup resistor to VDD in monitor mode.
2. Communication speed in the table is an example to obtain a baud rate of 9600. Baud rate using external oscillator is bus
frequency / 256 and baud rate using internal oscillator is bus frequency / 333.
3. External clock is a 9.8304 MHz oscillator on OSC1.
4. X = don’t care
5. MON08 pin refers to P&E Microcomputer Systems’ MON08-Cyclone 2 by 8-pin connector.
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
1
3
5
7
9
2
4
6
8
GND
RST
IRQ
PTA0
10 PTA4
12 PTA1
14 NC
NC 11
OSC1 13
VDD
15
16 NC
Data Sheet
216
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Development Support
Development Support
Monitor Module (MON)
The rising edge of the internal RST signal latches the monitor mode. Once monitor
mode is latched, the values on PTA1 and PTA4 pins can be changed.
Once out of reset, the MCU waits for the host to send eight security bytes
(see 16.3.2 Security). After the security bytes, the MCU sends a break signal
(10 consecutive 0s) to the host, indicating that it is ready to receive a command.
16.3.1.1 Normal Monitor Mode
RST and OSC1 functions will be active on the PTA3 and PTA5 pins respectively
as long as VTST is applied to the IRQ pin. If the IRQ pin is lowered (no longer VTST
then the chip will still be operating in monitor mode, but the pin functions will be
determined by the settings in the configuration registers (see Section 5.
Configuration Registers (CONFIG1 and CONFIG2)) when VTST was lowered.
)
With VTST lowered, the BIH and BIL instructions will read the IRQ pin state only if
IRQEN is set in the CONFIG2 register.
If monitor mode was entered with VTST on IRQ, then the COP is disabled as long
as VTST is applied to IRQ.
16.3.1.2 Forced Monitor Mode
If entering monitor mode without high voltage on IRQ, then startup port pin
requirements and conditions, (PTA1/PTA4) are not in effect. This is to reduce
circuit requirements when performing in-circuit programming.
NOTE:
If the reset vector is blank and monitor mode is entered, the chip will see an
additional reset cycle after the initial power-on reset (POR). Once the reset vector
has been programmed, the traditional method of applying a voltage, VTST, to IRQ
must be used to enter monitor mode.
If monitor mode was entered as a result of the reset vector being blank, the COP
is always disabled regardless of the state of IRQ.
If the voltage applied to the IRQ is less than VTST, the MCU will come out of reset
in user mode. Internal circuitry monitors the reset vector fetches and will assert an
internal reset if it detects that the reset vectors are erased ($FF). When the MCU
comes out of reset, it is forced into monitor mode without requiring high voltage on
the IRQ pin. Once out of reset, the monitor code is initially executing with the
internal clock at its default frequency.
If IRQ is held high, all pins will default to regular input port functions except for
PTA0 and PTA5 which will operate as a serial communication port and OSC1 input
respectively (refer to Figure 16-12). That will allow the clock to be driven from an
external source through OSC1 pin.
If IRQ is held low, all pins will default to regular input port function except for PTA0
which will operate as serial communication port. Refer to Figure 16-13.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
217
Development Support
Development Support
Regardless of the state of the IRQ pin, it will not function as a port input pin in
monitor mode. Bit 2 of the Port A data register will always read 0. The BIH and BIL
instructions will behave as if the IRQ pin is enabled, regardless of the settings in
the configuration register. See Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG1
and CONFIG2).
The COP module is disabled in forced monitor mode. Any reset other than a
power-on reset (POR) will automatically force the MCU to come back to the forced
monitor mode.
16.3.1.3 Monitor Vectors
In monitor mode, the MCU uses different vectors for reset, SWI (software interrupt),
and break interrupt than those for user mode. The alternate vectors are in the $FE
page instead of the $FF page and allow code execution from the internal monitor
firmware instead of user code.
NOTE:
Exiting monitor mode after it has been initiated by having a blank reset vector
requires a power-on reset (POR). Pulling RST (when RST pin available) low will
not exit monitor mode in this situation.
Table 16-2 summarizes the differences between user mode and monitor mode
regarding vectors.
Table 16-2. Mode Differences
Functions
Break Break
Modes
Reset
Reset
SWI
SWI
Vector High Vector Low Vector High Vector Low Vector High Vector Low
User
$FFFE
$FEFE
$FFFF
$FEFF
$FFFC
$FEFC
$FFFD
$FEFD
$FFFC
$FEFC
$FFFD
$FEFD
Monitor
16.3.1.4 Data Format
Communication with the monitor ROM is in standard non-return-to-zero (NRZ)
mark/space data format. Transmit and receive baud rates must be identical.
NEXT
START
BIT
START
BIT
BIT 6
STOP
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 7
Figure 16-14. Monitor Data Format
Data Sheet
218
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Development Support
Development Support
Monitor Module (MON)
16.3.1.5 Break Signal
A start bit (0) followed by nine 0 bits is a break signal. When the monitor receives
a break signal, it drives the PTA0 pin high for the duration of approximately two bits
and then echoes back the break signal.
MISSING STOP BIT
APPROXIMATELY 2 BITS DELAY
BEFORE ZERO ECHO
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Figure 16-15. Break Transaction
16.3.1.6 Baud Rate
The monitor communication baud rate is controlled by the frequency of the external
or internal oscillator and the state of the appropriate pins as shown in Table 16-1.
Table 16-1 also lists the bus frequencies to achieve standard baud rates. The
effective baud rate is the bus frequency divided by 256 when using an external
oscillator. When using the internal oscillator in forced monitor mode, the effective
baud rate is the bus frequency divided by 335.
16.3.1.7 Commands
The monitor ROM firmware uses these commands:
•
•
•
•
•
•
READ (read memory)
WRITE (write memory)
IREAD (indexed read)
IWRITE (indexed write)
READSP (read stack pointer)
RUN (run user program)
The monitor ROM firmware echoes each received byte back to the PTA0 pin for
error checking. An 11-bit delay at the end of each command allows the host to send
a break character to cancel the command. A delay of two bit times occurs before
each echo and before READ, IREAD, or READSP data is returned. The data
returned by a read command appears after the echo of the last byte of the
command.
NOTE:
Wait one bit time after each echo before sending the next byte.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
219
Development Support
Development Support
FROM
HOST
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
READ
READ
DATA
4
4
1
1
4
1
3, 2
4
ECHO
Notes:
1 = Echo delay, approximately 2 bit times
RETURN
2 = Data return delay, approximately 2 bit times
3 = Cancel command delay, 11 bit times
4 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 16-16. Read Transaction
FROM
HOST
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
DATA
DATA
WRITE
WRITE
3
3
1
1
3
1
3
1
2, 3
ECHO
Notes:
1 = Echo delay, approximately 2 bit times
2 = Cancel command delay, 11 bit times
3 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte.
Figure 16-17. Write Transaction
A brief description of each monitor mode command is given in Table 16-3 through
Table 16-8.
Table 16-3. READ (Read Memory) Command
Description Read byte from memory
Operand 2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order
Data Returned Returns contents of specified address
Opcode $4A
Command Sequence
SENT TO MONITOR
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS
LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
READ
READ
DATA
ECHO
RETURN
Data Sheet
220
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Development Support
Development Support
Monitor Module (MON)
Table 16-4. WRITE (Write Memory) Command
Description Write byte to memory
Operand 2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order; low byte followed by data byte
Data Returned None
Opcode $49
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
ADDRESS
HIGH
ADDRESS ADDRESS
HIGH LOW
ADDRESS
LOW
DATA
DATA
WRITE
WRITE
ECHO
Table 16-5. IREAD (Indexed Read) Command
Description Read next 2 bytes in memory from last address accessed
Operand 2-byte address in high byte:low byte order
Data Returned Returns contents of next two addresses
Opcode $1A
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
IREAD
IREAD
DATA
DATA
ECHO
RETURN
Table 16-6. IWRITE (Indexed Write) Command
Description Write to last address accessed + 1
Operand Single data byte
Data Returned None
Opcode $19
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
DATA
DATA
IWRITE
ECHO
IWRITE
A sequence of IREAD or IWRITE commands can access a block of memory
sequentially over the full 64-Kbyte memory map.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
221
Development Support
Development Support
Table 16-7. READSP (Read Stack Pointer) Command
Description Reads stack pointer
Operand None
Returns incremented stack pointer value (SP + 1) in high-byte:low-byte
Data Returned
order
Opcode $0C
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
SP
HIGH
SP
LOW
READSP
READSP
ECHO
RETURN
Table 16-8. RUN (Run User Program) Command
Description Executes PULH and RTI instructions
Operand None
Data Returned None
Opcode $28
Command Sequence
FROM HOST
RUN
ECHO
RUN
The MCU executes the SWI and PSHH instructions when it enters monitor mode.
The RUN command tells the MCU to execute the PULH and RTI instructions.
Before sending the RUN command, the host can modify the stacked CPU registers
to prepare to run the host program. The READSP command returns the
incremented stack pointer value, SP + 1. The high and low bytes of the program
counter are at addresses SP + 5 and SP + 6.
SP
HIGH BYTE OF INDEX REGISTER
CONDITION CODE REGISTER
ACCUMULATOR
SP + 1
SP + 2
SP + 3
SP + 4
SP + 5
SP + 6
SP + 7
LOW BYTE OF INDEX REGISTER
HIGH BYTE OF PROGRAM COUNTER
LOW BYTE OF PROGRAM COUNTER
Figure 16-18. Stack Pointer at Monitor Mode Entry
Data Sheet
222
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Development Support
Development Support
Monitor Module (MON)
16.3.2 Security
A security feature discourages unauthorized reading of FLASH locations while in
monitor mode. The host can bypass the security feature at monitor mode entry by
sending eight security bytes that match the bytes at locations $FFF6–$FFFD.
Locations $FFF6–$FFFD contain user-defined data.
NOTE:
Do not leave locations $FFF6–$FFFD blank. For security reasons, program
locations $FFF6–$FFFD even if they are not used for vectors.
During monitor mode entry, the MCU waits after the power-on reset for the host to
send the eight security bytes on pin PTA0. If the received bytes match those at
locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host bypasses the security feature and can read all
FLASH locations and execute code from FLASH. Security remains bypassed until
a power-on reset occurs. If the reset was not a power-on reset, security remains
bypassed and security code entry is not required. See Figure 16-19.
Upon power-on reset, if the received bytes of the security code do not match the
data at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host fails to bypass the security feature. The
MCU remains in monitor mode, but reading a FLASH location returns an invalid
value and trying to execute code from FLASH causes an illegal address reset. After
receiving the eight security bytes from the host, the MCU transmits a break
character, signifying that it is ready to receive a command.
NOTE:
The MCU does not transmit a break character until after the host sends the eight
security bytes.
VDD
4096 + 32 BUSCLKX4 CYCLES
RST
FROM HOST
PA0
5
1
1
4
1
4
2
1
FROM MCU
Notes:
1 = Echo delay, approximately 2 bit times
2 = Data return delay, approximately 2 bit times
4 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte
5 = Wait until the monitor ROM runs
Figure 16-19. Monitor Mode Entry Timing
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
223
Development Support
Development Support
To determine whether the security code entered is correct, check to see if bit 6 of
RAM address $80 is set. If it is, then the correct security code has been entered
and FLASH can be accessed.
If the security sequence fails, the device should be reset by a power-on reset and
brought up in monitor mode to attempt another entry. After failing the security
sequence, the FLASH module can also be mass erased by executing an erase
routine that was downloaded into internal RAM. The mass erase operation clears
the security code locations so that all eight security bytes become $FF (blank).
Data Sheet
224
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Development Support
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 17. Electrical Specifications
17.1 Introduction
This section contains electrical and timing specifications.
17.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Maximum ratings are the extreme limits to which the microcontroller unit (MCU)
can be exposed without permanently damaging it.
NOTE:
This device is not guaranteed to operate properly at the maximum ratings. Refer to
17.5 5-V DC Electrical Characteristics and 17.9 3.3-V DC Electrical
Characteristics for guaranteed operating conditions.
Characteristic(1)
Supply voltage
Symbol
VDD
Value
Unit
V
–0.3 to +6.0
VIN
VSS –0.3 to VDD +0.3
VSS –0.3 to +9.1
Input voltage
V
VTST
Mode entry voltage, IRQ pin
V
Maximum current per pin excluding
PTA0–PTA5, VDD, and VSS
I
±15
mA
IPTA0— PTA5
I
Maximum current for pins PTA0–PTA5
Storage temperature
±25
–55 to +150
100
mA
°C
TSTG
IMVSS
IMVDD
Maximum current out of VSS
Maximum current into VDD
mA
mA
100
1. Voltages references to VSS
.
NOTE:
This device contains circuitry to protect the inputs against damage due to high
static voltages or electric fields; however, it is advised that normal precautions be
taken to avoid application of any voltage higher than maximum-rated voltages to
this high-impedance circuit. For proper operation, it is recommended that VIN and
VOUT be constrained to the range VSS ≤ (VIN or VOUT) ≤ VDD. Reliability of
operation is enhanced if unused inputs are connected to an appropriate logic
voltage level (for example, either VSS or VDD.)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
225
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
17.3 Functional Operating Range
Temp.
Code
Characteristic
Symbol
Value
Unit
– 40 to +125
– 40 to +105
–40 to +85
M
V
C
Operating temperature range (TL to TH)
TA
°C
V
Operating voltage range(1) (VDDMIN to VDDMAX
1. VDD must be above VTRIPR upon power on.
)
VDD
3.0 to 5.5
17.4 Thermal Characteristics
Characteristic
Thermal resistance
Symbol
Value
Unit
16-pin PDIP
16-pin SOIC
16-pin TSSOP
76
90
133
θJA
°C/W
PI/O
PD
I/O pin power dissipation
Power dissipation(1)
User determined
W
W
PD = (IDD x VDD
)
+ PI/O = K/(TJ + 273°C)
PD x (TA + 273°C)
Constant(2)
K
W/°C
+ PD2 x θJA
TJ
TA + (PD x θJA)
Average junction temperature
Maximum junction temperature
°C
°C
TJM
150
1. Power dissipation is a function of temperature.
2. K constant unique to the device. K can be determined for a known TA and measured PD. With
this value of K, PD and TJ can be determined for any value of TA.
Data Sheet
226
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Electrical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
5-V DC Electrical Characteristics
17.5 5-V DC Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Typ(2)
Symbol
VOH
Min
Max
Unit
V
Output high voltage
ILoad = –2.0 mA, all I/O pins
VDD–0.4
VDD–1.5
VDD–0.8
—
—
—
—
—
—
ILoad = –10.0 mA, all I/O pins
ILoad = –15.0 mA, PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5 only
Maximum combined IOH (all I/O pins)
IOHT
—
—
50
mA
V
Output low voltage
ILoad = 1.6 mA, all I/O pins
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.4
1.5
0.8
VOL
ILoad = 10.0 mA, all I/O pins
ILoad = 15.0 mA, PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5 only
Maximum combined IOL (all I/O pins)
IOHL
VIH
—
—
—
50
mA
V
Input high voltage
PTA0–PTA5, PTB0–PTB7
0.7 x VDD
VDD
Input low voltage
PTA0–PTA5, PTB0–PTB7
VIL
VSS
0.3 x VDD
—
V
VHYS
IINJ
0.06 x VDD
–2
Input hysteresis
—
—
—
—
+2
V
DC injection current, all ports
Total dc current injection (sum of all I/O)
mA
mA
IINJTOT
–25
+25
Digital I/O ports Hi-Z leakage current
Typical at 25 W°C
–10
—
—
±0.1
+10
—
IIL
µA
µA
IIN
Digital input only ports leakage current (PA2/IRQ/KBI2)
–1
—
+1
Capacitance
Ports (as input)
Ports (as input)
CIN
—
—
—
—
12
8
pF
COUT
POR rearm voltage(3)
VPOR
RPOR
VTST
0
—
—
—
100
—
mV
V/ms
V
POR rise time ramp rate(4)
Monitor mode entry voltage
0.035
VDD + 2.5
9.1
Pullup resistors(5)
PTA0–PTA5, PTB0–PTB7
RPU
16
26
36
kΩ
VTRIPF
VTRIPR
VHYS
Low-voltage inhibit reset, trip falling voltage
Low-voltage inhibit reset, trip rising voltage
Low-voltage inhibit reset/recover hysteresis
3.90
4.00
—
4.20
4.30
100
4.50
4.60
—
V
V
mV
1. VDD = 4.5 to 5.5 Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted.
2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25°C only.
3. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed.
4. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR reset is released, LVI will hold the part in reset until minimum VDD
is reached.
5. RPU is measured at VDD = 5.0 V.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
227
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
17.6 Control Timing
Characteristic(1)
Internal operating frequency
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
fOP (fBus
)
—
8
MHz
ns
Internal clock period (1/fOP
)
tcyc
125
175
125
—
—
—
—
tRL
RST input pulse width low
ns
tILIH
IRQ interrupt pulse width low (edge-triggered)
IRQ interrupt pulse period
ns
Note(2)
tILIL
tcyc
1. VSS = 0 Vdc; timing shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD unless otherwise noted.
2. The minimum period is the number of cycles it takes to execute the interrupt service routine plus 1 tcyc
.
tRL
RST
tILIL
tILIH
IRQ
Figure 17-1. RST and IRQ Timing
Data Sheet
228
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
Typical 5-V Output Drive Characteristics
17.7 Typical 5-V Output Drive Characteristics
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
5V PTA
5V PTB
0
-5
-10
-15
-20
-25
-30
-35
IOH (mA)
Figure 17-2. Typical 5-Volt Output High Voltage
versus Output High Current (25°C)
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
5V PTA
5V PTB
0
5
10
15
20
25
30
35
IOL (mA)
Figure 17-3. Typical 5-Volt Output Low Voltage
versus Output Low Current (25°C)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
229
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
17.8 5-V Oscillator Characteristics
Characteristic
Internal oscillator frequency(1)
Symbol
Min
—
8
Typ
25.6
—
Max
Unit
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
pF
fINTCLK
—
Crystal frequency, XTALCLK(1)
External RC oscillator frequency, RCCLK(1)
External clock reference frequency(1) (3)
Crystal load capacitance(4)
32(2)
12
32
—
fOSCXCLK
fRCCLK
fOSCXCLK
CL
2
—
dc
—
—
—
—
—
20
Crystal fixed capacitance(2)
C1
2 x CL
2 x CL
—
—
Crystal tuning capacitance(2)
Feedback bias resistor
C2
—
—
RB
10
—
MΩ
—
REXT
RC oscillator external resistor
See Figure 17-4
1. Bus frequency, fOP, is oscillator frequency divided by 4.
2. Due to variations in electrical properties of external components such as, ESR, and load capacitance, operation above
16 MHz is not guaranteed for all crystals or ceramic resonators. Operation above 16 MHz requires that a negative
resistance margin (NRM) characterization and component optimization be performed by the crystal or ceramic resonator
vendor for every different type of crystal or ceramic resonator which will be used. This characterization and optimization
must be performed at the extremes of voltage and temperature which will be applied to the microcontroller in the
application. The NRM must meet or exceed 10x the maximum ESR of the crystal or ceramic resonator for acceptable
performance.
3. No more than 10% duty cycle deviation from 50%.
4. Consult crystal vendor data sheet.
14
5 V @ 25°C
12
MCU
10
OSC1
8
6
VDD
4
2
0
REXT
0
10
20
30
40
50
Resistor, REXT (kΩ)
Figure 17-4. RC versus Frequency (5 Volts @ 25°C)
Data Sheet
230
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
3.3-V DC Electrical Characteristics
17.9 3.3-V DC Electrical Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Typ(2)
Symbol
VOH
Min
Max
Unit
V
Output high voltage
ILoad = –0.6 mA, all I/O pins
VDD–0.3
VDD–1.0
VDD–0.8
—
—
—
—
—
—
ILoad = –4.0 mA, all I/O pins
ILoad = –10.0 mA, PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5 only
Maximum combined IOH (all I/O pins)
IOHT
—
—
50
mA
V
Output low voltage
ILoad = 0.5 mA, all I/O pins
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.3
1.0
0.8
VOL
ILoad = 6.0 mA, all I/O pins
ILoad = 10.0 mA, PTA0, PTA1, PTA3–PTA5 only
Maximum combined IOL (all I/O pins)
IOHL
VIH
—
—
—
50
mA
V
Input high voltage
PTA0–PTA5, PTB0–PTB7
0.7 x VDD
VDD
Input low voltage
PTA0–PTA5, PTB0–PTB7
VIL
VSS
0.3 x VDD
—
V
VHYS
IINJ
0.06 x VDD
–2
Input hysteresis
—
—
—
—
+2
V
DC injection current, all ports
Total dc current injection (sum of all I/O)
mA
mA
IINJTOT
–25
+25
Digital I/O ports Hi-Z leakage current
Typical at 25°C
–10
—
—
±0.5
+10
—
IIL
µA
µA
IIN
Digital input only ports leakage current (PA2/IRQ/KBI2)
–1
—
+1
Capacitance
Ports (as input)
Ports (as input)
CIN
—
—
—
—
12
8
pF
COUT
POR rearm voltage(3)
VPOR
RPOR
VTST
0
—
—
—
100
—
mV
V/ms
V
POR rise time ramp rate(4)
Monitor mode entry voltage
0.035
VDD + 2.5
VDD + 4.0
Pullup resistors(5)
PTA0–PTA5, PTB0–PTB7
RPU
16
26
36
kΩ
VTRIPF
VTRIPR
VHYS
Low-voltage inhibit reset, trip falling voltage
Low-voltage inhibit reset, trip rising voltage
Low-voltage inhibit reset/recover hysteresis
2.65
2.75
—
2.8
2.9
60
3.0
3.10
—
V
V
mV
1. VDD = 3.0 to 3.6 Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted.
2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25°C only.
3. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed.
4. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR reset is released, LVI will hold the part in reset until minimum VDD
is reached.
5. RPU is measured at VDD = 3.3 V
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
231
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
17.10 Typical 3.3-V Output Drive Characteristics
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
3V PTA
3V PTB
0
-5
-10
-15
-20
IOH (mA)
Figure 17-5. Typical 3.3-Volt Output High Voltage
versus Output High Current (25°C)
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
3V PTA
3V PTB
0
5
10
15
20
IOL (mA)
Figure 17-6. Typical 3.3-Volt Output Low Voltage
versus Output Low Current (25°C)
Data Sheet
232
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
3.3-V Control Timing
17.11 3.3-V Control Timing
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
fOP
Min
—
Max
4
Unit
MHz
µs
Internal operating frequency(2)
RST input pulse width low(3)
tIRL
1.5
—
1. VDD = 3.0 to 3.6 Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH; timing shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless otherwise
noted.
2. Some modules may require a minimum frequency greater than dc for proper operation; see appropriate table for this
information.
3. Minimum pulse width reset is guaranteed to be recognized. It is possible for a smaller pulse width to cause a reset.
17.12 3.3-V Oscillator Characteristics
Characteristic
Internal oscillator frequency(1)
Symbol
Min
—
8
Typ
12.8
—
Max
—
Unit
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
pF
fINTCLK
Crystal frequency, XTALCLK(1)
External RC oscillator frequency, RCCLK(1)
External clock reference frequency(1) (2)
Crystal load capacitance(3)
fOSCXCLK
fRCCLK
fOSCXCLK
CL
16
12
16
—
2
—
dc
—
—
—
—
—
20
Crystal fixed capacitance(2)
C1
2 x CL
2 x CL
—
—
Crystal tuning capacitance(2)
Feedback bias resistor
C2
—
—
RB
10
—
MΩ
—
REXT
RC oscillator external resistor
See Figure 17-7
1. Bus frequency, fOP, is oscillator frequency divided by 4.
2. No more than 10% duty cycle deviation from 50%
3. Consult crystal vendor data sheet
14
12
10
8
3 V @ 25°C
MCU
OSC1
6
VDD
4
REXT
2
0
0
10
20
30
40
50
RESISTOR, REXT (KΩ)
Figure 17-7. RC versus Frequency (3 Volts @ 25°C)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
233
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
17.13 Supply Current Characteristics
Bus
Freq.
(MHz)
Characteristic(1)
Voltage
Symbol
Typ
Max
Unit
5.0
3.3
4
4
4.5
2.7
—
—
Run mode VDD supply current(2)
RIDD
mA
mA
5.0
3.3
4
4
1.7
1.0
—
—
WAIT mode VDD supply current(3)
Stop mode VDD supply current(4)
WIDD
5.0
3.3
0.10
0.22
0.34
6.50
5.70
125
—
—
—
—
—
—
µA
µA
µA
nA
µA
µA
–40 to 85°C
–40 to 105°C
–40 to 125°C
25°C
25°C with auto wake-up enabled
Incremental current with LVI enabled at 25°C
SIDD
–40 to 85°C
–40 to 105°C
–40 to 125°C
25°C
25°C with auto wake-up enabled
Incremental current with LVI enabled at 25°C
0.10
0.14
0.18
4.60
1.30
102
—
—
—
—
—
—
µA
µA
µA
nA
µA
µA
1. VDD = 3.3 to 5.5 Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted.
2. Run (operating) IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than
100 pF on all outputs. All ports configured as inputs. Measured with all modules enabled.
3. Wait (operating) IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than
100 pF on all outputs. All ports configured as inputs. Measured with all modules enabled.
4. Stop IDD measured with all ports driven 0.2 V or less from rail. No dc loads. On the 8-pin versions, port B is configured as
inputs with pullups enabled.
Data Sheet
234
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
Supply Current Characteristics
14
12
10
8
Crystal w/o ADC
Crystal w/ ADC
6
Internal Osc w/o
ADC
4
Internal Osc w/
ADC
2
0
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Bus Frequency (MHz)
Figure 17-8. Typical 5-Volt Run Current
versus Bus Frequency (25°C)
4
3
2
1
0
Crystal w/o ADC
Crystal w/ ADC
Internal Osc w/o
ADC
Internal Osc w/
ADC
0
1
2
3
4
5
Bus Frequency (MHz)
Figure 17-9. Typical 3.3-Volt Run Current
versus Bus Frequency (25°C)
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
235
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
17.14 5.0-Volt ADC Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Max
5.5
Unit
Comments
V
DDAD should be tied to
VDDAD
Supply voltage
4.5
V
the same potential as VDD
via separate traces.
VADIN
BAD
VDDAD
VADIN <= VDDAD
Input voltages
0
10
V
Bits
Resolution
10
+4
AAD
Absolute accuracy
ADC internal clock
Conversion range
Power-up time
–4
LSB
Includes quantization
fADIC
RAD
tAIC = 1/fADIC
500 k
VSSAD
1.048 M
VDDAD
Hz
V
tADPU
tADC
tADS
MAD
ZADI
FADI
CADI
IVREF
tAIC cycles
tAIC cycles
tAIC cycles
16
16
5
—
17
—
Conversion time
Sample time
Monotonicity
Guaranteed
VADIN = VSSA
ADIN = VDDA
Zero input reading
Full-scale reading
Input capacitance
VDDAD/VREFH current
000
3FC
—
003
3FF
30
Hex
Hex
pF
V
Not tested
—
1.6
mA
Absolute accuracy
(8-bit truncation mode)
AAD
—
–1
+1
LSB
LSB
Includes quantization
Quantization error
(8-bit truncation mode)
–1/8
+7/8
1. VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%, VSS = 0 Vdc, VDDAD/VREFH = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%, VSSAD/VREFL = 0 Vdc
Data Sheet
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
236
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
3.3-Volt ADC Characteristics
17.15 3.3-Volt ADC Characteristics
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Max
3.6
Unit
Comments
V
DDAD should be tied to
VDDAD
Supply voltage
3.0
V
the same potential as VDD
via separate traces.
VADIN
BAD
VDDAD
VADIN <= VDDAD
Input voltages
0
10
V
Bits
Resolution
10
+6
AAD
Absolute accuracy
ADC internal clock
Conversion range
Power-up time
–6
LSB
Includes quantization
fADIC
RAD
tAIC = 1/fADIC
500 k
VSSAD
1.048 M
VDDAD
Hz
V
tADPU
tADC
tADS
MAD
ZADI
FADI
CADI
IVREF
tAIC cycles
tAIC cycles
tAIC cycles
16
16
5
—
17
—
Conversion time
Sample time
Monotonicity
Guaranteed
VADIN = VSSA
ADIN = VDDA
Zero input reading
Full-scale reading
Input capacitance
VDDAD/VREFH current
000
3FA
—
005
3FF
30
Hex
Hex
pF
V
Not tested
—
1.2
mA
Absolute accuracy
(8-bit truncation mode)
AAD
—
–1
+1
LSB
LSB
Includes quantization
Quantization error
(8-bit truncation mode)
–1/8
+7/8
1. VDD = 3.3 Vdc ± 10%, VSS = 0 Vdc, VDDAD/VREFH = 3.3 Vdc ± 10%, VSSAD/VREFL = 0 Vdc
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
Data Sheet
237
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
17.16 Timer Interface Module Characteristics
Characteristic
Timer input capture pulse width
Timer Input capture period
Symbol
tTH, TL
Min
Max
—
Unit
t
tcyc
2
Note(1)
tcyc + 5
tTLTL
tcyc
ns
—
tTCL, tTCH
Timer input clock pulse width
—
1. The minimum period is the number of cycles it takes to execute the interrupt service routine plus 1 tcyc
.
tTLTL
tTH
INPUT CAPTURE
RISING EDGE
tTLTL
tTL
INPUT CAPTURE
FALLING EDGE
tTLTL
tTH
tTL
INPUT CAPTURE
BOTH EDGES
tTCH
TCLK
tTCL
Figure 17-10. Input Capture Timing
Data Sheet
238
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
Memory Characteristics
17.17 Memory Characteristics
Characteristic
RAM data retention voltage
Symbol
Min
1.3
1
Typ
—
Max
—
Unit
V
VRDR
FLASH program bus clock frequency
FLASH read bus clock frequency
—
—
—
MHz
Hz
(1)
0
—
8 M
fRead
FLASH page erase time
<1 K cycles
>1 K cycles
tErase
0.9
3.6
1
4
1.1
5.5
ms
tMErase
tNVS
FLASH mass erase time
4
10
5
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
40
—
ms
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
FLASH PGM/ERASE to HVEN setup time
FLASH high-voltage hold time
FLASH high-voltage hold time (mass erase)
FLASH program hold time
tNVH
tNVHL
tPGS
100
5
tPROG
FLASH program time
30
1
(2)
FLASH return to read time
tRCV
(3)
FLASH cumulative program HV period
—
10 k
15
—
4
ms
tHV
FLASH endurance(4)
—
—
100 k
100
—
—
Cycles
Years
FLASH data retention time(5)
1. fRead is defined as the frequency range for which the FLASH memory can be read.
2. tRCV is defined as the time it needs before the FLASH can be read after turning off the high voltage charge pump, by
clearing HVEN to 0.
3. tHV is defined as the cumulative high voltage programming time to the same row before next erase.
tHV must satisfy this condition: tNVS + tNVH + tPGS + (tPROG x 32) ≤ tHV maximum.
4. Typical endurance was evaluated for this product family. For additional information on how Motorola defines. Typical
Endurance, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB619.
5. Typical data retention values are based on intrinsic capability of the technology measured at high temperature and de-rated
to 25°C using the Arrhenius equation. For additional information on how Motorola defines Typical Data Retention, please
refer to Engineering Bulletin EB618.
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
239
Electrical Specifications
Electrical Specifications
Data Sheet
240
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Data Sheet — MC68HC908QL4 Family
Section 18. Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
18.1 Introduction
This section provides ordering information for the MC68HC908QL4,
MC68HC908QL3, and MC68HC908QL2 along with the dimensions for:
•
•
•
16-pin plastic dual in-line package (PDIP
16-pin small outline integrated circuit (SOIC) package
16-pin thin shrink small outline package (TSSOP)
The following figures show the latest package drawings at the time of this
publication. To make sure that you have the latest package specifications, contact
your local Motorola Sales Office.
18.2 MC Order Numbers
Table 18-1. MC Order Numbers
MC Order Number
ADC
Yes
No
FLASH Memory
4096 bytes
Package
MC68HC908QL4
MC68HC908QL3
MC68HC908QL2
16-pins
PDIP, SOIC,
and TSSOP
4096 bytes
Yes
2048 bytes
Temperature and package designators:
C = –40°C to +85°C
V = –40°C to +105°C (available for VDD = 5 V only)
M = –40°C to +125°C (available for VDD = 5 V only)
P = Plastic dual in-line package (PDIP)
DW = Small outline integrated circuit package (SOIC)
DT = Thin shrink small outline package (TSSOP)
M C 6 8 H C 9 0 8 Q L X X X X
FAMILY
PACKAGE DESIGNATOR
TEMPERATURE RANGE
Figure 18-1. Device Numbering System
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
241
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
18.3 16-Pin Plastic Dual In-Line Package (Case #648D)
NOTES:
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER
ANSI Y14.5M, 1982.
2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: INCH.
3. DIMENSION L TO CENTER OF LEADS WHEN
FORMED PARALLEL.
4. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE
MOLD PROTRUSION.
5. MOLDFLASHORPROTRUSIONSSHALLNOT
EXCEED 0.25 (0.010).
-A-
16
9
8
-B-
S
1
6. ROUNDED CORNERS OPTIONAL.
F
INCHES
DIM MIN MAX
MILLIMETERS
MIN MAX
L
C
K
A
B
C
D
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
S
0.740 0.760 18.80 19.30
0.245 0.260
0.145 0.175
0.015 0.021
0.050 0.070
0.100 BSC
6.23
3.69
0.39
1.27
2.54 BSC
1.27 BSC
6.60
4.44
0.53
1.77
SEATING
PLANE
-T-
M
J
0.050 BSC
H
0.008 0.015
0.120 0.140
0.295 0.305
0.21
0.38
3.55
7.74
G
3.05
7.50
0
D 16 PL
0
10
10
M
S
S
°
°
°
°
0.25 (0.010)
T B
A
0.015 0.035
0.39
0.88
18.4 16-Pin Small Outline Integrated Circuit Package (Case #751G)
A
NOTES:
D
1. DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETERS.
2. INTERPRET DIMENSIONS AND
TOLERANCES PER ASME Y14.5M, 1994.
3. DIMENSIONS D AND E DO NOT INLCUDE
MOLD PROTRUSION.
q
16
9
4. MAXIMUM MOLD PROTRUSION 0.15 PER
SIDE.
5. DIMENSION B DOES NOT INCLUDE DAMBAR
PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE DAMBAR
PROTRUSION SHALL BE 0.13 TOTAL IN
EXCESSOFTHEBDIMENSIONATMAXIMUM
MATERIAL CONDITION.
1
8
MILLIMETERS
B
16X B
DIM MIN
2.35
A1 0.10
MAX
2.65
0.25
0.49
0.32
A
M
S
S
0.25
T A
B
B
C
D
E
e
H
h
L
q
0.35
0.23
10.15 10.45
7.40 7.60
1.27 BSC
10.05 10.55
0.25
0.40
0
0.75
1.00
7
SEATING
PLANE
14X
e
°
°
C
T
Data Sheet
242
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
16-Pin Thin Shrink Small Outline Package (Case #948F)
18.5 16-Pin Thin Shrink Small Outline Package (Case #948F)
16X KREF
M
S
S
0.10 (0.004) T U
V
NOTES:
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER
ANSI Y14.5M, 1982.
S
0.15 (0.006) T U
K
2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: MILLIMETER.
3. DIMENSION A DOES NOT INCLUDE MOLD
FLASH. PROTRUSIONS OR GATE BURRS.
MOLD FLASH OR GATE BURRS SHALL NOT
EXCEED 0.15 (0.006) PER SIDE.
4. DIMENSION B DOES NOT INCLUDE
INTERLEAD FLASH OR PROTRUSION.
INTERLEADFLASHORPROTRUSIONSHALL
NOT EXCEED
K1
16
9
2X L/2
J1
B
-U-
SECTION N-N
L
0.25 (0.010) PER SIDE.
J
5. DIMENSION K DOES NOTINCLUDE DAMBAR
PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE DAMBAR
PROTRUSION SHALL BE 0.08 (0.003) TOTAL
IN EXCESS OF THE K DIMENSION AT
MAXIMUM MATERIAL CONDITION.
6. TERMINAL NUMBERS ARE SHOWN FOR
REFERENCE ONLY.
PIN 1
IDENT.
8
1
N
0.25 (0.010)
7. DIMENSION A AND B ARE TO BE
DETERMINED AT DATUM PLANE -W-.
S
0.15 (0.006) T U
A
M
-V-
N
F
MILLIMETERS
DIM MIN MAX
INCHES
MIN MAX
A
B
C
D
F
G
H
J
4.90
4.30
---
0.05
0.50
0.65 BSC
0.18
0.09
5.10 0.193 0.200
4.50 0.169 0.177
DETAIL E
1.20
--- 0.047
0.15 0.002 0.006
0.75 0.020 0.030
-W-
C
0.026 BSC
0.28 0.007 0.011
0.20 0.004 0.008
0.16 0.004 0.006
0.30 0.007 0.012
0.25 0.007 0.010
0.10 (0.004)
J1 0.09
0.19
DETAIL E
H
SEATING
PLANE
K
-T-
D
G
K1 0.19
L
6.40 BSC
0.252 BSC
M
0
8
0
8
°
°
°
°
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
Data Sheet
243
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
Data Sheet
MC68HC908QL Family — Rev. 2
MOTOROLA
244
Ordering Information and Mechanical Specifications
HOW TO REACH US:
USA/EUROPE/LOCATIONS NOT LISTED:
Motorola Literature Distribution
P.O. Box 5405
Denver, Colorado 80217
1-800-521-6274 or 480-768-2130
JAPAN:
Motorola Japan Ltd.
SPS, Technical Information Center
3-20-1, Minami-Azabu, Minato-ku
Tokyo 106-8573, Japan
81-3-3440-3569
ASIA/PACIFIC:
Motorola Semiconductors H.K. Ltd.
Silicon Harbour Centre
2 Dai King Street
Tai Po Industrial Estate
Tai Po, N.T., Hong Kong
852-26668334
HOME PAGE:
http://motorola.com/semiconductors
Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and software implementers to use Motorola products.
There are no express or implied copyright licenses granted hereunder to design or fabricate any integrated circuits or
integrated circuits based on the information in this document.
Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein. Motorola makes no warranty,
representation or guarantee regarding the suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Motorola assume
any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically disclaims any and all liability,
including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. “Typical” parameters that may be provided in Motorola
data sheets and/or specifications can and do vary in different applications and actual performance may vary over time. All
operating parameters, including “Typicals”, must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts.
Motorola does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Motorola products are not designed,
intended, or authorized for use as components in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications
intended to support or sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of the Motorola product could create a
situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Motorola products for any such
unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Motorola and its officers, employees, subsidiaries,
affiliates, and distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees arising
out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even
if such claim alleges that Motorola was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part.
MOTOROLA and the Stylized M Logo are registered in the US Patent and Trademark Office. All other product or service
names are the property of their respective owners. Motorola, Inc. is an Equal Opportunity/Affirmative Action Employer.
© Motorola Inc. 2004
MC68HC908QL4/D
Rev. 2
3/2004
相关型号:
SI9130DB
5- and 3.3-V Step-Down Synchronous ConvertersWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9135LG-T1
SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply ControllerWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9135LG-T1-E3
SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply ControllerWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9135_11
SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply ControllerWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9136_11
Multi-Output Power-Supply ControllerWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9130CG-T1-E3
Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9130LG-T1-E3
Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9130_11
Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9137
Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile ApplicationsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9137DB
Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile ApplicationsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9137LG
Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile ApplicationsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9122E
500-kHz Half-Bridge DC/DC Controller with Integrated Secondary Synchronous Rectification DriversWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明